Annual Financial Report

RNS Number : 7272C
ITV PLC
20 March 2014
 



20 March 2014

 

ITV plc Annual Report and Accounts for the year ended 31 December 2013

 

Online Annual Report

The Online Annual Report is available at ar2013.itvplc.com.

 

Annual Financial Report

 

ITV plc (the 'Company') released its preliminary announcement of annual results for the year ended 31 December 2013 ('Preliminary Announcement') on 26 February 2014. Further to the Preliminary Announcement, the Company can now confirm that the Report and Accounts 2013, Notice of Annual General Meeting and Form of Proxy will be mailed to shareholders on 20 March 2014. The Report and Accounts 2013 are now available on the Company's website at www.itvplc.com/investors.

 

Appendix A to this announcement contains the Report and Accounts 2013 in unedited full text for the purposes of compliance with the Disclosure and Transparency Rules. Any page and note references refer to page numbers and notes in the Report and Accounts 2013.

 

Annual General Meeting

 

The Company's 2014 Annual General Meeting will be held at 11.00 a.m. on Wednesday, 14 May 2014 at The Queen Elizabeth II Conference Centre, Broad Sanctuary, Westminster, London SW1P 3EE. The Notice of Annual General Meeting and Form of proxy will be available on our website from 20 March 2014.

 

National Storage Mechanism

 

In compliance with LR 9.6.3, the following documents have been submitted to the National Storage Mechanism and will shortly be available for inspection at: http://www.hemscott.com/nsm.do

 

·      Report and Accounts 2013

·      Notice of 2014 Annual General Meeting

·      Form of Proxy for 2014 Annual General Meeting

 

ITV plc

Tel: 020 7157 3000

 

For further enquiries please contact: 

 

Investor Relations

 

Pippa Foulds - 020 7157 6555 or 07778 031097

 

Media Relations

 

Mary Fagan - 020 7157 3965 or 07736 786448

Mike Large -  020 7157 3021 or 07768 261528

 

Website: www.itv.com; investor information: www.itvplc.com

 

 

Appendix A

 

ITV plc Annual Report and Accounts for the year ended 31 December 2013

 

Corporate Website

We maintain a corporate website at www.itvplc.com containing a wide range of information of interest to institutional and private investors including:

·     Latest news and press releases

·     Annual reports and investor presentations

·     Governance documents

·     Corporate Responsibility content

 

Appendix A

 

Strategic Report

The Strategic Report explains in detail how we have performed this year and sets out a fair review of the business, a balanced and comprehensive analysis of our performance, the use of key performance indicators to explain the progress we have made, a description of the principal risks and uncertainties facing the Company, and an indication of potential future developments. 

The Strategic Report is prepared in line with the relevant provisions of the Companies Act 2006 and the Company has had regard to the guidance issued by the Financial Reporting Council in its Exposure Draft: Guidance on the Strategic Report. It is intended to provide shareholders with a better understanding of the Company, of its position in the markets within which it operates, and of its prospects. 

In setting out the Company's main risks and uncertainties, an indication of potential future developments, and in other content, this report and accounts contains statements that are based on knowledge and information available at the date of preparation of the Strategic Report, and what are believed to be reasonable judgements, and therefore cannot be considered as indications of likelihood or certainty. A wide range of factors may cause the actual outcomes and results to differ materially from those contained within, or implied by, these various forward-looking statements. None of these statements should be construed as a profit forecast.

 

Investor Proposition

·     We are four years into our strategic plan and ITV is now a demonstrably stronger and more efficient business -operationally, financially and creatively

·     Over the last four years we've grown our revenues and delivered double digit profit growth every year, our adjusted earnings per share has increased sixfold and our cash conversion has been consistently strong

·     Creativity lies at the heart of our strategy and our investment in quality content is driving revenue and profit growth across the business

·     While we have made great progress and ITV is now a much more balanced business, there is still a great deal to do

·     We remain committed to our strategy to build an international content business and as an integrated producer broadcaster we are building a unique position to exploit the increasing global demand for proven content across a range of platforms

·     ITV Studios has grown strongly, both organically and through acquisitions, and going forward growth will come increasingly from our international business as we become a more global business

·     Our Broadcast business is robust, with the best year-on-year on-screen performance for ten years, and Online, Pay & Interactive continues to deliver double digit revenue growth as we make our content available on more platforms

 

ITV at a Glance

ITV is an integrated producer broadcaster, operating the largest commercial family of channels in the UK. In addition to traditional broadcasting on our channels, we deliver our content on demand through numerous platforms, both directly and via ITV Player. Through ITV Studios we produce content for both our own channels and third parties in the UK and increasingly overseas. Our distribution business sells finished programmes and formats worldwide.

Broadcast & Online

ITV broadcasts a wide variety of content on its family of free to air (FTA) channels consisting of ITV, the largest commercial television channel in the UK, and the digital channels, ITV2, ITV3, ITV4 and CITV. In 2014 we will launch ITVBe, our new FTA lifestyle and reality channel. The family of channels attracted a total share of viewing of 23.1% in 2013, the largest audience of any UK commercial broadcaster. Programming is primarily funded by television advertising revenues. ITV has the largest share of our estimate of the UK television advertising market at 45.4% in 2013.

In addition to linear broadcast, ITV delivers its content across multiple platforms. This is either through ITV Player, available on ITV's website, itv.com, and platforms such as Virgin and Sky, or through direct content deals with services such as Lovefilm and Netflix. ITV's content  is now available on 19 platforms and in 2014 we will launch our new pay channel, ITV Encore, on Sky.

 

ITV Studios

ITV Studios is the Group's international content business. It is the largest production company in the UK and produces programming for ITV's own channels and for other broadcasters such as the BBC, Channel 4 and Sky. ITV Studios also operates in five international locations, the US, Australia, Germany, France and the Nordics, producing content for local broadcasters in these regions. This content is either locally created IP or created elsewhere by ITV, mainly the UK. We have made a number of acquisitions in the UK, US and the Nordics as we look to build our international business. Global Entertainment, ITV's distribution business, licenses ITV's finished programmes and formats and third party content internationally.

 

ITV Strategy

Our vision remains to create world-class content which we can make famous on our channels, and exploit across multiple platforms, both free and pay, in the UK and internationally. We have a clear and consistent strategy which is based on four key strategic priorities as follows:

1. Create a lean, creatively dynamic and fit-for-purpose organisation

2. Maximise audience and revenue share from our existing free-to-air broadcast business

3. Drive new revenue streams by exploiting our content across multiple platforms, free and pay

4. Build a strong international content business

 

Business Model

How ITV generates value

As an integrated producer broadcaster, we have a unique opportunity to deliver value from our investment in quality content. Our investment in our programme budget for our broadcast channels delivers unrivalled audiences that drive our advertising revenues. Our channels also provide a shop window for our own content to make it famous before selling it internationally. 

By creating and owning content we can grow new revenue streams by exploiting that content across multiple platforms, both free and pay. Investment in our creative pipeline and in selective acquisitions is building our international content business as we sell our programmes and formats internationally as the demand for proven content continues to grow.

Market Review

The media environment in which ITV operates, both as broadcaster and producer, continues to be dynamic. We must ensure that we adapt as the market changes as it presents great opportunities for ITV as an integrated producer broadcaster.

Broadcast & Online

Over recent years the number of ways to watch TV has greatly increased. Viewers are now able to choose between a variety of traditional platforms, both free and pay. On demand viewing allows people to watch content away from traditional television with programmes delivered over the top to devices including mobiles, tablets and connected TVs. Linear viewing via the TV set is still dominant with on demand a relatively small part of overall viewing, but it is growing fast: we cannot be complacent and must ensure that our online offering is strong to compete in this market.

Traditional television viewing

ITV competes for viewers with the BBC and other commercial broadcasters, including the Channel 4, Channel 5 and Sky families of channels. The process of digital switchover in the UK completed in 2012, increasing the number of channels available to all viewers from the traditional five terrestrial channels to a choice of hundreds. The erosion of audience share experienced by the terrestrial broadcasters during this transition has now levelled. Relatively little has changed in terms of viewing behaviour. In the last five years the public service broadcaster (PSB) families have only lost 1.2 share points. BBC One and ITV continue to be the only channels consistently able to deliver peak audiences of more than five million, and the PSB families receive around 72% share of viewing (SOV). ITV Family SOV in 2013 was 23.1%, second only to the BBC's family of channels at 32.2%. SOV for the Channel 4, Channel 5 and Sky families was significantly smaller at 11.0%, 6.0% and 8.0% respectively.

Total television viewing has been largely stable over the past decade with average viewing of 232 minutes in 2013 compared to 224 minutes in 2003. Total viewing saw a decline of 4% in 2013 due to the lack of a large one-off sporting event and the good weather over the summer. Viewing of commercial channels was only down 1% to 153 minutes per day.

Platforms

The platforms on which viewers watch television is important to ITV as for linear viewing our SOV is higher in free to air homes. The current platform mix is around 48% free to air (Freeview and Freesat) and 52% Pay (including Sky, Virgin and BT). We continue to support free platforms with developments such as YouView, which is estimated to have distributed over 900,000 boxes by the end of 2013.

Video on demand and catch up

Video on demand (VOD) viewing of lawful long form content is growing rapidly but remained around 3% of all viewing in 2013. Growth is being driven by viewing on mobiles, tablets and the television set, while PC viewing is declining (Source: Internal estimates, 3Reasons).

The number of homes with Personal Video Recorders (PVRs) has increased to around 63%, with PVR catch up viewing of around 12% (2012: 10%). The line between catch up and VOD is becoming more blurred with the growth of connected devices as viewers no longer need to record programmes. ITV continues to improve the quality and distribution of ITV Player to take advantage of this growing demand.

Advertising revenues

ITV generates revenues from advertising through traditional broadcast and also increasingly online. ITV competes with the commercial broadcasters and other advertising mediums, such as the internet and print, for its advertising revenues. Over the last five years TV has broadly maintained its share of total advertising spend at around 28% whilst the internet, which is growing rapidly, continues to take share from press. ITV's share of the television advertising net revenues (SOB) was 45.4% in 2013, slightly behind 2012 (45.8%). However, it is getting increasingly difficult to measure the market as all broadcasters have differing definitions and therefore include sources of revenue other than pure spot advertising.

Subscription and Pay revenue

ITV also earns revenues from pay TV, both directly from the viewer and through licensing its channels and content. The total UK pay TV market has been growing moderately and was estimated to be £6.1 billion in 2012 (Source: Screen Digest). Much of this goes to platform owners such as Sky and Virgin as subscriptions from the viewer, with the remainder being paid by platform owners to content owners, such as ITV, and rights holders.

A big growth area in pay TV is now subscription VOD, where viewers have unlimited access to content for a period of time. 2012 was the first year that VOD subscription took off in the UK, and the two main services, Netflix and Lovefilm which offer ITV content, are growing fast.

ITV Studios and the Global content market

Over the last few years the proliferation of entertainment platforms and the increasingly competitive nature of the broadcasting industry has created strong demand for quality proven content and formats that travel internationally. This is because broadcasters and platform owners want to increase the certainty of their audiences, either mass or targeted, around which to sell their advertising. This provides great opportunities for ITV as a leading content creator and producer.

ITV Studios production regions

ITV Studios is the largest commercial production company in the UK, and the third largest European producer after Fremantle and Endemol, producing over 3,500 hours of content per year for ITV and other broadcasters in the UK. ITV Studios also produces programming for local broadcasters in five international locations: the US (the largest international base), Australia, Germany, France and the Nordics. Global Entertainment, ITV's distribution business, sells finished programmes and formats around the world and is one of the top three European distributors of television content.

The global content market

The global content market is estimated to be worth around $50 billion. Approximately 29% of this ($15 billion) is accounted for by the US, 8% by the UK ($4 billion), and the remaining 63% by the rest of the world.

Entertainment and factual entertainment formats such as Come Dine With Me, Hell's Kitchen and I'm A Celebrity Get Me Out Of Here! are a significant part of global content sales. We are also seeing a resurgence of drama and comedy, and a rise in reality programming, for example Duck Dynasty and Real Housewives.

The UK and US drive global creativity in TV formats and finished tape sales. The UK is the world leader for the volume of exported formats, ahead of other top exporters the US, Holland and the Nordics, and second only to the US in catalogue sales.

In the UK and internationally ITV competes with a large number of independent producers, including 'super-indies' such as Fremantle and Endemol. The independent producers are largely privately owned, and do not have the advantage of being an integrated producer broadcaster.

The US is the largest creative market in the world and while dominated by vertically integrated conglomerates, there is a thriving independent market valued at about $3.5 billion in which ITV competes. ITV Studios is now one of the five largest independent producers in the US.

 

Chairman's Statement

Archie Norman

 

Dear Shareholder

ITV today is a much stronger business in almost every respect than when the restructured Board and leadership team were formed four years ago. When we set out our transformation programme in 2010 the core objective was to rebalance the business, to open up new growth paths, and to ensure it is more resilient in a changing media landscape. Whilst there is much further to go, this programme is well under way with strong growth in all sources of non-net advertising revenue.

After years of underperformance, our content business is now delivering consistent growth under strong creative leadership. Selected international acquisitions have accelerated progress, particularly in the USA, to form the basis for a global content network. Meanwhile, online, pay and sponsorships have all shown strong and profitable growth. This has been achieved against the backdrop of difficult economic conditions and subdued consumer markets.

As a result ITV today is in unrecognisably better health, with strong leadership and a good talent base at all levels. This does not of course mean we can afford to let the pace of change diminish. While the traditional broadcast television model remains robust, the market for 'television-like' content is changing faster than ever with new forms of viewing emerging, more catch up, more consumption on connected and mobile devices and indeed new entrants competing for share of the viewers' time. Therefore we must continue to adapt ITV to take advantage of these opportunities.

We see great opportunities ahead as we build on the creative capability of ITV internationally. However, these will also pose challenges to the way we work internally and externally. And as we extend our reach it remains vital to sustain the health of our growing channel family in the UK and especially of our flagship channel ITV.

Our ability to tackle these challenges with confidence is reinforced by the transformation of our financial position which has been the result of tight cash management, debt restructuring and cost control: we now have a robust balance sheet and strong cash flow generation. The Board is very mindful of the need to balance the investment requirements of the business to deliver future growth with increasing shareholder returns. The Board has proposed a 35% increase in the ordinary dividend to 3.5p and a 4.0p special dividend in line with last year.

ITV remains a regulated business and as the media landscape changes we continue to see the need for the relaxation of regulatory constraints as non-regulated forms of competition grow. However, we are pleased that our public service licences have now finally been renewed providing a stable platform for another ten years.

Our philosophy of management has been to combine very strong commercial and management leadership with great creative talent. This approach is also reflected at Board level where we seek to retain a mix of deep commercial and creative understanding around the Board table. I am delighted therefore that Sir Peter Bazalgette has joined our Board this year. Mike Clasper, who made a huge contribution to the Board in good times and bad over the last eight years has stood down with our thanks.

Finally, we are a talent driven, people intensive business. Our progress has been driven by the leadership, creativity and motivation of our people. And I want to thank all our colleagues at ITV for their hard work, and our shareholders for their continuing support.

Archie Norman

Chairman

 

Strategy and Operation

Chief Executive's Review

Adam Crozier

 

ITV delivers another year of strong growth 

2013 was another strong year for ITV, both operationally and financially, as we continue to make progress with our strategy of growing and rebalancing the business. External revenues were up 9%, with non-NAR revenues up £175 million (17%), and for the fourth year in a row we delivered double digit profit growth.

2013's performance builds on the consistently strong results we have delivered since we announced our strategy. Since 2009 we have increased Group external revenues by 27%, EBITA before exceptional items (EBITA) by 207%, adjusted earnings per share (EPS) by 522% and improved our cash position by over £750 million, even after returns to shareholders and investment in the business.

Our Broadcast business remains in good shape. In 2013 we had the best year-on-year viewing performance for ten years with ITV Family SOV up 4%, and the television advertising market returned to growth. Online, Pay & Interactive revenues continue to grow strongly and are now a material part of the business. ITV Studios, which again delivered significant revenue growth, is becoming an increasingly international business as it grows both organically and through selective acquisitions.

Our vision remains to create world-class content, which we can make famous on our channels, before exploiting its value across multiple platforms, both free and pay, in the UK and internationally. While there is still much to do and good potential for growth, the progress we are making is clearly evident in our results.

2013 operating and financial performance

ITV's financial results reflect a good performance across the business. ITV NAR grew 2% and, in line with our strategy, non-NAR revenues grew £175 million or 17% to £1,211 million.

Good revenue growth, together with our tight cost control, has led to 21% growth in EBITA before exceptional items (EBITA) to £620 million, 27% growth in adjusted profit before tax (PBT) to £581 million and 23% growth in adjusted EPS to 11.2p. Group margins have improved by three percentage points to 26% and we delivered £28 million of cost savings, £8 million ahead of our original target.

Broadcast & Online revenues grew by 3% to £1,896 million (2012: £1,834 million) and EBITA increased by 20% to £487 million (2012: £406 million). This was driven by 2% growth in ITV Family NAR and 16% growth in Online, Pay & Interactive as we have increased the quality and distribution of ITV Player and further developed our pay opportunities.

On-screen we have had a very strong year with ITV share of viewing (SOV) up 3% and ITV Family SOV up 4% as we have continued to increase the quality and variety of the schedule.

ITV Studios delivered 20% growth in total revenue to £857 million (2012: £712 million) and 24% growth in EBITA to £133 million (2012: £107 million). This was driven by the international studios business, with growth coming both organically and from the acquisitions we have made in the UK and internationally.

Our continued focus on cash and costs and our strong profit to cash conversion, saw us grow our free cash flow by over £100 million. We generated £433 million of free cash before investment and shareholder returns to end the year with net cash of £164 million. We have taken further steps to improve the efficiency of the balance sheet with additional debt buybacks and the redemption of the convertible bond.

The Board has proposed a final dividend of 2.4p (2012: 1.8p) giving a full year dividend of 3.5p (2012: 2.6p) - an increase of 35%. The Board is committed to a progressive dividend, taking into account the outlook for the business, while balancing the need to invest for growth and to maintain a robust financial position.

In addition to the final dividend, the Board is proposing a special dividend of 4.0p per share (£161 million). The cash distribution reflects the Board's confidence in the ongoing growth and cash generation of the business. Going forward we will continue to show capital discipline and balance the need to invest for future growth with increasing returns to shareholders.

Our strategy and the changing media environment

We are now four years into our five year Transformation Plan which is based on our four key priorities. We remain committed to this strategy as the progress we have made over the last four years shows it is the right strategy for ITV.

The demand from viewers for quality content is strong not just in the UK but globally. Linear viewing remains healthy and we must ensure that our Broadcast business continues to be strong, generating significant profits and cash. However, we must not be complacent and we must adapt to the challenges and opportunities of the dynamic media environment in which we operate.

While on demand is still a relatively small part of total viewing, we must make sure that our digital offerings are high quality, competitive and widely available so we can keep up with changing consumer behaviour and demands. We continue to experiment with new free and pay offerings to explore how viewers want to consume our content.

In such a rapidly evolving market, creating and owning high quality content is more important than ever, so we will continue to invest in a quality creative pipeline and exploit our advantage as an integrated producer broadcaster.

2014 and beyond

The television advertising market continues to show signs of improvement with ITV Family NAR expected to be up 5% to 6% in the four months to the end of April. We expect to outperform our estimate of the television advertising market over the full year. Our good on-screen performance in 2013,  the strong 2014 schedule including the FIFA World Cup in June and the advertising deals we have done to date, puts us in a good position to achieve this.

Online, Pay & Interactive should deliver another year of good revenue growth as we continue to exploit opportunities in digital media and drive new revenue streams. Our new pay channel, ITV Encore, which will launch on Sky in 2014, will contribute towards this.

We anticipate good revenue growth in ITV Studios, primarily driven by the recent acquisitions we have made in the UK and internationally. Key to our success is creative content and therefore we will continue to invest in the pipeline of ideas and look at potential acquisitions and partnerships.

We remain committed to our strategy of rebalancing ITV and expect all parts of the business to see further growth in 2014. While a healthy broadcast business remains at the core of ITV, going forward we expect growth to increasingly come from Online, Pay & Interactive and from ITV Studios internationally.

Performance Dashboard

1 Create a lean, creatively dynamic and fit-for-purpose organisation

Milestones achieved

·     Record employee engagement at 91%

·     Rolled out ITV rebrand across all of ITV

·     £28 million of cost savings - £118 million since 2009

·     Fourth year of double digit profit growth

·     Improved group margin by 3% points to 26%

·     Net cash of £164 million after increase in shareholder returns

·     Cash conversion again over the 90% three year rolling target

Focus for 2014

·     Maintain high levels of employee engagement in ITV

·     Further simplify our operating structures as we grow in scale and geography

·     £10 million cost savings target

·     Relentless focus on cash

·     Maintain a robust, efficient and flexible balance sheet

KPIs

·     Employee Engagement

 

2 Maximise audience and revenue share from our existing free-to-air broadcast business

Milestones achieved

·     Best ITV Family SOV year-on-year performance for ten years

·     Increased variety and quality of schedule

·     ITV2 and 3 largest digital channels

·     ITV NAR grew 2% as TV ad market returned to growth

·     Innovative sponsorship and brand extension partnerships with advertisers

·     Sales team were awarded 'Sales Team of the Year' in 2013 at the Media Week Awards

·     Won six National Television Awards

Focus for 2014

·     Maintain strong on-screen viewing performance

·     Launch new free to air channel ITVBe

·     Expect to outperform our estimate of the TV ad market

·     Drive further value from 30 second spot and related revenues

·     Implement new ten year licence

KPIs

·     ITV Family Share of Viewing (SOV)

·     ITV Family Share of Commercial Impacts (SOCI)

·     ITV Family Share of Broadcast (SOB)

 

3 Drive new revenue streams by exploiting our content across multiple platforms, free and pay

Milestones achieved

·     Further improved quality of ITV Player

·     ITV content available on 19 platforms

·     Long form video requests up 16%

·     11.7 million downloads of ITV Player app

·     Renegotiated deals with BT and Virgin and extended Virgin deal to include ITV2, 3, 4 HD channels

·     Trialling direct to consumer pay opportunities

·     3.5 million registered users of ITV Player

Focus for 2014

·     Continue to improve quality of ITV Player

·     Increase distribution of ITV Player

·     Launch new pay channel, ITV Encore

·     Implement new deal with Sky which was renegotiated at the start of 2014

·     Develop further innovative and targeted advertising opportunities

·     Launch advertising on catch up on Sky and Virgin

KPIs

·     Total long form video request

 

4 Build a strong international content business

Milestones achieved

·     20% growth in total revenue driven particularly by international

·     24% growth in EBITA

·     ITV Studios' share of ITV output increased to 59%

·     Investing in creative pipeline - 121 new commissions

·     Creating programmes that return and travel

·     Eight programmes that are produced in three or more countries

·     Completed four acquisitions in UK and US

Focus for 2014

·     Invest in creative talent and pilots to maintain a healthy pipeline

·     Focus on long running returnable series

·     Exploit programmes that travel

·     Further strengthen global production capabilities as we become an increasingly international business

·     Continue to look at potential acquisitions

·     Scale international distribution business

KPIs

·     Number of new commissions for ITV Studios

·     Percentage of ITV output from ITV Studios

 

KPIs across all four priorities

·     EBITA before exceptional items

·     Adjusted earnings per share

·     'Profit to cash' conversion

·     Non-NAR revenues

 

Strategic Priority 1
Create a lean, creatively dynamic and fit-for-purpose organisation

In 2013 we have again made significant progress in making ITV lean, creatively dynamic and fit-for-purpose.

We continue to make ITV a better business both creatively and commercially, through driving out complexity, developing our people, driving cultural change throughout the organisation, investing in our core systems and technologies, and in our brand.

As well as operating efficiently it is vital that we also operate responsibly. Our behaviour impacts our employees, our shareholders, our viewers, the wider community and the environment. Our Corporate Responsibility strategy, which is aligned to our four key priorities, aims to help grow our business by strengthening stakeholder pride and loyalty in ITV, as well as mitigating the risks to the business. Ensuring the welfare and human rights of our employees is a key consideration in our day-to-day activity, both in the UK and internationally, and we use United Nations human rights frameworks as guiding principles.

This report highlights issues which are material to our business strategy. However, our commitment goes beyond the business plan and regulatory requirements. As a responsible industry leader we undertake a number of initiatives that demonstrate our commitment to behaving responsibly and to a sustainable future for our industry, which can be found on our website.

Our people

Our people are key to the success of ITV. It is essential that we develop and support them so that we can attract and retain the best talent. We measure our employee engagement annually and we are pleased to see it has again improved to 91% (2012: 88%), which compares to a benchmark for comparable company surveys of 77%.  Employee participation has also increased to 88% (2012: 80%), which compares to a benchmark of 69%.

We have continued to simplify the way we operate and to increasingly work as One ITV. This makes it easier for people to do their jobs and to help deliver value from our integrated producer broadcaster model and to drive future growth. However, there is still more we can do.

ITV at the heart of popular culture

At the start of 2013 we successfully rolled out the ITV rebrand with the emphasis on putting ITV at the heart of popular culture. This was one of the most extensive media rebrands ever undertaken and was developed in-house by ITV Creative. We rolled out a new identity for our five channels, our entire online estate, and our production and distribution businesses in the UK and internationally, all on the same day. The rebrand has significantly improved ITV's brand health as measured by YouGov and has helped make ITV the 'most loved' commercial network in 2013.

Relentless focus on cash and costs

In 2013 we delivered £28 million of cost savings, £8 million ahead of the original target. These savings are largely not employee related. Since 2009 we have taken £118 million of costs out of the business. These savings have funded our investment in our creative and commercial capabilities, specifically in our creative pipeline, in technology and online.

Our focus on costs and cash has enabled us to significantly strengthen and improve the efficiency of our balance sheet. Our cash generation remains strong with free cash flow up over £100 million year-on-year.  Profit to cash conversion was 97% and we have ended the year with net cash of £164 million even after significant investment in acquisitions, property and returns to shareholders. We have also continued to improve the efficiency of the balance sheet with £211 million of debt buybacks (nominal) and the redemption of the convertible bond, both of which deliver significant interest cost savings for 2014 and beyond.

The steps we have taken on the balance sheet along with another period of double digit profit growth has led the Board to propose a final dividend of 2.4p (2012: 1.8p) giving a full year dividend of 3.5p (2012: 2.6p) - an increase of 35%. The Board is committed to a progressive dividend, taking into account the outlook for the business, while balancing the need to invest for growth and to maintain a robust financial position.

In addition to the final dividend, the Board is proposing a special dividend of 4.0p per share (£161 million). The cash distribution reflects the Board's confidence in the ongoing growth and cash generation of the business. Going forward we will continue to show capital discipline and balance the need to invest for future growth with increasing returns to shareholders.

2014 and beyond

We have made great strides in creating a better business and we will continue to make further improvements across the organisation in 2014.

We will maintain our focus on costs but, given the savings we have made to date, further significant savings are getting harder to achieve. For 2014 we have identified a further £10 million of non-network programme budget cost savings.

It is essential that while we remain operationally and financially fit-for-purpose, we must balance cost and cash discipline with the need to invest in the business. The balance sheet we now have gives us the flexibility to invest where appropriate to drive future growth and improve shareholder returns.

Corporate Responsibility

People and diversity

Ensuring our culture, environment and processes are inclusive is essential to helping us attract diversity amongst the skills, experience and make-up of our workforce. As an example of our leadership and commitment ITV currently chairs the Creative Diversity Network, whose remit is to take joint industry responsibility for action on diversity.

Environmental matters and social, community and human rights issues: More details can be found on our Corporate Responsibility website, while the greenhouse gas disclosures are included in the Directors' Report.

 

Strategic Priority 2

Maximise audience and revenue share from our existing free-to-air broadcast business

A strong broadcast business is central to our strategy. As a business it generates significant profits and cash and its content can be repackaged to drive new revenues. As an integrated producer broadcaster, our family of broadcast channels provides a platform on which to make ITV Studios content famous before exploiting it internationally.

ITV Family NAR grown by 2%

In 2013, ITV Family NAR grew by 2% based on pure spot advertising. This is slightly behind our estimate of the television advertising market, up 3%. However, it is getting increasingly difficult to measure the market as all broadcasters have differing definitions and therefore include sources of revenue other than pure spot advertising.

Since 2009 we have grown our Share of Broadcast (SOB) from 44.7% to 45.4% in 2013. We have achieved this through the quality of our schedule and the unrivalled reach that ITV offers. ITV is the UK's strongest marketing platform, delivering the mass audiences which are so much in demand from advertisers. In 2013 ITV delivered 99.9% of all commercial audiences over five million viewers and 100% of audiences over six million.

Our digital channels, ITV2, 3 and 4, provide more targeted demographics, which together with ITV main channel, ensures that we deliver both mass and targeted reach.

Our broadcast performance has helped to drive 3% growth in Broadcast & Online revenues to £1,896 million.

Strong on-screen performance

The improved quality and variety of the schedule has driven a consistently strong on-screen performance throughout 2013. ITV Family SOV was up 4% over the full year - the best year-on-year performance for over ten years. ITV main channel SOV was up 3%, ITV main channel SOCI was up 1% and ITV Family SOCI was flat. ITV digital channels performed broadly in line with last year.

ITV had many on-screen successes in the year with both new and returning programmes. Based on the series average, ITV broadcast the highest rating drama with Downton Abbey, the highest rating new drama launch with Broadchurch and highest rating entertainment programme with I'm A Celebrity Get Me Out of Here! Other notable successes include Lewis, Poirot, Mr Selfridge, Doc Martin, Ant & Dec's Saturday Night Takeaway, The Chase, Tipping Point, Paul O'Grady: For the Love of Dogs, and Her Majesty's Prison: Aylesbury. Our sports programming again delivered good audiences, in particular the Champions' League and England international friendlies.

The strong on-screen performance is not just due to the success of these new and returning series. Much of our core schedule, in particular Coronation Street, Emmerdale and our News programmes, have all performed strongly in 2013. Coronation Street was the highest rating soap, and for the first time Emmerdale had a higher average share of viewers than Eastenders over the year. Both our national and regional news programmes have grown their audience share as we remain committed to providing high quality, impartial news.

The improved quality of ITV channels has again been recognised publicly in 2013 with ITV winning Channel of the Year at the Edinburgh Television Festival and ITV2 winning digital channel of the year at the Broadcast Digital Awards. ITV also won six National Television Awards including most popular serial drama for Coronation Street and most popular entertainment programme for I'm a Celebrity Get Me Out Of Here!

ITV2 and ITV3 remain the two largest digital channels in the UK and our digital channels again aired successful new and returning programmes, including Tricked, The Big Reunion, Duck Dynasty, Plebs, Celebrity Juice, The Only Way is Essex, The Tour de France and The French Open.

Our viewing performance is clearly healthy but there remain areas we would like to improve. While overall the digital channels performed well, ITV4's performance was slightly disappointing and the early daytime schedule on ITV has not performed as well as we had hoped. We will continue to rejuvenate some of our programmes and trial new ideas across our channels. We aim to increase our success rate in launching new programmes through research, viewer panels and pilots.

Our advertising is sold based upon the on-screen performance in the previous year and therefore our strong viewing performance in 2013 puts us in good stead for 2014.

During 2013 we experienced a number of transmission outages on our channels. High quality transmission is an absolute priority for ITV and we have a number of projects ongoing to ensure our transmission and distribution technologies are fit-for-purpose.

Maximising the value of our airtime

We compete with broadcasters and other media for our share of television advertising and advertising revenues in general. We aim to maximise the value of our 30 second spot and drive related revenue streams through sponsorship, interactivity and brand extensions. For example, the successful sponsorship campaigns and off-air endorsements including Morrisons with Ant & Dec's Saturday Night Takeaway, Tesco Finest with Downton Abbey, and Boots and This Morning. Following the successful broadcast of The Big Reunion on ITV2 in 2013 we also launched the live Big Reunion Tour and recommissioned the programme.

Traditional broadcast model remains robust

While the media environment is developing rapidly, the traditional television broadcast model remains structurally robust. On demand viewing is growing fast, but it remains around 3% of total viewing and people continue to watch around four hours of television a day.

We must ensure that even though our Broadcast business is strong we continue to make our digital offerings more widely available and competitive.

Renewal of licence

In February 2014, ITV's Public Service Broadcasting licences were renewed for a full ten years which gives us the certainty we require to continue to invest for the long term in our broadcast business and high quality content.

2014 and ahead

As we look into 2014 and beyond we must continue to focus on delivering a strong on-screen performance by offering a rich and varied schedule, including our new free to air lifestyle and reality channel ITVBe. There will be both challenges and opportunities. From the second half of 2015 we will no longer hold the live rights for the Champions' League but this will potentially open up parts of the schedule which will give us an opportunity to invest more in ITV Studios content.

The television advertising market continues to show signs of improvement with ITV Family NAR expected to be up 5% to 6% in the four months to the end of April. Over the full year we expect to outperform our estimate of the television advertising market. Our on-screen performance in 2013 and our strong schedule for 2014, including the FIFA World Cup and the advertising deals we have done, puts us in a good position to achieve this.

Corporate Responsibility

Using the power of our reach to inspire, engage and empower people to make a positive difference in our society.

ITV together with its much loved channels, popular programmes, celebrities and viewers have helped raise millions for charitable causes in 2013.

Social action has also been at the heart of many of our Corporate Responsibility campaigns in the form of volunteering and community action - often in collaboration with charities and other UK-wide social action organisations.
Responsible programming and complying with Ofcom's Broadcasting Code is absolutely key for ITV.

 

Strategic Priority 3

Drive new revenue streams by exploiting our content across multiple platforms, free and pay

Online, Pay & Interactive are fast growing new revenue streams which we are driving from distributing our content across a range of platforms, both free and pay. This is either by selling advertising around our content online or pay revenues through licensing our content to third party platform owners or, to a lesser extent, through transactions directly with the consumer through ITV Player. 

In 2013 we have continued to increase the quality and the availability of ITV Player and further developed our pay services. This, combined with the continued growing demand for watching our content via non-traditional channels as well as linear channels, has seen us again deliver strong growth, with revenues up 16% to £118 million.

Online advertising

Over the last few years we have invested to improve the quality of our online offering and ITV Player is now fit to compete with the best in the digital market. In 2013 we continued to enhance our online offering with improvements to the ITV Sports and ITV News sites.

We have also been working to increase the distribution of ITV content digitally so that it is available when and how people want to watch it. Our content is now available on 19 platforms.

The rapid increase in video on demand (VOD) is adding to a huge demand for quality content, both free and pay, and as an integrated producer broadcaster we are in a unique position to create value from this. Mobile and tablet viewing is driving VOD and there have now been over 11.7 million downloads of the ITV Player app since it was launched.

The increased quality and distribution of the ITV Player has led to continued good growth in long form video requests, which were up 16% in 2013. Advertiser demand continues to be strong for ITV's VOD and we must manage our advertising load to meet that demand while maintaining a good user experience.

 

Pay services

As consumer viewing behaviour evolves, we continue to explore, experiment and develop our pay services - both direct-to-consumer and to broadcasters and platform owners. We have trialled pay opportunities on the ITV Player with episode premieres of programmes such as Scott & Bailey for ITV and Plebs for ITV2, and have offered box sets to download to rent. We have also launched an ad free subscription model on iOS - the first broadcaster to do so.

During the year we renegotiated a number of our current deals with platform owners and also agreed a number of new deals to make our content available on more platforms.

We renewed our deals with BT and Lovefilm and we have renegotiated our Virgin deal to include HD versions of ITV2, 3 and 4 and to enable us to deliver adverts in our catch up content in the future. We have agreed deals with Amazon for transactional VOD, simulcast channels with Everything Everywhere and a catch up service on Virgin Atlantic. We have also launched ITV Essentials, an international catch up service for our Soaps.

In January 2014 we announced that we will be launching our first pay channel, ITV Encore, on Sky.  As part of the wider deal with Sky, ITV content will also be made available through Sky's range of connected platforms including Sky Go, Now TV and Sky Store.

Interactivity

We are further deepening our relationship with our viewers and ITV Player now has 3.5 million registered users. We are increasing our interaction and consumer engagement through competitions, voting, second screens and through social media to drive more value from our brands for ITV and for our advertisers.

2014 and beyond

We expect to again deliver double digit revenue growth in Online, Pay & Interactive in 2014. Our online revenues will grow through the increased distribution of ITV Player and through increased consumer demand. In 2014 we will start to deliver stitched advertising in our catch up services on Sky and Virgin. We continue to develop our pay services and during 2014 we will launch ITV Encore.

Corporate Responsibility

Building trust online

We strive to continue to build trust and confidence in our digital platforms, applying the same standards online as we do on air.

We listen to the issues that matter to our viewers, in particular safeguarding children, protection of personal data and accessibility to our programmes.  

 

Strategic Priority 4

Build a strong international content business

A strong international content business lies at the heart of our strategy to create and own more of our own content, make it famous in the UK on our channels and distribute it across multiple platforms in the UK and internationally. As an integrated producer broadcaster we are in a unique position to do this.

The high demand globally for quality content from broadcasters and platform owners provides a significant opportunity for us. We are building real momentum as we continue to invest in a strong and healthy creative pipeline in the key creative markets and specifically in genres that return and travel - drama, entertainment and factual entertainment, good examples of which are Mr Selfridge, Come Dine With Me and The Chase.

In 2013 we delivered a 20% increase in total ITV Studios revenue with good performances across the business - particularly driven by international production - and 24% growth in EBITA. We delivered good organic growth and are building on this with the acquisitions we have made both in the UK and internationally. Our portfolio of acquisitions are performing in line with our expectations and we will continue to look at further acquisitions which fit with our strict strategic and financial criteria.

The strong performance in 2013 builds upon the significant progress we have made over the last few years. While there is still a great deal to do, ITV is now an international studios business - we are the number one commercial producer in the UK, a top five independent producer in the US and the third largest European distributor of television content.

UK Production

In the UK we have increased our production revenues by 12%. Growth has come in particular from drama, entertainment and factual, with original hours commissioned in these genres up 55%, 16% and 49% respectively, including the benefit of our acquisitions. Growth also came both on and off ITV. We have again increased ITV Studios' share of ITV output, which increased to 59%, up from 50% in 2009.

On ITV we have delivered new commissions including Lucan, Big Star's Little Star and Tricked. As we focus on programmes that return and travel, our recommissions are very important. We are building a track record for producing programmes that return, including Mr Selfridge, Ant & Dec's Saturday Night Takeaway and Surprise Surprise, which all have international appeal.

Off ITV our new commissions include Pressure Pad for the BBC and Kingfishers for Discovery while our recommissions include Graham Norton, Shetland and University Challenge for the BBC, and 24 Hours in A&E, Friday Night Dinner and Come Dine with Me for Channel 4.

 

International Production

Our international production business continues to grow very strongly, with revenues up 56%, driven by the US.

Our US businesses have secured a number of new commissions such as The Chase, which was originally commissioned in the UK, and many recommissions of programmes which demonstrate their longevity and their international appeal. These included Hell's Kitchen which broadcast its 11th series in 2013, Kitchen Nightmares which broadcast its 5th series, Cake Boss which broadcast its 6th series and is developing spin-off shows, and Duck Dynasty which has broken cable viewing records in the US and is now also on ITV4. A number of these shows have already been recommissioned which will be reflected in the 2014/5 results.

Our other international production bases in Australia, Germany, France and the Nordics also produce their own original formats and versions of UK formats. Their original formats include Der Letzte Bulle in Germany, Mad As Hell in Australia and Night Patrol in Norway. UK formats produced locally include I'm a Celebrity Get Me Out Of Here! and The Audience in Germany, Four Weddings in France and Hell's Kitchen in the Nordics. They have also secured a number of new commissions for 2014 including UK formats, such as Hell's Kitchen in Germany.

Global Entertainment

The growth in the UK and international production businesses is starting to feed our international distribution arm, whose revenues were up 2% to £135 million. 

Global Entertainment's successes in the year include Mr Selfridge, Poirot, Marple, Lewis and Hell's Kitchen US, which have all now been sold to over 150 countries. We also continue to sell formats successfully, for example Come Dine with Me, Four Weddings and The Chase, and we now have eight programmes sold in three or more countries. As well as distributing ITV's own content we are adding to our catalogue through the distribution of third party content, such as Rectify for AMC and River Monsters for Icon Films. We are seeing strong growth in sales to digital platforms which is more than offsetting the decline in DVD sales.

We have delivered revenue growth in the period, but it takes time for the creative pipeline to flow through and the market for third party rights remains very competitive.

Acquisitions

Our acquisitions focus to date is on the two key markets which have a track record for creating and owning intellectual property, namely the UK and US. We are looking for companies that have a good creative pipeline and produce in genres that have the potential to travel.

In the UK we are seeking to enhance our skills in key genres. In 2013 we acquired UK producers The Garden and Big Talk to increase our capability in creating factual entertainment and comedy formats that travel and in delivering commissions for other broadcasters.

In the US we continued to build strength and scale with the most recent acquisitions of High Noon and Thinkfactory who produce reality, entertainment and drama programmes, such as Cake Boss and R&B Divas. These complement our existing business, including Gurney Productions which we acquired at the end of 2012.

2014 and beyond

In 2014 we again anticipate good growth, primarily driven by the acquisitions we have made in the UK and internationally. As ever ITV's revenue growth will not be a straight line because of the phasing of the delivery schedule required by our network and cable customers. A challenge for the UK business is that ITV main channel will be spending less on original commissions given the World Cup cost in the first half of 2014.

We will continue to invest in our creative pipeline to develop programmes that return and travel and we will also look at potential acquisitions in the key creative markets. Our international production business will remain a key focus as the demand for quality content globally continues to grow and will increasingly be the main driver for ITV Studios growth.

On 19 February 2014 we acquired a 51% controlling interest in DiGa Vision, a US independent producer of reality and scripted programming. There is a put and call option to buy the remainder of the company over three to six years.

Corporate Responsibility
Responsible programming

Through our programming we aim to tackle and portray social and community issues that are relevant to our audience, in an appropriate manner. As an international content producer we understand the influence and impact our content can have on society. 

Beyond our regulatory requirements we strive to produce content that is relevant for a global market and authentically portrays its audience. 

 

Performance and Financials
A review of Operational and Financial performance in 2013

Key Performance Indicators

We have defined our Key Performance Indicators (KPIs) to align our performance and accountability to our strategy.  These KPIs will be the key measures of success and cover all four strategic priorities.

 

EBITA before exceptional items

This is the key profitability measure used across the whole business. Earnings before interest, tax and amortisation before exceptional items ('EBITA') reflects our performance in a consistent manner and in line with how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis.

Related Priority 1,2,3,4

Performance

In 2013 this has increased by £107 million or 21%. This is as a result of the 9% growth in external revenues, driven by significant growth in non-NAR and 2% increase in NAR, and our continued focus on costs delivering £28 million of savings in 2013. Since 2009 EBITA has increased by over 200%. 

The Group margin has improved year on year, up three percentage points to 26%.

 

Adjusted earnings per share

Adjusted earnings per share represents the adjusted profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders. Adjusted profit is defined as profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders before exceptional items, impairment of intangible assets, amortisation of intangible assets acquired through business combinations, net financing cost adjustments and other tax adjustments.

It reflects the business performance of the Group in a consistent manner and in line with how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis.

Related Priority 1,2,3,4

Performance

Adjusted earnings per share has increased by 2.1p, a 23% increase year-on-year to 11.2p. This reflects the improvement in revenue and profit and the reduction in adjusted financing costs as we improve the efficiency of the balance sheet.

Since 2009 adjusted earnings per share has increased by over 500%.

 

'Profit to cash' conversion

'Profit to cash' conversion represents the proportion of EBITA converted into a measure of adjusted cash flow (defined as cash generated from operations before exceptional items less cash related to the acquisition of operating property, plant and equipment and intangible assets).

A key priority is to keep tight control on cash and costs and this measure primarily reflects our working capital management and capital expenditure control. As such, it remains ITV's aim to keep this 'profit to cash' conversion as high as possible, and in excess of 90% on a rolling three year basis.

 

Related Priority 1,2,3,4

Performance

Profit to cash conversion is again over 90% which is our rolling three year target. This is despite significant capital expenditure. This demonstrates our continued focus on working capital management which has helped drive a significant improvement in our cash position.

 

Employee engagement

To turn ITV into a world-class organisation that is lean, creatively dynamic and fit-for-purpose requires high quality employees who are engaged in the work that they do, and are committed to the strategy.

Employee engagement measures pride in the work we do, pride in working for ITV and also what we say about our programmes and services.

Related Priority 1

Performance

Employee engagement has again improved year on year to 91% which indicates employees' pride in ITV and their commitment to supporting change across the business. Company participation was also high at 88%.

These measures are well above benchmark as well as having improved year-on-year.

 

ITV Family Share of Viewing (SOV)

Strategic priority 2 aims to maximise audience share from our existing free-to-air broadcast business, and ITV Family Share of Viewing (SOV) is the clearest indicator of this. ITV Family SOV is ITV's share of the total viewing audience over the year achieved by ITV's family of channels as a proportion of total television viewing, including the BBC family. ITV aims to at least maintain the ITV Family SOV.

 

Related Priority 2

Performance

ITV Family SOV had its strongest year-on-year performance for ten years, up 4%, as we further improved the quality and breadth of the schedule.

 

ITV Family Share of Commercial Impacts (SOCI)

Strategic priority 2 aims to maximise audience share from our existing free-to-air broadcast business, and ITV Family Share of Commercial Impacts (SOCI) is another key indicator of this. SOCI is the trading currency in the television advertising market, and since it only covers commercial television it does not include the BBC. This is the share of total UK television commercial impacts which is delivered by ITV's family of channels. An impact is one viewer watching one 30 second commercial. We aim to maximise our SOCI.

 

Related Priority 2

Performance

ITV Family SOCI was flat year-on-year.  ITV main channel was up 1%, however, offsetting this was the performance of ITV4, which did not perform as well as we had hoped. 

 

ITV Family Share of Broadcast (SOB)

ITV's share of UK television advertising revenues is known as its Share of Broadcast (SOB). To maximise revenues from our free-to-air business, which is a key component of strategic priority 2, we aim to continue to maximise our SOB and to outperform the UK television advertising market.

It is getting increasingly difficult to measure the total television advertising market as all broadcasters have differing definitions and therefore include sources of revenue other than pure spot advertising.

Related Priority 2

Performance

ITV SOB was slightly down year on year. In 2014 we expect to outperform our estimate of the television advertising market over the full year. Our on-screen performance in 2013, the strong schedule for 2014 including the FIFA World Cup, and the advertising deals we have done, puts us in a good position to achieve this.

 

Total long form video requests

Our strategy looks to drive new revenue streams by exploiting our content across multiple platforms.

Long form video requests is a measure of the total number of our videos viewed across all platforms (such as itv.com, Virgin, Sky and mobile devices) and therefore provides a key measure of how much of our content is being viewed online.

A long form video is a programme that has been broadcast on television and is available to watch online and on demand in its entirety.

 

Related Priority 3

Performance

Long form video requests were up 16% at 577 million. We have improved the quality of ITV Player and increased the distribution of our content onto more platforms. ITV content is now available on 19 platforms. Growth in long form video requests has been driven by mobile and tablet viewing.

 

Non-NAR revenues

Growing non-NAR revenues is key to the strategy as we aim to rebalance the business away from our reliance on television advertising revenues. Non-NAR revenues include all ITV revenues, both internal and external, except net advertising revenues (NAR).

Key drivers of non-NAR revenue are the growth in Online, Pay & Interactive and Studios, particularly international.

 

Related Priority 2,3,4

Performance

Non-NAR revenues have grown by 17% in 2013 as we continue to rebalance the business. Non-NAR growth is driven by Studios revenues - particularly international - and Online, Pay & Interactive.

 

Number of new commissions for ITV Studios

A key indicator of the creative renewal pipeline is the number of new commissions won. This figure includes programmes shown both on ITV and on other broadcasters, and both in the UK and internationally.

 

Related Priority 4

Performance

The number of new commissions has increased in 2013 as we continue to invest in our creative pipeline both organically and through acquisitions.

 

Percentage of ITV* output from ITV Studios

This represents the proportion of the total spend on original commissions on ITV transmitted in the year, delivered by ITV Studios. A key part of building a strong international content business, is to increase ITV Studios' supply of programmes to ITV, where we aim to make them famous and then sell them around the world.

* Excludes ITV2, 3 and 4.

Related Priority 4

Performance

The percentage of ITV output from ITV Studios has increased again this year to 59%. The improvement has been driven by an increase in Drama commissions.

 

Financial and Performance Review

Ian Griffiths

 

Delivering revenue growth in all parts of the business

We have again delivered a strong set of results with good revenue growth and double digit profit growth. There was growth from all parts of the business, our acquisitions are making a material contribution and the relentless focus on costs and cash is evident in our healthy financial position.  We ended the year with £164 million of net cash even after significant investment across the business and increased returns to shareholders.

Twelve months to
31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Change

£m

Change

%

Net Advertising Revenue ('NAR')

1,542

1,510

32

2

Total non-NAR revenue

1,211

1,036

175

17

Total revenue

2,753

2,546

207

8

Internal supply

(364)

(350)

(14)

(4)

Total external supply

2,389

2,196

193

9

EBITA before exceptional items

620

513

107

21

Group EBITA Margin

26%

23%



Adjusted earnings per share

11.2p

9.1p

2.1p

23

Adjusted diluted earnings per share

10.8p

8.7p

2.1p

24

Dividend per share

3.5p

2.6p

0.9p

35

Special dividend

4.0p

4.0p

-

-

Net cash as at
31 December

164

206

(42)


 

The profit before tax (PBT) and earnings per share (EPS) from the Consolidated Income Statement are as follows:

Twelve months to

31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Change

£m

Change

%

Profit before tax

435

334

101

30

Earnings per share (EPS)

8.3p

6.6p

1.7p

26

Diluted earnings per share

8.1p

6.4p

1.7p

27

 

External revenues were up 9%. Total non-NAR revenues grew £175 million (17%) and ITV Family NAR was up 2%.

This revenue growth, combined with our tight cost management and our higher margin new revenue streams, saw us deliver 21% growth in EBITA to £620 million and 23% growth in adjusted EPS to 11.2p. Group margins improved by three percentage points to 26%.

We again maintained our focus on cash and costs. We delivered £28 million of cost savings, £8 million ahead of our original target and our tight working capital management has delivered a strong profit to cash ratio at 97%, again above our 90% rolling three year target. We have continued to take steps to improve the efficiency of the balance sheet having bought back £211 million of gross debt and exercised our right to redeem the convertible bond. Together, these actions have reduced our level of total debt to £354 million and further reduced our financing costs.

The Financial and Performance Review focuses on the adjusted results, which in management's view shows our business performance in a more meaningful and consistent manner and reflects how the business is managed and measured on a daily basis. A reconciliation to the reported results is set out in the earnings per share section that follows.

Adjusted profit before tax and adjusted EPS remove the effect of exceptional items which include acquisition related costs (professional fees, primarily due diligence, and performance based employment linked contingent payments), impairment of intangible assets, amortisation of intangible assets acquired through business combinations, net financing cost adjustments and other tax adjustments.

Following revisions to IAS 19, we are required to restate our prior period results which have resulted in the following:


2012 as originally reported

2012

(restated)

Income statement impact

Net Financing Costs

(99)

(106)

(7)

Broadcast & Online EBITA

413

406

(7)

Group EBITA

520

513

(7)

Tax Charge

(80)

(77)

3

PBT

348

334

(14)

PAT (excl. NCI)

267

256

(11)

Adjusted PBT

464

457

(7)

Adjusted Tax Charge

(105)

(104)

1

Adjusted PAT (excl NCI)

358

352

(6)

EPS

6.9

6.6

(0.3)

Diluted EPS

6.7

6.4

(0.3)

Adjusted EPS

9.2

9.1

(0.1)

Diluted Adjusted EPS

8.9

8.7

(0.2)

 

Broadcast & Online

Twelve months to

31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Change

£m

Change

%

Net Advertising

Revenue ('NAR')

1,542

1,510

32

2

SDN external revenues

71

62

9

15

Online, Pay & Interactive

118

102

16

16

Other commercial income

165

160

5

3

Broadcast & Online non-NAR revenue

354

324

30

9

Total Broadcast & Online revenue

1,896

1,834

62

3

Total schedule costs

(983)

(996)

13

1

Other costs

(426)

(432)

6

1

Total Broadcast & Online EBITA before exceptional items

487

406

81

20

Broadcast & Online EBITA margin

26%

22%



 

Broadcast & Online delivered a strong performance.  Revenues were up £62 million (3%) and with tight control of costs and growth in new higher margin revenues, we delivered an £81 million (20%) increase in EBITA. 

Revenue growth was driven by a 16% increase in Online, Pay & Interactive revenues and 2% growth in ITV Family NAR as the television advertising market returned to growth. The television advertising market again showed significant fluctuations across the year, often driven by the timing of sporting events or programmes delivering large audiences. ITV Family NAR was down 3% in the first half of the year as there were tough comparatives in Q2 caused by the absence of a big sporting event but this recovered over the second half which was up 8%. In 2014 with the FIFA World Cup in Q2 we expect again to see significant variations by quarter.

There also continues to be volatility by sector. In 2013 we continued to see strong demand from advertising sectors driven by technology and highly competitive industries. Good growth was seen in entertainment & leisure, telecommunications, cars, publishing & broadcasting, airlines & holidays and household stores.  While retail as a whole did not show significant growth as the high street subsector remained weak, supermarkets did spend more. Finance declined year-on-year driven by banks and building societies. Food was weak due to the margin pressure being experienced within the sector.

Over the full year, ITV NAR based on pure spot advertising was up 2% which is slightly behind our estimate of the television advertising market up 3%. However, it is getting increasingly difficult to measure the market as all broadcasters have differing definitions and therefore include sources of revenue other than pure spot advertising.

In 2014 we expect to outperform the television advertising market. Our on-screen performance in 2013, the strong schedule for 2014 including the FIFA World Cup, and the advertising deals we have done, puts us in a good position to achieve this.

SDN revenues increased 15% benefiting from the launch of the 12th and 13th video streams in the year. No similar one-off benefit is expected in 2014.

Online, Pay & Interactive revenues grew strongly, up 16% to £118 million. Within this, online advertising revenues increased as long form video requests grew 16%, which has been helped by our continued improvement in the quality and distribution and the enhanced offerings of itv.com and ITV Player. Our pay revenues have also grown as we have renegotiated deals with Virgin, BT and Lovefilm. These pay revenues are mainly from platform owners paying us for our channels. Our content is now available on 19 platforms. Our interactive revenues, which include competitions and voting, have been broadly flat year-on-year but we continue to drive engagement and interaction with our content.

Other commercial income includes sponsorship, minority revenues, media sales and other income. In total these are up 3%, with growth coming from sponsorship and brand extensions as we have broadened our commercial relationship with our advertisers, for example with Morrisons sponsoring Ant & Dec's Saturday Night Takeaway which included a full brand endorsement of Morrisons and Ant & Dec TV adverts.

Schedule costs were down as a result of the savings we have secured on our FA Cup and Champions League rights and lower overall sports costs as there has been no large one-off sporting event. This has enabled us to invest in more hours of drama and entertainment, including programmes from ITV Studios. Other costs were flat as we manage our overheads tightly which has mitigated inflationary pressures and funded our investment in the business.

ITV Studios

Twelve months to
31 December

2013

£m

2012

£m

Change

£m

Change

%

UK Productions

456

408

48

12

International Productions

266

171

95

56

Global Entertainment

135

133

2

2

Total Studios revenue

857

712

145

20

Total Studios costs

(724)

(605)

(119)

(20)

Total Studios EBITA before exceptional items

133

107

26

24

Studios EBITA margin

16%

15%



Sales from ITV Studios to Broadcasting & Online

364

350

14

4

External revenue

493

362

131

36

Total Studios revenue

857

712

145

20

 

In 2013 we again delivered strong revenue growth, up 20%. All parts of the business performed well, with significant growth coming from International Productions both organically and through the acquisitions we have made.

Through this strong revenue growth, our continued focus on costs and changes in our revenue mix, we delivered 24% growth in EBITA.

Organic revenue growth was 7% and acquisitions delivered just under £100 million of revenue growth and £15 million of EBITA in line with our expectations.

UK Productions grew on and off ITV, with total revenue up 12%. This has been driven by drama, entertainment and factual with programmes such as Mr Selfridge, Lewis, Vera, Ant & Dec's Saturday Night Takeaway and The Chase for ITV as the demand for high quality content has grown. Off ITV we have produced Graham Norton and Shetland for the BBC, 24 Hours in A&E for Channel 4 and Four Weddings for Sky Living.

International Productions grew very strongly, up 56%. This was driven particularly by America for a number of reasons. Firstly they delivered good organic growth with additional volumes of programmes such as Hell's Kitchen. Secondly 2013 was the first full year of owning Gurney Productions, who produce the hugely popular show Duck Dynasty. Finally our other acquisitions also performed well with programmes such as Cake Boss produced by High Noon. We also had a good year in Germany and France with I'm A Celebrity Get Me Out Of Here! and Come Dine With Me in Germany and Four Weddings in France.

The strong growth in our UK and international production businesses is starting to feed our global distribution business, with programmes such as Mr Selfridge, Poirot, Marple, Lewis and Hell's Kitchen US selling to over 150 countries. In addition, eight of our formats have been sold in three or more countries this year, including I'm a Celebrity Get Me Out Of Here!, Dancing on Ice, Coach Trip and The Audience. However, this is a process that does take time. We are seeing strong growth in sales to digital platforms which is more than offsetting the decline in DVD sales.

The majority of costs incurred in ITV Studios vary directly with levels of activity. However, we continue to maintain our focus on costs and to drive efficiencies in the production process. 

Acquisitions

In 2012 and 2013 we acquired a number of content businesses in the UK, the US and the Nordics. These have been made against strict strategic and financial criteria. Financially we look at ownership of intellectual property, return on capital employed and discounted cash flow. Strategically we look at the talent, creative pipeline and type of content to ensure it has the potential to return and travel. We have structured the deals, with earnouts or put and call options, to base a significant part of the consideration, which is capped, on future performance and therefore align incentives and lock in creative talent. To date our portfolio of acquisitions is performing in line with our expectations.

In 2012 we acquired Gurney Productions in the US, So TV in the UK, Mediacircus in Norway and Tarinatalo in Finland. In April 2013 we acquired 100% of the UK independent producer The Garden to enhance our capability in creating factual entertainment formats that travel and to increase our strength in delivering commissions off ITV. We made an upfront payment of £18 million with a further capped cash payment contingent on The Garden's future performance.  In July 2013 we acquired 100% of Big Talk Productions and associated companies (Big Talk) to strengthen our comedy and light entertainment capability. We paid an initial cash consideration of £13 million and there are further capped cash payments contingent on Big Talk's future performance.

In May 2013 in the US we acquired 60% of High Noon Entertainment for an upfront cash consideration of $26 million (£16 million) and in June we acquired 65% of Thinkfactory Media for an upfront cash consideration of $30 million (£19 million), to further build our strength and scale. There are put and call arrangements in place to buy the remaining minority stakes.

The total initial payment for 2012 and 2013 acquisitions is £108 million with a further expected £97 million (undiscounted) payable which is based upon our current view of their performance over the payment period. The total maximum consideration of £293 million (undiscounted contingent consideration of £185 million and initial consideration of £108 million) for all these acquisitions is payable only if the businesses deliver 20-30% compound average annual growth rate in earnings. 

On 19 February 2014 we acquired a 51% controlling interest in DiGa Vision, the US independent producer of reality and scripted programming. There is a put and call option to buy the remainder of the company over three to six years. 

Company

Geography

Genre

Initial consideration

(£m)

Total expected

consideration*

(£m)

Total maximum

consideration*

(£m)

Expected

payment

period

2013







The Garden

UK

Factual Entertainment

18

35

46

2018

High Noon

US

Reality, Entertainment

16

34

61

2015-2021

Thinkfactory

US

Reality, Entertainment & Scripted

19

31

61

2017-2019

Big Talk

UK

Comedy & Scripted

13

30

30

2015-2018

Total for 2013



66

130

198


Total for 2012



42

75

95


Total



108

205

293


 

* Undiscounted and including the initial cash consideration. All payments are performance related.

 

Net financing costs

Net adjusted financing costs of £25 million were £19 million lower than last year as a result of the full year benefit of the debt bought back in 2012 and part year benefit of the debt buyback and the redemption of the convertible bond in 2013.

The £61 million of losses on buybacks relate to the exceptional loss on the £211 million (nominal) of debt we bought back in the year. The partial repayment of the 2019 bilateral loan in March of £138 million (nominal) resulted in an exceptional loss of £38 million and will save £48 million of future interest costs.

The £73 million convertible bond buyback, together with the early redemption of the remaining balance for equity, resulted in an exceptional loss of £23 million and will save £16 million of future interest costs as well avoiding the dilution of our shareholders.

In 2012 losses were incurred on the buyback of certain bonds.

In January 2014 we bought back the remaining tranche of the 2019 bilateral loan for £95 million.

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Financing costs directly attributable to loans and bonds

(18)

(38)

Cash-related net financing (costs)/income

(2)

3

Cash-related financing costs

(20)

(35)

Amortisation of bonds

(5)

(9)

Adjusted financing costs

(25)

(44)

Mark-to-market on swaps and foreign exchange

(9)

(11)

Imputed pension interest

(20)

(16)(

Losses on buybacks

(61)

(36)

Other net financial costs

-

1

Net financing costs

(115)

(106)

 

Tax

The effective tax rate on adjusted profit before tax of £581 million is 23% which is comparable to the standard tax rate of 23.25% (2012: the effective tax rate on adjusted profits of 23% was lower than the standard rate of 24.5% due to the adjustments made for prior periods and the recognition of overseas deferred tax credits). The total tax charge is £105 million (2012: £77 million).

Cash tax paid of £67 million (2012: £62 million) arises as a result of making payments for taxable profits partially offset by the use of losses and the tax treatment of allowable pension contributions. The majority of cash tax is paid in
the UK.

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Profit before tax

435

334

Exceptional items (net)

2

12

Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets*

54

49

Adjustments to net financing costs

90

62

Adjusted profit before tax

581

457

 

* In respect of intangible assets arising from business combinations.

 

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Tax charge

(105)

(77)

Charge for exceptional items

(1)

(2)

Charge in respect of amortisation and impairment of intangible assets*

(12)

(12)

Charge in respect of adjustments to net financing costs

(21)

(15)

Other tax adjustments

3

2

Adjusted tax charge

(136)

(104)

Effective tax rate on adjusted profits

23%

23%

 

* In respect of intangible assets arising from business combinations.

 

Dividend

The Board has proposed a final dividend of 2.4p (2012: 1.8p) giving a full year dividend of 3.5p (2012: 2.6p) - an increase of 35% on 2012. The Board is committed to a progressive dividend, taking into account the outlook for the business, while balancing the need to invest for growth and to maintain a robust financial position.

In addition to the final dividend, the Board is proposing a special dividend of 4.0p per share or £161 million (2012: 4p per share special dividend). The cash distribution reflects the Board's confidence in the ongoing growth and cash generation of the business. Going forward we will continue to show capital discipline and balance the need to invest for future growth with increasing returns to shareholders.

Earnings per share

Adjusted earnings per share is 11.2p (2012: 9.1p). Earnings per share is 8.3p (2012: 6.6p).

The main differences between reported and adjusted earnings per share are exceptional items which include acquisition related costs (professional fees, primarily due diligence, and performance based employment linked contingent payments), impairment of intangible assets, amortisation of intangible assets acquired through business combinations, net financing cost adjustments and other tax adjustments.

The adjustments shown below remove the impact of those items that in management's view do not show the performance of the business in a consistent manner and do not reflect how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis.

Twelve months to 31 December 2013

Reported

£m

Adjustments

£m

Adjusted

£m

EBITA before exceptional items

620


620

Exceptional items (operating)

(8)

8

-

Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets

(66)

54

(12)

Net financing costs

(115)

90

(25)

Share of losses of JVs and Associates

(2)

-

(2)

Gain on sale and impairment of subsidiaries and investments (non-operating exceptional items)

6

(6)

-

Profit before tax

435

146

581

Tax

(105)

(31)

(136)

Profit after tax

330


445

Non-controlling interests

(4)


(4)

Earnings

326


441

Shares (million), weighted average

3,929


3,929

Earnings per share (pence)

8.3p


11.2p

 

Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets acquired through business combinations is not included within adjusted earnings. Amortisation of software licences and development is included as management considers these assets to be core to supporting the day-to-day operation of the business.

Operating exceptional items are mainly acquisition related expenses, including professional fees, primarily due diligence, and performance based employment linked contingent payments. There are no restructuring costs in 2013.

Non-operating exceptional items largely relate to the profit on disposal of STV shares in the year resulting in a gain of £6 million.

Cash flow, working capital and free cash flow

Cash flow and working capital management

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

EBITA before exceptional items ('profit')

620

513

(Increase)/decrease in programme rights and other inventory distribution rights

(42)

29

(Increase)/decrease in receivables

(15)

17

Increase/(decrease) in payables

42

(45)

Working capital movement

(15)

1

Depreciation

24

27

Share-based compensation and pension service costs

20

16

Cash flow generated from operations before exceptional items

649

557

Acquisition of property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

(45)

(61)

Adjusted cash flow

604

496

'Profit to cash' ratio

97%

97%*

 

*              Previously reported profit to cash ratio for 2012 was 95%. This has increased to 97% because of the restatement of EBITA.

Our focus on cash remains a priority and we generated £604 million of cash from £620 million of EBITA before exceptional items. This performance is largely due to the continued management of working capital balances. Our profit to cash ratio of 97% has been maintained at a strong level and continues to be ahead of our KPI target of 90% on a three year rolling basis.

This calculation includes £45 million of capital expenditure, which largely relates to the new state-of-the-art Coronation Street set. However, it excludes the acquisition of the Company's London headquarters for £58 million as management considers it to be a material one-off capital expenditure and not a day-to-day operational investment.

Free cash flow

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Adjusted cash flow

604

496

Net interest paid

(24)

(33)

Cash tax

(67)

(62)

Pension funding

(80)

(72)

Free cash flow

433

329

 

Except where disclosed, management views the acquisition of operating property, plant and equipment and intangibles as necessary ongoing investment in the business.

Free cash flow reflects our underlying cash generation and our strong free cash flow generation gives us flexibility to invest in the business and reward our shareholders. This is a key strength of ITV today.

Free cash flow before dividends, acquisitions and debt repayments remains very strong and is up over £100 million (32%) year-on-year, in line with the growth in profits.

Net cash, liquidity risk and funding

Net cash at the year end was £164 million, compared to net debt of £52 million at 30 June 2013 and £206 million net cash at the end of 2012.

One of the key strengths of our business is our strong cash generation but it is weighted to the second half of the year as we make a number of significant payments both regular and one-off in the first half of 2013, including acquisitions, dividends, the pension deficit funding contribution, debt buybacks and the purchase of our London headquarters.  In spite of this investment and shareholder returns we ended the year with similar cash position to 2012.

 

Adjusted net debt

Twelve months to 31 December

2013

£m

2012

£m

Net cash

164

206

Expected contingent payments on acquisitions

(97)

(36)

Pension deficit (IAS 19R)

(445)

(551)

Operating leases

(414)

(518)

Adjusted net debt

(792)

(899)

Adjusted net debt to EBITDA

1.2

1.7

 

Net debt/net cash is one measure of the strength of our financial position. However, we believe it is appropriate to look at all our financial commitments and have developed an adjusted net debt measure, similar to how credit rating agencies could look at our balance sheet. The ratio of adjusted net debt to EBITDA before exceptional items is 1.2. This level of indebtedness is slightly lower than previous years and reflects the improved profitability and strong cash generation of the business as well as reduced lease commitments and a lower pension deficit as measured by IAS 19.

As can be seen from the table, adjusted net debt includes the undiscounted estimate of the contingent payments in relation to all the acquisitions we have made in 2012 and 2013, the pension deficit on an IAS 19 basis, and our operating lease commitments (undiscounted) which are mainly for broadcast transmission contracts and property. Lease commitments have reduced year on year as a result of the acquisition of our London headquarters.

 

Debt structure and liquidity

We continued to strengthen our balance sheet and maintain access to liquidity with our strong underlying cash generation, the £125 million invoice discounting facility and our £250 million Revolving Credit Facility (RCF). In June 2013 we extended the maturity of the RCF by a further year to July 2016. The facility remains undrawn and, subject to agreement by the banks, is extendable by a further year. The facility contains leverage and interest cover financial covenants as is normal for a facility of this nature.

We have bought back over £1.1 billion of debt (including the £73 million of convertible we bought back) since October 2009 and we now have a much more efficient balance sheet. After the year end we bought back the remaining £62 million (nominal) of the March 2019 bank loan (see post balance sheet events). Given what we have bought back over the last few years we do not expect to be able to make any further material changes in the efficiency of our balance sheet.

The debt buybacks in the year were as follows:

·     In March 2013 we repaid £138 million (nominal) of the £200 million covenant free bilateral loan with a maturity of March 2019. This was satisfied by £30 million of cash and by gilts secured against the loan and resulted in an exceptional charge of £38 million. This repayment will save £48 million in future interest costs.

·     During the year we repurchased £73 million (nominal) of the £135 million convertible bond with a maturity date of November 2016 for a cash cost of £169 million.   In September we exercised our right to redeem the outstanding principal amount of the convertible bond. This redemption and conversion process was completed on 21 October and resulted in 95 million new shares being issued. Settling the convertible has resulted in £16 million of interest cost savings over the remaining period of the bond. Partly buying back the debt has avoided the full dilution which would have occurred if the entire convertible had been redeemed. Settling the convertible has also resulted in an exceptional charge of £23 million shown in financing costs and in a net £74 million loss attributable to equity, which has been reflected directly in retained earnings.

The actions we have taken will improve our adjusted financing costs going forward. In 2014 we expect adjusted financing costs to be about £10-£12 million, a saving of around £15 million after the repurchase of the remaining 2019 loan.

 

Financing

We are financed using debt instruments with a range of maturities. Following the buyback of the 2019 loan in January 2014, the remaining debt, other than the finance leases, is publicly traded Eurobond debt. Borrowings at 31 December 2013 (net of currency hedges) are repayable as follows:

Amount repayable

£m

Maturity

€50 million Eurobond*

15

June 2014

£78 million Eurobond

78

Oct 2015

£161 million Eurobond

161

Jan 2017

£62 million Bank loan

62

Mar 2019

Finance leases

38

Various

Total debt repayable on maturity

354


 

* Net of cross currency swaps.
† Bought back in full in January 2014

 

There are no financial covenants on any of our debt instruments, other than the RCF which remains undrawn.

The recent debt buyback of the 2019 loan removes the last of the high coupon debt taken out in 2008/9.

Ratings

Our credit ratings have improved during 2013 with all three ratings agencies upgrading their long-term credit ratings. In March and April respectively, Standard & Poor's and Fitch upgraded our long-term credit rating to investment grade BBB- (Stable outlook). In August Moody's Investors Service also upgraded their long-term credit rating to investment grade Baa3 (Stable outlook).

The factors that are taken into account in assessing our credit rating include our degree of operational gearing, exposure to the economic cycle, and business and geographical diversity. Continuing to execute our strategy will strengthen our position against all these metrics.

Pensions

IAS 19

The aggregate IAS 19 deficit of the defined benefit schemes at 31 December 2013 was £445 million (31 December 2012: £551 million). This was partly as a result of the £80 million annual deficit funding contribution. Total liabilities have also reduced as a result of an increase in the implied discount rate used to value liabilities. This was largely offset by an increase in the rate of market-implied inflation. A review of the mortality assumption produced a further increase in the liabilities, reflecting an increased allowance for longer life expectancy.

In 2011 the Group entered into a longevity swap to protect against further increases in life expectancy. Changes in accounting standards mean that the assumptions used to value this swap are now based on market fair values, rather than best estimates. These changes have resulted in a significant actuarial gain in 2013 with the book value of the swap decreasing from a £118 million liability in 2012 to a £23 million liability in 2013.

Pensions continue to be paid from the Scheme based on actual requirements.

Actuarial valuations

Full actuarial valuations are carried out every three years with the latest completed actuarial valuations of all three sections of the main defined benefit scheme carried out as at 1 January 2011 and, on the bases adopted by the Trustee, the combined funding deficits amounted to £587 million.

The Trustee of the Scheme will undertake actuarial valuations as at 1 January 2014 with the outcome expected by 2015.

Deficit funding contributions

Following completion of actuarial valuations as at 1 January 2011 the Group has agreed with the Trustee that the level of contributions to the main section of the ITV Pension Scheme will be a combination of fixed and performance related payments.

The fixed payments will be as follows:

2013 - 2014

£35 million per annum plus an additional £5 million if there are no initiatives in the previous year which materially reduce the deficit. This has not changed from the previous funding plan.

2015 - 2019

£48 million per annum in 2015 increasing by £0.5 million per annum to £50 million per annum in 2019.

2020 - 2025

£50 million per annum, but may be reduced by the impact of additional profit-related contributions set out below.

The performance related contributions will be calculated as follows:

2012 - 2020

If the Group's reported EBITA pre exceptional items exceeds £300 million, the Group will increase the fixed contributions by an amount representing 10% of EBITA pre exceptional items over the threshold level, subject to an annual cap which averages to £70 million per annum over the period 2015 - 2020. If the additional profit-related contributions are paid at the expected rate then the £50 million per annum fixed contributions scheduled to be paid between 2021 and 2025 (inclusive) should not be required.

In addition to the agreed deficit funding contributions, the SDN partnership established in 2010 provides an annual distribution of £11 million to this section of the Scheme for 12 years from 2011.

For Sections B and C of the Scheme the Group has agreed with the Trustee that it will make deficit funding contributions of £5.5 million per annum in order to eliminate the deficits in these sections by 31 March 2021.

In 2014 we expect to make a total deficit funding contribution of £89 million, which is £9 million higher than 2013 reflecting the increase in EBITA year-on-year.

Post balance sheet events

On 16 January 2014 we agreed to repay the remaining £62 million of the 2019 bilateral loan. This repayment will save around £44 million in adjusted financing costs over the remainder of the loan - around £8 million on an annualised basis, and will lead to an exceptional loss of £30 million for 2014. The repayment was satisfied by a one-off cash payment of £95 million.

 

Ian Griffiths

Finance Director

 

Risks and Uncertainties

ITV has a formal risk management process which is embedded within the business to support the identification and effective management of risks across the business. It is regularly reviewed and adapted as the Company, industry and macro environment evolves.

Our approach, which is consistent with previous years, covers risks at all levels of the organisation and considers risks in three core groups:

·     High Impact, Low Likelihood (HILL) risks - of low inherent likelihood but where there would be major consequences were the risk to materialise;

·     Strategic risks - would impact the successful execution of the strategy; and

·     Process level risks - embedded into everyday activity within the organisation.

Risk management framework and risk appetite

The Board is responsible for establishing a robust and appropriate risk management framework and risk management process for ITV. The Board, supported by the Audit Committee, regularly reviews the risk management framework, its content and its operations. This includes reviewing the risks themselves and the mitigating actions.

The Board also reviews risk appetite to ensure ITV is carrying an acceptable level of risk. During the year it conducted an exercise to assess the current risk appetite of the business and the actual risk the business takes with respect to the following categories: financial, market, operational, compliance and regulation, creative investment and organisational. This is considered to be the first step towards using risk appetite as a decision making tool and further work will be undertaken in 2014 to enhance this process.  The Board also continues to monitor closely ITV's specific financial risks, including foreign exchange, borrowing levels, interest rates and pension risks.

The Audit Committee keeps the overall effectiveness of the risk management framework and the risk management process under review.

Risk management process

The Management Board has responsibility for the content and operation of the risk management framework and performs regular reviews of all risks. In 2013 all the HILL and Strategic risks were reassessed and further refined to improve our risk management. As well as management review, process level risks are also subject to an ongoing review by internal audit.

Mitigating actions have been identified for all the HILL and Strategic risks. Each strategic risk has been mapped to at least one of the four key strategic priorities and, where possible, assigned key risk indicators. Where appropriate, the key risk indicators are aligned to our key performance indicators (KPIs) on page 36 or a subset of these KPIs. All HILL and strategic risks are owned by at least one member of the Management Board.

Risk monitoring process

ITV's risk monitoring process is embedded in the running and review of the business. Risks are primarily controlled through the risk management process. In addition to the risk specific mitigating actions outlined below, risks are regularly discussed and considered through day-to-day operations and through a number of divisional Board and review processes.

Internal Audit Plan

The internal audit plan is driven from ITV's risk management framework. As outlined above management has completed a number of activities with respect to HILL risks, Strategic risks and Process level risks. Internal audit reviews the auditable elements of these risks and this informs the areas and topics that internal audit focuses on.

High Impact, Low Likelihood Risks (HILL)

Risk Theme

 

HILL Risks

Mitigating Factors

Financial

ITV loses its credit status or lines of funding with existing lenders or there is a collapse of a major bank impacting financial arrangements/availability of credit.

·     The business is cash generative and in a net cash position. Working capital management remains a key focus and ITV's profit to cash conversion rate remains above ITV's 90% rolling three year target.

·     ITV has a £250 million revolving funding facility with a number of banks which remains unused.

·     The low gross debt levels that ITV now has would enable the Company to obtain debt from the marketplace if needed.

Financial

There is a major collapse in investment values leading to a material impact on the pension scheme deficit.

·     There is regular communication between ITV and the pension trustees.

·     The pension scheme's assets are invested in a diversified portfolio, with a significant amount of the fund held in bonds.

·     ITV has worked with the pension trustees to limit the potential deficit by entering into deals to limit exposure, for example, a longevity swap.

Operational

A significant event removes a number of the key management team from the business on a long-term or permanent basis.

·     There is a business resilience plan in place which includes succession plans or nominated replacements for all key positions within the Company.

Reputation

An event with public interest that causes significant reputational and brand damage.

·     There is a Company-wide Code of Conduct in place which employees should follow.

Reputation

There is a major health and safety incident that results in a significant loss of human life.

·     ITV has a central Health & Safety team and Health & Safety policies and procedures are in place, with appropriate training for employees where required.

·     Regular inspections are undertaken at all sites, which are run alongside a programme of Health & Safety audits.

Reputation

A major incident results in ITV being unable to continue with scheduled broadcasting for a sustained period.

·     A risk register of broadcast operations including third parties is in place and reviewed on a regular basis.

·     An end-to-end review of the broadcast cycle is regularly undertaken.

·     An incident management process has been agreed and disaster recovery plans are in place.

Reputation

There is a significant or unexpected change in regulation or legislation.

·     ITV regularly communicates with legislative groups, legal panels and Ofcom to monitor potential policy and regulatory developments.

 

Strategic Risks

The key strategic risks are those that impact the successful execution of the strategy. They require regular monitoring by the Management Board and are frequently discussed at management and divisional boards.

All of the strategic risks identified have been mapped to the four strategic priorities of the Strategy and have been grouped by key risk themes.

Strategic Risks

Mitigating Factors

Strategic Priorities

The Market

There is a major decline in advertising revenues and ITV does not build sufficient non-NAR revenue streams to offset the financial impact of this decline.

·     Growing non-advertising revenues, in areas such as ITV Studios and Online, Pay & Interactive, remains a key part of the strategy.

·     ITV continues to focus on cash and costs, ensuring the Company has an adequate financial liquidity and balance sheet flexibility.

2,3,4

The Market

The television market moves significantly towards pay television as a preferred model, negatively impacting ITV's free-to-air revenues.

·     ITV continues to support free platforms, including YouView, to keep free-to-air strong.

·     ITV looks at and evaluates the opportunities for expanding its existing pay services and other pay offerings.

·     ITV explores other platforms to understand viewing habits and what people are prepared to pay for.

2,3

The Market

A faster than expected shift to Video on Demand (VOD) or other new technologies causes a sustained loss of advertising revenue.

·     The business continues to develop ITV Player VOD services, maximise the distribution of ITV Player and grow its VOD advertising business.

·     ITV monitors the market for new technology and where appropriate explores how ITV can participate.

2,3,4

People

ITV fails to attract, develop and retain key creative, commercial and management talent with the skills required for the changing business.

·     ITV invests in training and development for all key colleagues in the business.

·     Strategic focus on working across the business to embed and strengthen the culture of 'One ITV' way of working.

·     Succession plans are in place for all key positions within the Company.

1,2,3,4

Organisation, Structure and Processes

ITV fails to evolve its organisational structure and culture to ensure that it is capable of delivering continued growth from the new businesses or revenue streams.

·     ITV constantly reassesses the business to create a fit-for-purpose organisation.

·     ITV continues to embed and strengthen the culture of 'One ITV' way of working.

1,2,3,4

Organisation, Structure and Processes

A significant high profile incident or series of events such as transmission incidents or a major regulatory breach causes significant reputational damage.

·     ITV has ongoing projects to ensure transmission and distribution technologies are fit-for-purpose.

·     There are disaster recovery and incident management plans in place in high risk areas of the business to help deliver a rapid and flexible response.

1

 

Strategic Risks

Mitigating Factors

Strategic Priorities

Organisation, Structure and Processes

There is significant loss of programme or sports rights or ITV fails to identify and obtain the optimal rights packages.

·     ITV is focused on both protecting and exploiting existing rights and ensuring that future rights generated accrue
to ITV.

·     ITV has a detailed model to evaluate the value of third party rights to ensure it only buys rights that make economic sense.

2,3,4

Organisation, Structure and Processes

ITV fails to create and own a sufficient number of hit programmes/formats.

·     ITV maximises opportunities for ITV Studios to create successful shows by investing in the creative pipeline and focusing on programmes and genres that can return and travel internationally, i.e. drama, entertainment and factual entertainment.

·     ITV is focused on hiring and retaining the right key creative talent.

2,3,4

Organisation, Structure and  Processes

ITV fails to properly resource, creatively and operationally, the growth businesses, in particular online and international content.

·     Talent management plans have been developed and reviewed to ensure adequate succession planning
across ITV.

·     ITV continues to embed and strengthen the culture of 'One ITV' way of working.

·     Lessons from recent investments are captured through post acquisition reviews.

3,4

Organisation, Structure & Processes

ITV loses a significant volume of personal or sensitive data.

·     A management board sponsored Information Security Steering Group is in place to ensure the appropriate management of information security.

·     Mandatory online training modules, awareness campaigns and simplified information security policies for employees.

·     Monitoring of information sharing outside of ITV.

1,2,3,4

Technology

ITV remains heavily reliant on legacy systems, which could potentially restrict the ability to grow the business. These systems and processes may not be appropriate for non-advertising revenues or international growth.

·     System requirements are kept under review with business growth and system modernisation projects implemented as appropriate.

·     A replacement plan is in place for the legacy systems which remains under constant review and development to ensure technology systems meet the needs of the business.

1,2,3,4

Technology

ITV fails to ensure appropriate business continuity planning and resilience within its core systems, processes, platforms and technology infrastructure.

·     Disaster recovery plans are in place with tests conducted annually on business critical systems.

·     Internal Audit review the disaster recovery plans and the test results as appropriate.

1,2,3

Technology

There is a sustained cyber/viral attack causing prolonged system denial or major reputational damage, for example the ability to broadcast our channels or the availability of ITV Player.

·     We continue to improve our ability to monitor, detect and respond to cyber threats internally and through partnerships with specialist security organisations.

·     Mandatory online training modules, awareness campaigns and simplified information security policies for employees.

·     There are disaster recovery and incident management plans in place for high risk areas of the business to help deliver a rapid and flexible response.

·     A management board sponsored Information Security Steering Group is in place to ensure the appropriate management of information security.

1

 

The Strategic Report as set out on pages 2 to 55 was approved by the Board on 26 February 2014 and signed on its behalf by:

Adam Crozier

Chief Executive

 

Governance

Board of Directors

 

Archie Norman

Chairman

Appointment to the Board

1 January 2010

Age 59

Committee membership

Nomination (Chairman), Remuneration

Key areas of prior experience

Business turnaround, consumer marketing, international business and corporate finance

External appointments

·     Chairman, Lazard London (2014)

·     Chairman, Hobbycraft Group Ltd (2013)

·     Director of Target Ltd (2012)

·     Adviser to Wesfarmers Limited (2009)

·     Director of Coles Group (2007)

·     Governor, National Institute of Economic and Social Research (1997)

Previous experience

·     Founder, Aurigo Management Partners LLP (2006-2013)

·     Senior Adviser to Lazard (2003-2013)

·     Chairman, HSS Hire Services Group (2007-2012)

·     Chairman, Energis (2002-2005)

·     Shadow Secretary of State for Department of Environment, Transport and the Regions (2000-2001), Shadow Minister for Europe (1999-2000), Chief Executive and Deputy Chairman of the Conservative Party (1998-1999), Member of Parliament (1997-2005), Founder, Policy Exchange (2001)

·     Chief Executive (1991-1996) and Chairman (1996-2000), ASDA Group plc

·     Finance Director, Kingfisher plc (1986-1991)

·     Chairman, Chartwell Land plc (1987-1991)

·     Non-executive director of British Rail (1992-1994), Railtrack plc (1994-2000), and  Geest plc (1988-1991)

·     Partner, McKinsey and Co (1979-1986)

 

Adam Crozier

Chief Executive

Appointment to the Board

26 April 2010

Age 50

Committee membership

General Purpose

Key areas of prior experience

Business turnaround and change management

External appointments

·     Non-executive Director of G4S plc (2013)

Previous experience

·     Non-executive Director of Debenhams plc (2006-2012)

·     Group Chief Executive, Royal Mail Group (2003-2010)

·     Non-executive director of Camelot Group plc (2007-2010)

·     Chief Executive of the Football Association (2000-2002)

·     Joined Saatchi & Saatchi Advertising in 1988, Joint Chief Executive (1995-1998)

 

Ian Griffiths

Group Finance Director

Appointment to the Board

9 September 2008

Age 47

Committee membership

General Purpose

Key areas of prior experience

Corporate finance and financial restructuring

External appointments

·     None

Previous experience

·     Group Finance Director of Emap plc (2005-2008)

·     Senior Finance roles held within Emap plc including director of financial control (2000-2005) and head of finance at Emap Business Communications (1995-2000)

·     Manager in audit and corporate finance, Ernst & Young (1988-1994)

 

Sir Peter Bazalgette

Non-executive Director

Appointment to the Board

1 June 2013

Age 60

Committee membership

Nomination

Key areas of prior experience

Media consultant, digital media investor and former television producer

External appointments

·     Chairman, Arts Council of England (2013)

·     Non-executive director of Nutopia (2011)

·     Non-executive director of Mirriad Ltd (previously Chairman 2012-2013)

·     President of the Royal Television Society (2010)

·     Senior non-executive director,  Chairman of Remuneration Committee and member of Audit Committee, YouGov plc (2005)

Previous experience

·     Non-executive director of DCMS (2011-2013)

·     Non-executive director of Base79 Ltd (2008-2013) and adviser up to 2008

·     Trustee of DebateMate (2009-2013)

·     Chairman of ENO (2012)

·     Non-executive director of Critical Information Group plc (2009-2012)

·     Adviser to Sony Music division (2009-2012) and Chairman of UK production business at Sony Pictures Television Inc (2009-2012)

·     Deputy Chairman and Director of National Film and Television School (2002-2009)

·     Chairman of Endemol UK Ltd (2002-2008) and adviser until 2008

·     Joined Endemol in 1998, became Chief Creative Officer of Endemol Group BV and Endemol Entertainment UK Ltd (2005-2007)

·     Non-executive director of Channel Four Television Corp (2001-2004)

 

Roger Faxon

Non-executive Director

Appointment to the Board

31 October 2012

Age 65

Committee membership

Nomination

Key areas of prior experience

Broad commercial, digital and media rights experience, development of business strategy and finance

External appointments

·     Director of EMI Global Group (2011)

·     Director of The John Hopkins University

·     Director of the Songwriters Hall of Fame

Previous experience

·     Chief Executive Officer of EMI Group Limited (2010-2012)

·     Chairman and CEO of EMI Music Publishing (2007-2010)

·     Director of EMI Group Plc (2002-2008)

·     1994 to 2007 various roles at EMI including Senior VP, Business Development and Strategy; President of EMI Music Publishing

·     Prior to 1994 held finance, operations and general management positions with Sotheby's, Lucas Films, Tri-Star and Columbia Pictures. Overseas appointments at Music Choice (Digital Cable Radio) (chairman of Remuneration Committee), the American Society of Composers and Authors and Lancit Media Entertainment Ltd in the US, Chairman of VIVA Television in Germany and a director of Channel V Networks in Asia

 

Andy Haste

Senior Independent Director

Appointment to the Board

11 August 2008

Age 52

Committee membership

Audit, Nomination, Remuneration (Chairman)

Key areas of prior experience

International and emerging markets, change management, restructuring and business turnaround

External appointments

·     Senior Independent Deputy Chairman, Council of Lloyd's (2012)

Previous experience

·     Group Chief Executive of RSA Insurance Group plc (2003-2011)

·     Chief Executive of AXA Sun Life plc (1999-2003)

·     Director of AXA UK plc (life and pensions) (1999-2003)

·     President and CEO, GE Capital Global Consumer Finance UK, Western Europe and Eastern Europe (1998-1999)

·     CEO, GE Capital Global Consumer Finance UK (1996-1998)

·     President of National Westminster Bank US Consumer Credit Business (1995-1996), senior vice-president and head of US Consumer Loan Products Division (1992-1995)

 

Baroness Lucy Neville-Rolfe DBE, CMG

Non-executive Director

Appointment to the Board

3 September 2010

Age 61

Committee membership

Nomination, Audit

Key areas of prior experience

International retail, communications, legal and regulatory issues

External appointments

·     Member of Supervisory Board, Metro AG (2013)

·     Non-executive director, 2 Sisters Food Group (2013)

·     Director, Hermes Equity Ownership Services Limited (2013)

·     Member UK India Business Advisory Council (2013)

·     Member PWC Advisory Board (2013)

·     President, Euro Commerce, Brussels (2012)

·     Member of UK Trade and Investment Strategic Advisory Group (2011)

·     Governor, London Business School (2011)

·     Member of the Coalition Government's Efficiency and Reform Board (2010)

Previous experience

·     Non-executive director, The Carbon Trust (2008-2013)

·     Member of China-Britain Business Council (2007-2013)

·     Executive Director, Corporate and Legal Affairs, Tesco plc (2006-2013)

·     Corporate Leaders Group on Climate Change (2006-2012)

·     Deputy Chair, British Retail Consortium (1998-2012)

·     Chairman, Dobbies Garden Centres (2007-2011)

·     Group Director of Corporate Affairs (1997-2006) and Company Secretary (2004-2006), Tesco plc

·     Director of Deregulation Unit, BIS and Cabinet Office (1995-1997)

·     Member of Prime Minister's Policy Unit (1992-1994)

·     Ministry of Agriculture, Fisheries and Food (1973-1992)

 

John Ormerod

Non-executive Director

Appointment to the Board

18 January 2008

Age 65

Committee membership

Audit (Chairman), Nomination, Remuneration

Key areas of prior experience

Financial experience, developing strategy and growth

External appointments

·     Non-executive Chairman of Tribal Group plc (2010, director from 2009)

·     Non-executive director and chairman of audit committee of Gemalto NV (2006) and Computacenter plc (2006)

Previous experience

·     Senior independent director and chairman of audit committee at Misys plc (2005-2012)

·     Trustee of the Design Museum (2006-2012)

·     Non-executive director and chairman of Merlin Claims Services Holdings Limited (2007-2010)

·     Non-executive director of Negative Equity Protection Holdings Limited (2007-2009), Millen Group Limited (2007-2009) and BMS Associates Limited (2004-2008)

·     Member of audit and retail risk control committees and HBOS plc (2005-2008)

·     Trustee of The Roundhouse Trust (2003-2008)

·     Chairman of Walbrook Group (2004-2007)

·     Chairman of audit committee, Transport for London (2004-2006)

·     Practice senior partner, London, Deloitte & Touche (2002-2004)

·     Regional managing partner, UK and Ireland and senior partner, UK, Arthur Andersen (2001-2002)

·     Held various positions within Arthur Andersen from 1970

 

Management Board

 

Mary Fagan

Group Communications and Corporate Affairs Director

Appointed

January 2011

Age 56

Previous experience

Mary joined ITV from the Royal Mail Group, where she was Corporate and Government Affairs Director from December 2003. A senior City and Business journalist with more than 20 years' experience, Mary's previous roles included Deputy City Editor

of the Sunday Telegraph, Industrial Correspondent for the Independent and City Reporter at the Evening Standard.

 

Peter Fincham

Director of Television, Channels and Online

Appointed

May 2008

Age 57

Previous experience

Peter joined ITV from the BBC where he was Controller of BBC One. He began his career in broadcasting at independent production company, Talkback Productions, where he became Managing Director in 1986. In 2001 Talkback Productions was sold to Fremantle Media and in 2003 Peter became Chief Executive of the newly merged company TalkbackThames.

 

Andrew Garard

Group Legal Director and Company Secretary

Appointed

November 2007

Age 47

Previous experience

Andrew joined ITV as Group Legal Director in 2007 and took on the additional role of Company Secretary in 2009. Previously Andrew was a Partner in the corporate department of LeBoeuf Lamb's London office. Prior to joining LeBoeuf Lamb, Andrew was Group General Counsel and Company Secretary at Cable & Wireless PLC where he was a member of the Group Executive responsible for Global Legal. Prior to that he was Global Head of Legal and Deputy General Counsel of Reuters Group Plc in the UK, and before that, General Counsel Asia.

 

Fru Hazlitt

Managing Director, Commercial, Online and Interactive

Appointed

August 2010

Age 50

Previous experience

Prior to joining ITV, Fru was Chief Executive of GCap Media Plc until it was sold to Global Radio in 2008. Her previous positions include Chief Executive of Virgin Radio, Managing Director of Yahoo UK and European Commercial Director of Yahoo Europe.

 

Kevin Lygo

Managing Director, ITV Studios

Appointed

August 2010

Age 56

Previous experience

Before joining ITV Kevin spent much of his career at Channel 4, most recently as Director of Television and Content which included responsibility for Channel 4 Group's portfolio of channels. Kevin's previous roles include Director of Programmes at

Channel 5 as well as a number of positions at the BBC, including Head of Independent Commissioning for Entertainment.

 

Simon Pitts

Director of Strategy and Technology

Appointed

January 2011

Age 38

Previous experience

Simon joined ITV in 2000 and has held roles in ITV's Public Affairs, Regulatory and New Media departments before joining the Strategy Team in 2007. He was promoted to the ITV Management Board in the role of Director of Strategy and Transformation in January 2011, and more recently to Director of Strategy and Technology to combine the leadership of ITV's Technology Group with the implementation of the Company's overall strategic plan. Prior to ITV, Simon worked in the European Parliament in Brussels where he specialised in media issues.

 

Directors' Report

The Directors present their report together with the audited consolidated and parent company financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2013. The comparative period is for the year ended 31 December 2012.

Directors

A table showing Directors who served in the year can be found on page 70. Biographies for Directors currently in office can be found on pages 58 and 59. In accordance with the UK Governance Code (the Code), each Director will retire and submit himself or herself for election or re-election at the AGM on 14 May 2014.

On 1 June 2013 Sir Peter Bazalgette was appointed as a Non-executive Director, and will seek election as a Director of the Company at the AGM on 14 May 2014. On 31 December 2013 Mike Clasper stepped down from the Board. Andy Haste was appointed Senior Independent Director in his place.

Post balance sheet events

Details of post balance sheet events can be found on page 173.

Dividends

The Board has proposed a final dividend for the year ended 31 December 2013. Details of this and other dividends paid for the year are as follows:


2013

2012

Interim dividend

1.1p

0.8p

FInal dividend

2.4p

1.8p

Total Ordinary

3.5p

2.6p

 

Special dividend

4.0p

4.0p

Total Payments

7.5p

6.0p

 

The final dividend and special dividend for 2013 will be paid on 30 May 2014 to shareholders on the register on 2 May 2014. The ex dividend date is 30 April 2014.

Share capital

Issued: At the date of this report there were 4,025,409,194 ordinary shares of 10 pence each in issue, all of which are fully paid up and quoted on the London Stock Exchange.

Rights: The rights attaching to the Company's ordinary shares, as well as the powers of the Company's Directors, are set out in the Company's Articles of Association. Unless expressly specified to the contrary, the Articles may only be amended by special resolution of the shareholders. A copy of the Articles can be obtained from the Company's website or by writing to the Company Secretary.

Restrictions: There are no restrictions on the transfer of ordinary shares in the capital of the Company other than those which may be imposed by law from time to time. In accordance with the Disclosure and Transparency Rules, certain employees are required to seek approval to deal in ITV shares. The Company is not aware of any agreements between shareholders that may result in restrictions on the transfers of securities and/or voting rights.

Purchase of own shares: The Directors have the authority to purchase up to 391.2 million of the Company's ordinary shares. The authority remains valid until the AGM in 2014 or 15 August 2014, if earlier.

Trusts: The Company has a discretionary trust funded by loans to acquire shares for the potential benefit of employees of the Group. Details of shares held by the trust at 31 December 2013 are set out on page 166. During the year shares have been released from the trust in respect of share schemes for employees.

 

Substantial shareholdings

As at 31 December 2013 the Company had received notifications from the following companies and institutions of the voting interests of themselves and their clients in 3% or more of the issued ordinary share capital (carrying rights to vote in all circumstances) of the Company.


 At 31 December 2013

Shares1

%

Sky Holdings Ltd2

291,684,730

7.50%

Majedie Asset Management Limited

195,687,610

5.01%

Blackrock, Inc.

195,504,921

5.00%

Brandes Investment Partners, L.P.

194,304,930

4.99%

AXA S.A.

196,862,678

4.93%

 

1.   The number of shares is based on announcements made by each relevant shareholder using the Company's issued share capital at that date.

2.   Subsidiary of British Sky Broadcasting Group plc.

3.   Following the year end there have been no further notifications received.

A profile of shareholdings is set out on page 175.

Change of control

No person holds securities in the Company carrying special rights with regard to control of the Company.

All of the Company's share schemes contain provisions relating to a change of control. Outstanding awards and options would normally vest and become exercisable on a change of control, subject to the satisfaction of any performance conditions. Certain of the Group's bonds/borrowing facilities have change of control clauses whereby the issuer can require ITV to repay/redeem bonds in the event of a change of control. The Company is not aware of any other significant agreements to which it is party that take effect, alter or terminate upon a change of control of the Company.

Financial instruments

Note 4.5 to the accounts gives details of the Group's financial risk management policies and related exposures.

Political donations

It is the Company's policy not to make cash contributions to any political party. However, within the normal activities of the Group's national and regional news-gathering operations there may be occasions when an activity might fall within the broader definition of 'political expenditure' contained within the Companies Act 2006. Shareholder authority for such expenditure was given at the 2013 AGM. However, during 2013 the Group made no payments falling within this definition (2012: nil).

Employees

Employment of disabled persons

The Company continues to meet its legal obligations as outlined in the Equality Act 2010 by actively encouraging applicants with disabilities whilst ensuring we retain the best talent within our workforce.

This is reflected in an award of the annual Department for Work and Pensions Two Ticks Disability Symbol status.

Our policies and procedures fully support our disabled colleagues. With a robust reasonable adjustment policy, an HR Disability manager, disability specific online resources and on-site diversity experts, we have taken active measures to ensure employees are fully supported.

The Company is committed to the development and growth of all its employees. Our learning and development portfolio is inclusive and accessible to employees. Alternative formats are available to all employees, which include large print, use of British sign language interpreters and Braille.

The Company's commitment around the disability agenda extends beyond our legal obligations. For a comprehensive outline of our activity visit our Corporate Responsibility website.

Employee involvement

Attracting and retaining talent is critical to ITV's success. It is therefore in our interest to ensure that we provide the appropriate rewards and opportunities for development so that people feel engaged with the Company.

In 2013 ITV carried out an engagement campaign consisting of a series of roadshows during which the Management Board visited ITV locations. This gave employees an opportunity to feed back their thoughts and concerns about the business. Engagement was reinforced through forums such as the intranet, regular hard copy newsletters and briefings between management and its teams. These channels enabled employees to understand the financial and economic factors affecting the Company's performance, how their role contributed towards the execution of the strategy and how they could benefit from company success through involvement in employee share schemes and information on their rights and benefits. 

We have continued to measure and listen to employees through employee surveys and employee engagement has increased again in 2013 to 91% (2012: 88%) with 93% of respondents proud to work for ITV.

Pensions

The Group operates a pension scheme which provides retirement and death benefits for employees of ITV. The ITV Pension Scheme (the "Scheme") comprises three sections: A, B and C. Section A includes the defined contribution (DC) section of the Scheme. The DC section is open to new members. The defined benefit (DB) sections are closed to new members but are still open to future accrual.

ITV Pension Scheme Limited is a corporate trustee and manages the DB and DC assets of the Scheme, which are held under trust separately from those of the Group. Members of the trustee board are formally appointed as directors of ITV Pension Scheme Limited. There are nine directors including the chairman - five appointed by the Company and four nominated by the members.

A member nomination selection process took place during June 2013 and on 1 July 2013, one trustee was reappointed and two new trustees were appointed. There is currently a vacancy for a company appointed director.

The trustee has four committees: Investment, Audit and Operations, DC and Corporate Affairs. The Corporate Affairs Committee is convened as and when appropriate for dealing with any corporate activities that may arise. It is the responsibility of the trustee to have in place appropriate training for its directors and effective committee structures. The trustee board and each committee have a business plan which is reviewed and updated on an annual basis, together with the associated budget. The trustee board also has a risk register, a conflicts of interest policy and a register of interests policy, all of which are reviewed at least annually.

The trustee directors receive regular training throughout the year and also have the support of the various professional advisers. The chairman and the pensions executive identify training opportunities. Training is delivered both by attendance at external courses and with targeted training to support specific agenda items at the start of each trustee board meeting. Where appropriate, longer training sessions are organised. Comprehensive records are kept of all training completed by each trustee director and training is discussed as part of the trustee evaluations conducted on an annual basis.

The trustee board completes regular assessments of its advisers and has prepared a Service Charter that outlines the terms of the appointment and clarity on the services provided. The aim of the document is to support the ongoing monitoring of the adviser or services provider and will be introduced as they are reviewed and appointed. During 2013 The Scheme Actuary and Investment Consultant were reappointed and the DC Investment Platform provider was replaced.

To encourage greater pension savings, the Government has introduced auto-enrolment. This requires employers to enrol eligible employees into a pension scheme automatically. The requirement to comply with the auto-enrolment regulations is being phased in with larger employers required to comply first and with medium-sized and smaller employers following at a later period. The size of an employer's largest PAYE scheme determines the point at which the new duties affect their organisation (the 'staging date'). ITV had a staging date of 1 March 2013 however, in line with permitted legislation ITV postponed auto-enrolment until 29 May 2013 when eligible employees were enrolled into the ITV Auto-enrolment Pension Plan.

Pension Scheme indemnities: Qualifying pension scheme indemnity provisions, as defined in section 235 of the Companies Act 2006, were in force for the financial year ended 31 December 2013 and remain in force for the benefit of each of the directors of ITV Pension Scheme Limited, a subsidiary of ITV plc. These indemnity provisions cover, to the extent permitted by law, certain losses or liabilities incurred as a director or officer of ITV Pension Scheme Limited.

For further information please see page 50 and note 3.7.

Health and safety

The Health and Safety (H&S) of our employees, contractors and visitors is always a high priority. The significant loss of human life as the result of a major H&S incident has been identified as a specific risk to the organisation. The H&S team continue to use a management system that meets the specific risk profile of the business which is supported by a comprehensive training programme and communicated across the business.

Health and safety - performance indicators


2013

2012

Lost time accidents reported under RIDDOR

2

5

Major accidents (as defined by RIDDOR)

0

3

Fatal accidents

0

0

 

As of 6 April 2012, RIDDOR's over-three-day injury reporting requirement changed to over-seven-day reporting. Our figures reflect this change.

The statistics are for UK permanent and fixed-term employees.

For more detail on the Company's health and safety management system and implementation visit our Corporate Responsibility website.

Greenhouse Gas emissions

The Company is required to report annually on the quantity of carbon dioxide emissions in tonnes emitted as a result of activities for which it is responsible, our Greenhouse Gas emissions.

All new regulatory data for the financial year ended
31 December 2013 is disclosed below for direct and indirect emissions. Data on other emissions where available and more information on our energy use, environmental impacts, and how we aim to make a positive difference can be found on our Corporate Responsibility website.

Our total Greenhouse Gas emissions

Indicator

2013

Total gross CO2e emissions

43,485 (tCO2e)

Scope 1: Direct emissions

17,117 (tCO2e)

Scope 2: Indirect emissions

26,368 (tCO2e)

Total Revenue

£2,753m

Emissions per unit/£m turnover

15.8 (tCO2e)

Source: Utilyx analysis of ITV data.

The latest conversion factors specified in Defra and DECC's 2013 guidance were used as methodology. 44% of our data consumption is based on estimate. This is where we are the occupier of a property but do not pay the energy bills directly. Estimates are calculated from observed ITV consumption intensity and published benchmarks where relevant.

Risk management

Details of our High Impact Low Likelihood (HILL) and Strategic risks and our approach to risk management are set out on pages 52 to 55.

Going concern

The going concern statement is set out on page 115.

Auditor

KPMG has instigated an orderly wind-down of KPMG Audit Plc as a result of an internal reorganisation and requested that going forward the audit is instead undertaken by KPMG LLP (an intermediate parent of KPMG Audit Plc). KPMG Audit Plc will not therefore be seeking reappointment as auditor of the Company and in accordance with the Companies Act 2006, a resolution proposing the appointment of KPMG LLP as our auditor will be put to the 2014 AGM.

Annual General Meeting

The AGM will be held on Wednesday, 14 May 2014 at 11.00 am at the Queen Elizabeth II Conference Centre, Broad Sanctuary, Westminster, London, SW1P 3EE. The Notice of the AGM contains an explanation of special business to be considered at the meeting.

A copy of the Notice will be available on our website.

Directors' Responsibilities

The Directors consider that the Annual Report and accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company's and the Group's performance, business model and strategy.

Each of the Directors, whose names and functions are listed on pages 58 and 59, confirm that, to the best of their knowledge:

·     the Group accounts, which have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the EU, give a true and fair view of the assets, liabilities, financial position and profit of the Group; and

·     the Directors' Report includes a fair review of the development and performance of the business and the position of the Group, together with a description of the principal risks and uncertainties that it faces.

In accordance with Section 418 of the Companies Act 2006, the Directors confirm that, so far as they are each aware, there is no relevant audit information of which the Company's auditor is unaware; and each Director has taken all steps that they ought to have taken as a Director in order to make themselves aware of any relevant audit information and to establish that the Company's auditor is aware of that information.

The Board has conducted a review of the effectiveness of the Group's systems of internal controls for the year ended 31 December 2013. In the opinion of the Board, the Company has complied with the internal control requirements of the UK Corporate Governance Code throughout the year, maintaining an ongoing process for identifying, evaluating, and minimising risk. Further information is set out in the Audit Committee Report on page 79.

By order of the Board

Andrew Garard

Company Secretary

26 February 2014

ITV plc

Registered number 4967001

 

The Directors are responsible for preparing the Annual Report and the Group and parent company financial statements in accordance with applicable law and regulations.

Company law requires the Directors to prepare Group and parent company financial statements for each financial year. Under that law they are required to prepare the Group financial statements in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the EU and applicable law and have elected to prepare the parent company financial statements in accordance with UK Accounting Standards.

Under company law the Directors must not approve the financial statements unless they are satisfied that they give a true and fair view of the state of affairs of the Group and parent company and of their profit or loss for that period. In preparing each of the Group and parent company financial statements, the Directors are required to:

·     select suitable accounting policies and then apply them consistently;

·     make judgements and estimates that are reasonable and prudent;

·     for the Group financial statements, state whether they have been prepared in accordance with IFRSs as adopted by the EU;

·     for the parent company financial statements, state whether applicable UK Accounting Standards have been followed, subject to any material departures disclosed and explained in the parent company financial statements; and

·     prepare the financial statements on the going concern basis unless it is inappropriate to presume that the Group and the parent company will continue in business.

The Directors are responsible for keeping adequate accounting records that are sufficient to show and explain the parent company's transactions and disclose with reasonable accuracy at any time the financial position of the parent company and enable them to ensure that its financial statements comply with the Companies Act 2006. They have general responsibility for taking such steps as are reasonably open to them to safeguard the assets of the Group and to prevent and detect fraud and other irregularities.

Under applicable law and regulations, the Directors are also responsible for preparing a Strategic Report, Directors' Report, Remuneration Report and Corporate Governance Statement that comply with that law and those regulations.

The Directors are responsible for the maintenance and integrity of the corporate and financial information included on the Company's website. Legislation in the UK governing the preparation and dissemination of financial statements may differ from legislation in other jurisdictions.

 

Chairman's Governance Statement

Dear Shareholder,

The Board believes that a high standard of corporate governance is a key contributor to the long-term success of the Company. 

The Board remains committed to ensuring that a combination of good leadership and the highest standards of corporate governance is maintained through a combination of a robust internal framework of systems and controls underpinned by the right values and culture. This framework of policies and processes is regularly reviewed against developments in the legislative, regulatory and governance landscape.

This governance report comprises the following sections:

·     How the Board works

·     Effectiveness

·     Relations with shareholders

·     Audit Committee Report

·     Remuneration Report

 

The role of the Board

The Board's main role is to work with the executive team, providing support and advice to complement and enhance the work undertaken. The Board consistently challenges processes, plans and actions and exercises a degree of rigorous enquiry and intellectual debate. This serves to promote continuous and sustained improvement across the business.

The Board consisted of a majority of independent Non-executive Directors throughout the year. Further details of our Board composition and appointments are set out in the Governance Report.

In addition to scheduled formal Board and Committee meetings, there are meetings for cross interaction among the members of the Board, Management Board, Senior Independent Director, Non-executive Directors and myself. These meetings provide a sense of value added from the engagement of the Board members in all their interaction with the Company, formal or otherwise. In 2013, the Board continued its programme of visiting different areas of the business. This year the Board members took a trip to Stockholm where they met with colleagues to discuss our continuing growth in the Nordic region. The Company has a policy and programme for induction and continuing professional development for Directors. On appointment each Director takes part in a comprehensive induction programme. To enhance performance and effectiveness, the Board has established a process for the annual development of the Board, its committees and individual Directors.

We remain committed to sharing our business vision with our shareholders by maintaining regular open dialogue and effective communication. We believe that continued engagement with our shareholders is highly beneficial to all parties as it helps to build a greater understanding of our investors' views, opinions and concerns.

The UK Corporate Governance Code

As a listed company, ITV is required to report on how it has complied with the principles of governance set out in the UK Corporate Governance Code (the Code).

I am pleased to report that ITV has complied with the provisions of the Code throughout the year ended 31 December 2013.

Archie Norman

Chairman

26 February 2014

 

Corporate Governance

How the Board works

Our role

The Board as a whole is collectively responsible for delivering the long-term success of the Company by:

·     providing entrepreneurial leadership within a framework of prudent and effective controls which enable risk to be assessed and managed;

·     supporting the executive team to formulate and execute the Company's long-term objectives and strategy, ensuring that the necessary financial and other resources are in place for the Company to meet its objectives, and reviewing management performance; and

·     setting the Company's values and standards and ensuring that its obligations to its shareholders and others are understood and met.

There is a schedule of specific matters reserved to the Board for decision which is available on our website.

Our meetings

The number of meetings held during the year and attendance of Directors is set out in the table on page 70. The Board agrees an annual schedule of matters it wishes to consider at each of its meetings and those of its committees. The schedule ensures that all relevant matters are considered and receive appropriate attention. Meetings are normally held at one of the London sites and at least once a year they are held at one of the regional or international offices. Board meetings are structured around the following areas:

·     Operational and functional updates

·     Financial updates

·     Strategy and risk

·     Progress against strategy

·     Other reporting and items for approval

·     Feedback from committees

Senior executives and other colleagues are regularly invited to attend meetings for specific items. In addition to formal Board and Committee meetings, meetings take place between:

·     Board members and Management Board members

·     Chairman and Non-executive Directors

·     Senior Independent Director and Non-executive Directors (without the Chairman present)

The Board has approved a formal framework for the approval of expenditure within the Company around this governance structure.

Who is on our Board and how we work as a team

Composition and appointments

In June 2013 the Board appointed Sir Peter Bazalgette as a Non-executive Director. Peter was selected from a number of potential candidates. The Board felt that Peter's wealth of experience in media consultancy, digital media and as a former television producer would be an asset to the Board assisting with the execution of the business strategy.  Executive search firm, JCA Group, were engaged to assist with the rigorous selection process. JCA Group have no other connection with ITV.

Mike Clasper completed seven years as a Non-executive Director in January 2013 and was asked by the Board to continue in this position for a further twelve month period. He stepped down from the Board on 31 December 2013. Andy Haste was appointed as Senior Independent Director in his place.

As recommended by the Code, there will be resolutions to elect or re-elect each of the Directors at the AGM in May 2014.

Non-executive Directors are expected to commit at least 18 to 20 days per annum to the Company and the Board is satisfied that each of the Non-executive Directors commits sufficient time to the business of the Company. An outline of the terms of engagement for the Non-executive Directors can be found on our website.

Skills and experience

There are job descriptions in place for each of the Chairman, the Chief Executive, and the Senior Independent Director which have been agreed by the Board.

 

The Board is still of the view that the Non-executive Directors are independent in both character and judgement. They constructively challenge and help develop proposals on strategy, scrutinise the performance of management in meeting agreed goals and objectives and monitor the reporting of performance.

The Board works well together bringing strong, independent, balanced judgement, knowledge, and experience to the Board's deliberations. Each non-executive Director has appropriate skills and experience that their views carry significant weight in the Board's decision making.

Board and Committee membership and attendance at meetings in 2013

Scheduled meetings shown in black and ad hoc meetings shown in orange.





Board

Nomination

 Committee

Remuneration

Committee

Audit

Committee


Status

Notes

Date of

appointment

to the Board

11

1

2

1

5

1

5

2

Peter Bazalgette

Independent

1

1 June 2013

7

1

1

-

-

-

-

-

Mike Clasper

Independent  SID


3 January 2006

11

1

2

1

5

1

5

1

Adam Crozier

Executive


26 April 2010

11

1

-

-

-

-

-

-

Roger Faxon

Independent

3

31 October 2012

11

1

1

1

-

-

-

-

Ian Griffiths

Executive


9 September 2008

11

1

-

-

-

-

-

-

Andy Haste

Independent


11 August 2008

11

1

2

1

5

1

5

1

Lucy Neville-Rolfe

Independent

2, 3

3 September 2010

11

1

1

1

-

-

4

2

Archie Norman

Independent Chairman


1 January 2010

11

1

2

1

5

1

-

-

John Ormerod

Independent


18 January 2008

11

1

2

1

5

1

5

2

 

 

Peter Bazalgette joined the Board on 1 June 2013. Four of the 11 scheduled Board meetings were held prior to his appointment.

Lucy Neville-Rolfe was appointed to the Audit Committee on 1 May 2013 and so did not attend the meeting held prior to this.

Non-attendance at Nomination Committee was due to Board meeting overrun and unavoidable other commitments.

Board Committees

The Board has delegated certain responsibilities to its committees. The terms of reference for each committee are reviewed annually and the current versions are available on the Company's website.

Nomination Committee

The Committee is composed of the Non-executive Directors.

The role of the Nomination Committee is to:

·     review the structure, size, and composition of the Board, including skills, knowledge and experience;

·     identify and nominate for Board approval candidates to fill Board vacancies;

·     consider succession planning for Directors and other senior executives; and

·     consider and review any conflicts of interest that may be reported by the Directors.

In addition to considering matters under its terms of reference, the Committee considered candidates for a Non-executive Director appointment. The Committee also reviewed a detailed succession planning framework and undertook an annual review of conflicts of interest.

Full details of attendance at Committee meetings can be found in the table above.

The Company also has the following Committees:

General Purpose Committee: the Committee is composed of the Executive Directors. The Committee meets as required to conduct the Company's business within the clearly defined limits delegated by the Board and subject to those matters reserved to the Board.

Disclosure Committee: the Committee is composed of the Executive Directors and other members of the senior management team. The function of the Committee, in accordance with the Company's Inside Information Policy, is to ensure compliance with continuing obligations under the Disclosure and Transparency Rules and the Listing Rules.

Effectiveness

Evaluation

The Board has established an ongoing evaluation and development process. The process focuses on roles and responsibilities, culture, balance of skills and experience, diversity and how the Board works together. In particular, it focuses on how effective the Directors are in assisting the executive team in achievement of the strategy.

At the end of 2012 the Board embarked on a comprehensive Board Development Programme facilitated by Gurnek Bain of YSC, a global firm of business psychologists. This included a rigorous assessment of performance, agreement on the Board's aspirations for itself and identification of steps required to achieve its objectives. Over the past 12 months each board member  has had access to feedback and advice from YSC to help develop their own performance and the Board has held a number of collective discussions to review and agree on progress. At the end of the process further feedback was given and a programme for future development was agreed. It is ITV policy to ensure that all board members have continued access to coaching, feedback and support, and a further healthcheck review will be undertaken on the anniversary of the completion of the programme in 2014.

YSC have also been involved in supporting the review of the board make up and composition. They have no other connection with the Company.

Succession planning and diversity

Board tenure

All Directors are required by the Company's Articles of Association to be elected by shareholders at the first AGM following their appointment by the Board. Subsequently, all Directors are subject to annual re-election by shareholders as recommended by the Code.

Succession planning

The Board has agreed a succession planning framework to ensure that:

·     board tenure is appropriate and encourages fresh thinking and new ideas;

·     the Board is sufficiently diverse but most importantly has the appropriate mix of generalist and specialist skills; and

·     Non-executive Directors have the appropriate level of independence, from the executive and each other.

When planning succession within the Company consideration is given to emergency cover together with medium and long-term succession. There is particular emphasis on growing the internal leadership pipeline through the launch of the following key programmes:

·     Executive Development Programme for next generation potential board successors giving them an opportunity to develop their management potential and gain a greater understanding of the business.

·     Developing Future Leaders Programme for delegates selected from across the business identified as a result of the performance review process. Content includes understanding what it means to be a leader at ITV, how to manage performance effectively, coaching skills and change management.

·     Graduate Programme.

·     Apprentice Programme.

A comprehensive portfolio of development courses and workshops for all colleagues which address common development needs is in place.

Diversity

It is the Board's policy to retain a strong but relatively small board bringing a balance of in depth commercial and creative experience. Although given the size of the Board specific formulaic targets are not appropriate it is our intention to increase the gender and ethnic diversity of board membership as opportunities arise.

Diversity within the organisation is integral to achieving our business aims. Reflecting the demographics of our customers and understanding their needs ensures that our brand, services and products are accessible, inclusive and have wide appeal.

The Company's aim is to represent our society both within the organisation and on-screen. Year-on-year progress has been achieved in working towards this target. Key activity in 2013 included:

·     Diversity awareness training for line managers, supervisors and programme makers.

·     Sustaining programme portrayal monitoring across 75% of our programmes.

·     Workshops across the country to support future generations of diverse talent from Black, Asian, Minority Ethnics and individuals with disabilities.

·     Developing and maintaining partnerships with external organisations to support and recognise diverse talent. For example, partnering with the inaugural Asia Media Awards and working with government to deliver the first ever Disability Confident conference to FTSE 100 companies.

 

Induction

The Company has a policy and programme for induction and continuing professional development of Directors. On appointment, each Director takes part in a comprehensive induction programme where they:

·     receive information about the Group in the form of presentations by executives from all parts of the business and on the regulatory environment;

·     meet representatives of the Company's key advisers;

·     receive information about the role of the Board and the matters reserved for its decision, the terms of reference and membership of Board committees and the powers delegated to those committees;

·     receive information about the Company's corporate governance practices and procedures and the latest financial information about the Group; and

·     are advised of their legal and other duties and obligations as a director of a listed company.

This is supplemented by visits to key locations, including studios and regional sites, and meetings with key senior executives and with major shareholders where appropriate.

 

The key stages of the induction programme are:

Stage one

Matters covered

Provision of documents

Duties of a Director, board procedures, board and strategy papers and corporate governance

 

Stage two

Matters covered

Meeting with Chief Executive and Group Finance Director

Business overview, current trading and key commercial issues

 

Meetings with Non-executive Directors

 

Open discussion forums

Meetings with Management Board members and other

senior executives

 

Commercial issues and projects

Stage three

Matters covered

Site visits

Understanding of the business and operations

 

 

Additional specific induction programmes are in place when Non-executive Directors join committees.

 

Continuing professional development

During their period in office, the Directors are continually updated on the Group's businesses and the competitive and regulatory environments in which they operate. This is done through:

·     updates and papers which cover changes affecting the Group and the market in which it operates;

·     meetings with senior executives across the Group and key advisers;

·     regular updates on changes to the legal and governance requirements of the Group and in relation to their own position as Directors; and

·     presentations given at board and committee meetings on business matters and technical update sessions from external advisers where appropriate.

As part of their professional development Executive Directors may accept external appointments as non-executive directors of other companies and retain any related fees paid to them.  For further information on board development see the Evaluation section on page 71.

Conflicts of interest

The Board has delegated the authorisation of conflicts to the Nomination Committee and has adopted a Conflicts of Interest Policy.

The Board has considered in detail the current external appointments of the Directors which may give rise to a situational conflict and has authorised potential conflicts where appropriate.

This authorisation can be reviewed at any time but will always be subject to annual review. The Board is confident that these procedures operate effectively.

Insurance and indemnities

The Company maintains liability insurance for its Directors and officers which is renewed on an annual basis. The Company has also entered into deeds of indemnity with its Directors. A copy of the indemnity can be found on our website.

Relations with shareholders

The Board attaches a high priority to effective communication with shareholders and has regular and open dialogue with our institutional investors. The Board believes that continued engagement with our shareholders is beneficial to both ITV and its stakeholders as it helps to build a greater understanding of investors' views, opinions and concerns.Adam Crozier, Ian Griffiths and our investor relations team meet with many institutional investors throughout the year to keep them updated on the Company's performance and the Transformation Plan. These range from one-to-one meetings to group presentations including the Full year and Interim results and the AGM. Specifically, following the Full year and Interim results one-to-one meetings are held with our largest institutional investors.

The Chairman responds to shareholder queries and holds meetings where appropriate.

The Company maintains a programme of engagement with the investment community, including the results presentations, briefings to brokers and other sales forces and attendance at a number of investor conferences. Presentations given to the investment community are available to download from our website.

We regularly seek feedback on the perception of the Company amongst shareholders and the investor community more broadly via our corporate brokers. Investor comments are fed back to the Board and its committees regularly.

The Company considers annually whether it is appropriate to commission an investor audit. No audit was undertaken
in 2013.

Private shareholders represent more than 95% of our shareholders holding 3.36% of our shares. We encourage shareholders to register their email addresses to receive information from us in a timely manner.

Annual General Meeting (AGM)

The AGM will be held on 14 May 2014 (further details can be found on page 65). The Notice of Meeting sets out the resolutions being proposed. The Notice, together with any related documents, is made available to shareholders on or website or is mailed to them, if they have elected to receive hard copies, at least 20 working days before the meeting. Last year all resolutions were passed with votes ranging from 93% to 100%.

In 2013 the meeting was attended by 131 shareholders. Shareholders are invited to meet the Directors prior to and after the formal proceedings. At the meeting the Chairman and Chief Executive will review the Group's current trading which is followed by a question and answer session. Separate resolutions are proposed on each substantially separate issue and all resolutions are taken on a poll. The level of votes lodged on each resolution is made available on a regulatory information service and on the Company's website as soon as possible after the meeting.

Shareholders who are not able to attend the meeting can vote online in advance via our website or by completing and returning a form of proxy.

Save in exceptional circumstances, all members of the Board will attend the AGM.

 

Audit Committee Report

In this report . . .

The purpose of this report is to highlight areas that the Committee has reviewed during the year, reporting back to shareholders the significant financial reporting issues and judgements made in connection with the preparation of the Company's financial statements. The report also notes any areas or specific topics, such as risk, that the Committee has reviewed. Also highlighted is how the Committee has assisted the Board in reviewing the Company's internal control environment, and what the Committee has done to review the effectiveness of both internal and external auditors. This year the report addresses the changes in the UK Corporate Governance Code by describing in more detail what the Committee does, and what processes and controls are in place to help ensure that the annual report presents a fair, balanced and understandable view of the business.

 

Dear Shareholder,

On the following pages we set out the Audit Committee's Report for 2013. The report comprises four sections:

·     How the Committee works

·     What we focused on in 2013

·     Internal controls

·     Our auditors

Strong and effective risk management and control procedures underpin our ability to execute and implement our strategy. The principal aims of the Committee are to support the maintenance and continuing development

of a strong control environment across ITV and to ensure the integrity of the financial information provided to our shareholders. We do this in the context of a business with ambitious plans and a growing international footprint.

We seek not just to respond to changes but to support and challenge management to develop controls as they anticipate future opportunities and risks.

As requested by the Board, the Committee has considered the processes and controls in place to help ensure that the annual report presents a fair, balanced and understandable view of the business. As a result of this work the Committee concluded that the processes and controls were appropriate and was able to provide positive assurance to the Board.

In reporting to you, we have sought to respond to shareholders' changing requirements and expectations of audit committees. This is no doubt the start of improved communication between audit committees and shareholders and we welcome feedback.

John Ormerod

Chairman, Audit Committee

26 February 2014

 

Who is on the Committee

The Committee is composed entirely of Non-executive Directors. The current members are:

John Ormerod (Chairman)

Andy Haste

Lucy Neville-Rolfe (appointed 1 May 2013)

Mike Clasper stepped down from the Board and as a member of the Committee on 31 December 2013.

 

How the Committee works

The Committee members have between them a wide range of business and financial experience which enables the Committee to fulfil its terms of reference in a robust and independent manner. The Committee considers that John Ormerod has recent and relevant financial experience for the purposes of the Code.

The Chief Executive, Group Finance Director and internal and external auditors attended meetings during the course of the year at the invitation of the Chairman of the Committee. Members of the Management Board and other senior management have attended certain meetings by invitation. The Committee as a whole has regular private sessions with both internal and external auditors and also, when appropriate, with the Group Finance Director.

In addition, throughout the year the Chairman of the Committee has individual sessions with other Committee members and meets informally, and has open lines of communication, with the Group Finance Director, Head of internal audit and the senior engagement team from the external auditors. This group generally meets ahead of each full Committee meeting to prepare and identify key areas for consideration by the Committee.

The Committee works to a structured programme of activities with agenda items focused to coincide with key events of the annual financial reporting cycle, themes or areas of risk that the Committee has identified, together with standing items that the Committee is required to consider regularly under its terms of reference. Reports are provided by management, internal audit, and external audit, addressing the key risks and reporting matters faced by the Group. Following each meeting the Committee communicates its main discussion points and findings to the Board.

In addition to formal meetings, from time to time, Committee members have informal briefings on topics relevant to the Committee's work from members of the operational and financial management teams and external auditor.  

In reviewing the various topics on its agenda the Committee members receive input from management, internal audit and external audit as appropriate. Committee members draw upon this and their own experience to provide a constructive challenge to the judgements made by management and consider alternative scenarios or accounting treatments in reaching their conclusions.

What is our role?

The role of the Committee includes to:

·     monitor the integrity of the published financial information of the Company;

·     review and report to the Board on the significant financial reporting issues and judgements made in connection with the preparation of the published financial information of the Company (having regard to matters communicated by the auditor);

·     review the consistency of, ongoing appropriateness of, and changes to, accounting policies, consider the methods used to account for significant or unusual transactions;

·     review the effectiveness of the internal control and risk management processes;

·     review the Group's whistleblowing process for employees;

·     review and approve the internal audit plan;

·     monitor and review the effectiveness and independence of the internal audit function;

·     monitor and review the effectiveness of management in addressing internal and external audit actions;

·     review the quality and effectiveness of the external audit and the procedures and controls designed to ensure auditor independence;

·     consider and make recommendations to the Board in relation to the appointment, reappointment, replacement, and remuneration of the Company's external auditor; and

·     where requested by the Board, provide advice on whether the annual report and accounts, taken as a whole, is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Company's performance, business model and strategy.

The Committees terms of reference can be accessed on our website.

What we focused on in 2013

In planning its own agenda, and reviewing the audit plan of the internal and external auditor, the Committee takes account of significant issues and risks, both operational and financial, likely to impact on the Company's financial statements. The Committee also addresses specific queries referred to it by the Board or Remuneration Committee. In 2013, the Remuneration Committee asked the Committee to report by exception on significant unusual or non-recurring transactions which came to its attention and the effect of which the Remuneration Committee may wish to consider in connection with its assessment of remuneration.

An annual review of the performance of the Committee was conducted for the year. In addition to feedback from members of the Committee, input was sought from the Group Finance Director, KPMG, internal audit and the Chairman of the Board. Overall, the review concluded that the Committee is responding appropriately to its terms of reference and will continue to develop its role.

Below is a summary of some of the more significant risks and issues discussed in the year by the Committee.

During 2013 there were no topics where there was significant disagreement between management, our external auditor and the Committee or unresolved issues which needed to be referred to the Board.

Technology Risk

As the Group has progressed through the strategy, the technology infrastructure supporting the business has evolved to support the rebalancing of the business opportunities from new revenue streams and the production business. Legacy systems supporting the existing business remain in place, while emerging technology has been adopted to support new opportunities. It is therefore important to have in place an effective technology governance framework that seeks to address the risks posed by the Group's technology environment. The governance framework, which is reviewed by the Committee, seeks to identify and manage key risks and provide oversight and methodologies around governing change and major projects.

In 2012 reviews by internal and external audit highlighted a number of opportunities to improve the governance of our core systems. The Committee and management agreed a set of actions and a workplan to address these, most of which were completed by the end of 2013.  Work will continue to finalise remaining actions which will be kept under review by the Committee and internal and external audit.

The Group has a technology governance and assurance team who ensure a coordinated approach is in place to mitigate the risks faced in technology. In 2013 two key high risk areas were reviewed by the Committee:

·     As part of a wider end-to-end review of the broadcast transmission infrastructure (including interaction with third party outsource providers), the incident management and governance processes were revisited, and a number of changes were agreed for implementation.

·     There has been significant media coverage of the recent increase in attacks on corporate infrastructure. Examples of such issues include the loss of customer data due to hacking and the disruption of corporate social media feeds. In response to these cyber security threats, the Committee discussed management's assurance plans around information security and technology infrastructure.

Financial Reporting

As part of the Committee's review of the interim and year-end financial statements, the following were discussed:

Complex discrete transactions in the year

The Group completed certain transactions during the period which were outside the normal course of business. The Committee carefully reviewed these one-off transactions to ensure that the judgements applied by management were reasonable and any complex accounting guidance followed correctly. The topics discussed in the year covered acquisitions, debt settlements and large property acquisitions.

Acquisition accounting (see note 3.4 for details of acquisitions): following the acquisition of four businesses during the year, the Committee debated the accounting for the key areas of judgement: the determination of whether ITV has control of the entity and should therefore consolidate its accounts in the Group's accounts, the presentation of performance-related contingent payments or earn-out costs in the income statement, and determining the fair values of the net assets acquired:

·     Control: this was particularly relevant for acquisitions that were structured so that the Group acquired a majority equity interest in a company, but less than 100%. The Committee debated ITV's majority representation, control of budgets and decision-making power on the new boards and concluded that the Group does control each of the businesses acquired. 

·     Performance-related consideration and earnouts: the Group's acquisitions include an amount which is payable based on future performance of the business. Structuring the acquisition this way helps manage risks in terms of initial capital outlay and creates a joint incentive between ITV and the previous owners to grow the business. This is a feature that is common for acquisitions in the creative industry. Where the payment is also linked to employment, IFRS requires it to be accrued as a remuneration operating cost over the period to payment. The Committee debated the presentation of the transaction and concluded that these costs are linked to a capital transaction and their size and nature warrants them being excluded from underlying earnings (adjusted profit). Once acquired and the earnout period has been completed, operational salary and bonuses payable to the sellers are treated as part of operating costs.

·     Intangibles: the Committee reviewed the results of the exercise to allocate the purchase price between intangible assets and goodwill and agreed with management's allocation.

Debt settlements: as part of management's continued efforts to improve the balance sheet and remove remaining expensive debt, the Group repurchased significant debt in the year. Accounting for these repurchases, though complex, required little judgement. However, due to the significant loss of £61 million the Committee sought to ensure the accounting standards had been applied correctly. The Committee considered the source of the inputs management used in calculating the amount of loss to be recognised and concluded that the accounting was appropriate.

Acquisition of the London Television Centre: the Group acquired its headquarters in January. The Committee discussed the analysis undertaken by management to allocate the purchase price between the value of the land and building, which is required by the new accounting standard on fair value measurements. Real estate consultants were engaged to provide an estimate of the land value. The Committee considered the results of the exercise and agreed with management's allocation
(see note 3.2).

Recurring transactions in the year

There are a number of areas where the Group transacts as part of its business as usual. However, these areas may require the application of judgement by management or have underlying complexity that should be considered on an ongoing basis by the Committee. Consequently, the topics noted below are regularly reviewed by the Committee:

Revenue: every year the Committee considers management's assessment of the Group's internal controls framework, which includes control over revenue. The Group's processes and controls around existing revenue streams, such as NAR and Studios revenues, have remained consistent and effective during the year.

As new revenue streams emerge - which has been seen in areas such as the Online, Pay & Interactive business - the Committee reviews policies adopted by management to recognise revenue and considers the related controls. The policies and controls adopted in 2013 are consistent with prior years and are considered appropriate by the Committee. No changes have occurred during the year.

Deal debt: deal debt is where management provides for over/under delivery of advertising value to agencies. The Committee reviews management's approach and method of determining the provision required and ensures consistency is applied in estimating inputs. The Committee is satisfied that the provision has been calculated on a consistent basis with prior years.

Royalty accruals: the Group is required to make royalty payments for content broadcast and distributed. Such payments are in accordance with individual contracts, and the large variety of terms results in a complex and manual process. As part of the agreed 2013 plan, internal audit reviewed the controls around the royalty accrual process without significant finding. As with previous years, the Committee considered the estimated accrual to be reasonable.

Pension accounting: the Group's defined benefit pension scheme is a significant liability on the Group's balance sheet (see note 3.7) and the value of the scheme will fluctuate due to changes in underlying assumptions. The main assumptions which drive these fluctuations include the forecast bond yield rates and the forecast inflation rate. A particular feature affecting 2013 has been the valuation of a longevity swap. A recent change to IFRS has required the swap to be recorded at fair value on a different basis from the best estimate of value on which the swap was previously recorded. The Committee considered both the process management undertook to finalise the assumptions, and how these assumptions benchmark against the market. In particular, because of the size of the valuation adjustment to the longevity swap of £95 million, the Committee confirmed the changes in IFRS had been appropriately applied with our auditors and the sources of information on which the recorded valuation was based. The Committee concluded that that the process was robust and the resulting calculation appropriately balanced.

Tax: the Group recognises certain provisions and accruals in respect of tax. The Committee debates the nature and key risks which give rise to corporate tax, payroll and VAT issues, and discusses the activities management undertake to resolve the matters that give rise to such provisions. Where support from our tax advisers is received, the results and views of their work are also reviewed. The Committee concluded that the provisions at the year-end were appropriate (see note 2.3).

Risk Management

The Committee continued to consider the process for managing risk within the business.

Every year the Board and senior management review and challenge the Group's High Impact Low Likelihood (HILL) risks, and the strategic risks. Each risk is assigned an owner and has a series of mitigating actions identified. An updated list of risks is included within the Strategic Report on pages 53 to 55.

For each HILL risk the Committee reviewed the Group's current level of exposure and considered the appropriateness of the mitigating actions being taken by management.

The Committee also considered management's response to each strategic risk, including the level of assurance provided around the risk and how the risk is tracked using key risk indicators. With regard to process risks the Committee reviewed how effective management was in addressing the findings of internal and external audit, as well as the method by which management accepted process risks.

The Committee was comfortable with the processes in place for risk management, that the internal audit plan for 2014 was aligned to the highlighted risks and with those process risks that have been accepted.

Internal controls

The Board has overall responsibility for the Group's systems of internal control and for regularly reviewing the effectiveness of those systems. The Committee assists the Board in reviewing the Group's systems of internal control.  The primary responsibility for the operation of these systems is delegated to management. Such systems can only provide reasonable and not absolute assurance against material misstatement or loss. Key control procedures are designed to manage rather than eliminate risk and can be summarised as follows:

·     Strategy and financial reporting: the strategy is reviewed and approved by the Board. The Group performs a comprehensive annual strategy review and five year financial planning exercise. The five-year plan feeds into the annual budget cycle. The Executive Directors review formal forecasts, detailed budgets, strategies and action plans and the Board approves the overall Group budget as part of its normal responsibilities. The results of operating units are reported monthly, along with an update of the Group's performance against strategic KPIs and cash. Actual results are compared to budget and forecasts, and key trends and variances are explained and analysed.

·     Organisational structure and authorisation procedures: the Group has an established organisational structure with clearly stated lines of responsibility, approval levels and delegated authorities.

·     Risk assessment and management: management is responsible for identifying the risks facing the business and for establishing controls and procedures to monitor and mitigate those risks.

·     The Board is responsible for establishing a robust risk management process and for regularly reviewing the identified risks. The Committee keeps the effectiveness of the process under regular review.

·     Control environment: financial controls, policies, and procedures are considered as part of the Group's ongoing risk assessment process. These controls are reviewed to ensure risks are identified and the processes and procedures are in accordance with and aligned to the strategy. The internal audit team provides objective assurance as to the effectiveness of the Group's systems of internal control and risk management, reporting to both the Management Board and the Committee.

·     Reviewing and monitoring the effectiveness of internal controls: controls are monitored by senior management, internal audit and the Committee.  Remedial plans are put in place where controls are weak or there are opportunities for improvement. Serious control weaknesses (if any) are reported to the Board and actions taken as appropriate.

·     Data analytics: during the year the Group implemented a suite of automated analytics tests that enables the Group to continuously highlight exceptions from the norm over its transactional financial data. Going forward, this will make the control environment stronger and more efficient.

Our auditors

Internal auditor

The Group's internal audit activity is outsourced to Deloitte who report directly to the Committee. The Committee keeps under review the internal audit relationship with Deloitte and the procedures to ensure appropriate independence of the internal audit function is maintained. In particular, the Committee has approved guidelines in relation to other advisory and consultancy work that Deloitte may undertake for the Company, which adheres to the underlying principle that they cannot implement controls that they audit. During the year Deloitte provided the Group with advice on remuneration policy and the external remuneration environment. Other services included tax and corporate finance advice.

The effectiveness of internal audit is assessed over the year using a number of measures which include (but are not limited to):

·     an evaluation of each audit assignment completed using feedback from the part of the business that has been audited; and

·     a high level annual review that is completed by obtaining feedback from senior management in each division.

At the start of the year the Committee considered and approved the internal audit plan, which included audits across the Group as well as assurance over live projects. During the year the Committee reviewed findings from these internal audit reports, the actions taken to implement the recommendations made in the reports and the status of progress against previously agreed actions. All internal audit reports are available to the Committee as required.

External auditor

Auditor engagement

Throughout the year the Committee receives reports from the auditors on their plans and the progress and results of their work.

The Committee considers carefully the scope of planned work and the assessment of risk and materiality on which it is based. In particular the Committee reviews the audit fee arrangements to ensure that there is an appropriate balance between the scope of work and the cost of assurance. The Committee's aim is to support a robust and effective audit and strong reporting lines to the Committee.

In 2012 the Committee conducted a tender process for external audit services, the main outcome of which was the reappointment of KPMG, and a plan for the development of the external audit approach over a two to three year period.

The principal planned changes agreed were that:

·     the scope of the external audit will consider developments in certain areas of the business earlier than otherwise might have been considered necessary on a traditional assessment of financial materiality, such as certain online revenues and controls over and at smaller overseas acquisitions ; and

·     the data analytics implemented by management as part of the internal control initiatives will allow for all year round routine audit tests through exception reporting, making the control environment both stronger and more efficient. Further, the embedded technology will support internal and external audit's systems evaluation and testing.

The Committee continues to monitor the implementation of these changes.

Auditor effectiveness

Audit quality is reviewed throughout the year with the focus on: strong audit governance; the firm's methodology and its effective application to ITV; robustness of challenges and findings on areas which require management judgement; and the quality of the senior members of the audit team.

In particular, the effectiveness of the audit is assessed over the year using a number of measures including (but not limited to):

·     reviewing the quality and scope of planning of the audit and its responsiveness to changes in our business;

·     implementation of planned improvements identified in the audit tender process;

·     monitoring the independence and transparency of the audit;

·     reviewing the Financial Reporting Council's Audit Quality Review (AQR) reports for KPMG and other audit firms; and

·     seeking feedback from KPMG on any external or internal quality review of our audit.

At the conclusion of each year's audit the Committee performs a specific evaluation of the performance of the external auditor. This is supported by the results of questionnaires completed by the Executive Directors and relevant senior management, both finance and non-finance, covering areas such as quality of audit team, business understanding, audit approach and management. Where appropriate, actions are agreed against the points raised and subsequently monitored for progress. There were no significant findings from the evaluation this year and the Committee considers the external audit to have been robust and effective.

Independence, objectivity and fees

The Committee seeks to ensure the objectivity and independence of our auditors through:

·     focus on the assignment and rotation of key personnel;

·     the adequacy of audit resource; and

·     policies in relation to non-audit work.

The senior audit partner serves no more than five years continuously and the independent review partner serves no more than seven years continuously. Other key partners serve for no longer than seven consecutive years. The Committee monitors the tenure of partners and senior staff as well as former employees working for the Company. The appointment by the Company of former senior employees of the external auditor would require approval of the Committee.

The Committee regularly monitors the other services being provided to the Group by its external auditor, and has developed a formal policy to ensure this does not impair their independence or objectivity. The policy is based on the five key principles which underpin the provision of other services by the external auditor. These are that the auditor may not provide a service which:

·     places them in a position to audit their own work;

·     creates a mutuality of interest;

·     results in the auditor developing close personal relationships with ITV employees;

·     results in the auditor functioning as a manager or employee of ITV; or

·     puts the auditor in the role of advocate for ITV.

The policy is reviewed annually and is available in full on our website.

Other than in exceptional circumstances management and the Committee do not expect non-audit fees to be in excess of fees for audit and audit related services. The non-audit fees for 2013 were half that of the audit fees. A report on the level of non-audit work provided by the auditor is given to the Committee half yearly. No changes have been made to the policy during the year.

The significant non-audit engagements related to VAT and corporate tax services, including tax advice. Significant engagements require the prior approval of the Chairman of the Committee.

Reappointment

During the year the Committee considered the performance and audit fees of the external auditor, and the level of non-audit work undertaken, and recommended to the Board that a resolution for the reappointment of KPMG Audit Plc for a further year as the Company's auditor be proposed to shareholders at the AGM in May 2013. The resolution was passed and KPMG Audit Plc was reappointed for a further year.

KPMG has instigated an orderly wind-down of KPMG Audit Plc as a result of an internal reorganisation and requested that going forward the audit is instead undertaken by KPMG LLP (an intermediate parent of KPMG Audit Plc). KPMG Audit Plc will not therefore be seeking re-appointment as auditor of the Company and in accordance with the Companies Act 2006, a resolution proposing the appointment of KPMG LLP as our auditor will be put to the 2014 AGM.

Remuneration Report

In this report . . .

The purpose of this report is to set out for shareholders the principles and policy we apply to remuneration for our Executive Directors and to update you on how we have applied these for the financial year ended 31 December 2013.  The report also aims to demonstrate how our remuneration policy is aligned to our strategy, supports the retention of the Executive Directors and rewards them for outperformance.

This report is subject for the first time to amended legislation on remuneration and we will be asking our shareholders at the 2014 AGM to approve our:

·     Remuneration policy as set out on pages 85 to 92. This will be a binding vote.

·     Annual Report on Remuneration as set out on pages 93 to 101. This will be an advisory vote.

We would encourage our shareholders to provide us with feedback if they feel we could provide more clarity in our reporting.

 

Dear Shareholder,

On the following pages we set out the Remuneration Report for 2013. Our report looks quite different this year as we are required for the first time to comply with new UK regulations on the disclosure of directors' remuneration.

Remuneration review

During 2013 we undertook an extensive review of our approach to remunerating Executive Directors. As a result of this review we will be asking our shareholders to support three resolutions on executive remuneration matters at our AGM in May 2014:

·     We will be seeking shareholder approval for a new Long Term Incentive Plan (new LTIP).

·     We will be asking our shareholders to formally approve our remuneration policy for the first time.

·     We will be holding an advisory vote on our Annual Report on Remuneration.

We have consulted extensively with our major shareholders on these proposals and where appropriate their comments have been reflected.

Objectives for the remuneration review

The principal objective of the review was to ensure that the remuneration framework remains aligned with the strategy of the business as ITV moves into the next phase.

The current remuneration arrangements were put in place for 2011 when the Board set out to build a top calibre, highly motivated team to lead the renewal of ITV and have strongly supported the strategy over this time. Performance has been outstanding and delivered real value to shareholders over the period to 31 December 2013, including:

·     Share price growth of 177% (around 40% per annum).

·     £5.1 billion of additional value to shareholders.

·     Significant outperformance of the FTSE 250 and
FTSE 100.

The Committee wants to ensure that the remuneration framework continues to incentivise and reward strong business performance and shareholder value during the next phase of the strategy, and acts as a retention tool to retain the key management team that has delivered outstanding performance to date.

Summary of the key changes

The adjustments to remuneration strategy include the following elements:

·     Simple to understand - We heard that going forward shareholders wanted us to adopt a simpler approach to remuneration. We have therefore removed the link between the voluntary deferral of annual bonuses and long-term incentive award levels.

·     Performance measures aligned to the next phase of our business strategy - Our new LTIP will ensure that the continued delivery of our strategy is rewarded. We have amended the performance tests to reflect strategic challenges and align them more closely with the continuing evolution into a more balanced business.

·     Increased shareholding guidelines - We have increased the minimum shareholding requirements for our Executive Directors. The combination of executive shareholding requirements, deferred annual bonuses and share-based long-term incentives will strongly align executive incentives with shareholder value.

·     Longer holding periods - Reflecting the preference of the Committee and our shareholders, we are also introducing an additional two year holding period for awards under the new LTIP. This will be phased in over the next two award cycles.

·     Adjusted salaries to reflect the size and complexity of the Executive Director roles - Our remuneration policy for Executive Directors has been, and will continue to be, that salary increases will generally follow those of the wider employee population. This approach has been adopted since their appointment. During that time the shape and size of the business has changed significantly and performance has been strong. We have therefore increased base salaries to reflect increased responsibilities, performance, marketability and the challenges ahead. Following these increases it is our intention to return to normal policy in 2015.  We have also increased pension allowances in the year to reflect the levels of pension provision provided to Executive Directors in comparable organisations.

·     Provide market competitive levels of remuneration comparative to performance - We are proposing to increase long-term incentive opportunities to levels that reflect the current size and challenge of the Executive Director roles, the level of performance delivered and the current size of the Company.

·     Performance targets set at stretching levels to reflect business outlook - Performance target ranges will continue to be set at levels that reward strong business performance. The level of vesting for threshold performance has been reduced, reflecting the increased award levels.  When considering performance outcomes the Committee will look beyond formulaic results to ensure the outcomes align with the overall business performance.

The Committee has been thoughtful about the combined value of all of the proposed changes, as well as the individual elements. In summary, the overall remuneration packages are intended to support the retention of the Executive Directors in the business and to reward them for continuing to deliver strong business performance and shareholder value.

The increase in total remuneration for the Chief Executive from 2012 to 2013 results from the vesting of his joining award in 2013, together with the first vesting under a PSP award since he joined ITV. The level of vesting of both awards reflects the outstanding performance to date and a significant increase in share price.

Further details are provided in our remuneration policy.

The Committee initiates dialogue with major shareholders where developments or changes are proposed and welcomes feedback at other times.

We look forward to receiving your support for all three resolutions at our forthcoming AGM.

Andy Haste

Chairman, Remuneration Committee26 February 2014

 

Who is on the Committee

The Committee is comprised entirely of Non-executive Directors. The current members are:

·     Andy Haste (Chairman)

·     Archie Norman

·     John Ormerod

Mike Clasper stepped down from the Board and as member of the Committee on 31 December 2013.

How the Committee works

What is our role?

The role of the Committee is primarily to:

·     review the ongoing appropriateness, relevance and effectiveness of the Group remuneration policy including in relation to retention and development;

·     approve the remuneration policy and strategy for the Executive Directors, Management Board and other senior executives (together the Senior Executive Group);

·     approve the design of the Company's annual bonus arrangements and long-term incentive plans, including the performance targets that apply for the Senior Executive Group; and

·     determine the award levels for the Senior Executive Group based on performance against annual bonus targets and long-term incentive conditions.

Principles considered when setting remuneration

The Company operates in the particularly competitive media market. We aim to balance the need to attract and retain high quality talent essential to the Company's success with the need to be cost-effective and to reward exceptional performance. The Committee has developed a remuneration policy for the Company which balances these factors, while taking into account the prevailing best practice and a fair outcome for investors.

A significant proportion of the remuneration package is tied to the achievement of stretching performance conditions which align remuneration with our strategy to deliver strong business performance and create shareholder value. Individuals should be rewarded for success and performance measured over clear timescales. The remuneration package is focused on rewarding sustained long-term performance and aligning executives with the shareholder experience.

What we did in 2013?

In addition to the remuneration review described in the Chairman's letter, during 2013 our work was broadly in four areas:

Setting targets

·     setting the business and personal performance targets for 2013 annual bonuses aligned with the business plan for the year;

·     setting the performance targets that would apply to the ITV Performance Share Plan (PSP) awards made in 2013; and

·     carrying out a preliminary review of annual bonus targets for 2014.

Reviewing outcomes

·     reviewing the annual bonus outcomes and award levels for 2012 and indicative 2013 outcomes ahead of final approval in 2014; and

·     approving the performance outcomes of the 2010 awards under the PSP, including the awards made on recruitment to Adam Crozier.

Reward framework

·     agreeing the base salaries for the Senior Executive Group with effect from 1 January 2013 using the same process as applied to the wider employee population;

·     reviewing the pension allowances provided to Executive Directors;

·     agreeing the remuneration packages for new appointments to the Senior Executive Group and the arrangements for any leavers from this group; and

·     agreeing a new remuneration framework and new LTIP as set out in the Chairman's letter.

Governance

·     considering the final BIS regulations on executive pay and how these will be integrated into the future remuneration strategy; and

·     agreeing the Remuneration Report for 2012, prior to its approval by the Board, and approval by shareholders at the AGM in May 2013.

The Committee reports regularly to the Board on its work.

An annual review of the performance of the Committee was conducted. Feedback was also sought from the Chief Executive, Group HR Director and Deloitte. Overall the review concluded that the Committee is responding appropriately to its terms of reference and will continue to develop its role.

Remuneration policy

The table below summarises the main elements of the remuneration packages for the Executive Directors and will be           effective from the date approved by shareholders and will apply until shareholders next consider and vote on the policy.

Fixed Elements

Purpose and

link to strategy

Operation

Maximum potential payment

Performance Metrics

Base Salary

Reflects the individual's skills, responsibilities and experience.

Supports the recruitment and retention of Executive Directors of the calibre required to deliver the business strategy within the competitive media market.

Reviewed annually and paid monthly in cash.

Consideration is typically given to a range of factors when determining salary levels, including:

·     Personal and Company-wide performance.

·     Typical pay levels in relevant markets for each executive whilst recognising the need for an appropriate premium to attract and retain superior talent, balanced against the need to provide a cost-effective overall remuneration package.

·     The wider employee pay review.

There is no maximum salary increase. However, ordinarily salary increases will be in line with the average increase awarded to other employees in the Company.

Increases may be made above this level to take account of individual circumstances, which may include:

·     Increase in size or scope of the role or responsibility.

·     Increase to reflect the individual's development and performance in role.

 

None, although overall individual and business performance is considered when setting and reviewing salaries.

 

Provision for an income in retirement

To provide competitive post-retirement benefits or cash allowance as a framework to save for retirement.

Supports the recruitment and retention of Executive Directors of the calibre required to deliver the business strategy within the competitive media market.

 

Executives can choose to participate in the ITV defined contribution scheme, receive a cash allowance or receive payments into a personal pension or a combination thereof.

Contributions are set as a percentage of base salary.

Post-retirement benefits do not form part of the base salary for the purposes of determining incentives.

The maximum contributions or cash allowances for the Executive Directors are 25% of base salary.

 

None

Benefits

Ensures the overall package is competitive and provides financial protection for employees and their families.

 

The Company provides a range of market competitive benefits including travel related benefits, private medical insurance and other insurance benefits.

Additional benefits may also be provided in certain circumstances, if required for business need. For example (but not limited to), relocation expenses, housing allowance and education support.

Set at a level which the Committee considers to be appropriately positioned taking into account typical market levels for comparable roles, individual circumstances and the overall cost to the business.

 

None

 

Variable Elements

Purpose and

link to strategy

Operation

Maximum potential payment

Performance Metrics

Annual Bonus Scheme (Bonus) and Deferred Share Award Plan (DSA)

Incentivises executives and colleagues to achieve key strategic outcomes on an annual basis.

Focus on key financial metrics and objectives to deliver the business strategy.

The element compulsorily deferred into shares rewards delivery of sustained long-term performance, provides alignment with the shareholder experience and supports the retention of executives.

 

Measures and targets are set annually based on business plans at the start of the financial year and pay-out levels are determined by the Committee following the year end based on performance against objectives.

Paid once the results have been audited. Annual bonus calculations that are based on the financial results for the year are audited by Internal Audit and reviewed by the Audit Committee before consideration by the Committee.

The Committee has the discretion to amend the bonus pay-out should any formulaic assessment of performance not reflect a balanced view of overall business performance for the year.

Two-thirds of the bonus is delivered in cash and one-third is deferred into shares under the DSA for a period of three years.

During the deferral period share awards may be reduced or cancelled in certain circumstances. Further detail is provided on page 88.

Dividends are paid to participants on the deferred shares during the deferral period.

The maximum bonus opportunity for any Executive Director will not exceed 200% of salary.

The current bonus opportunities are 180% of salary for Adam Crozier and 165% of salary for Ian Griffiths.

Increases above the current opportunities, up to the maximum limit, may be made to take account of individual circumstances, which may include:

·     Increase in size or scope of the role or responsibility.

·     Increase to reflect the individual's development and performance in their role.

Performance measures and targets are set by the Committee each year based on corporate objectives closely linked to the strategic priorities and individual contributions.

The majority of the bonus opportunity will be based on the corporate and financial measures.

The remainder of the bonus will be based on performance against individual objectives.

Up to 20% of the maximum opportunity will be received for threshold performance.

New LTIP

Incentivises executives to deliver performance which is aligned to the business strategy over the longer term and the creation of shareholder value.

Acts as a retention tool to retain the executives required to deliver the business strategy.

 

Awards are made under the LTIP rules, which shareholders have been asked to approve at the 2014 AGM.

Awards are made annually with vesting dependent on business performance during the performance period. The performance period will be three years, other than in exceptional circumstances.

The Committee has discretion to amend the final vesting level should any formulaic assessment of performance not reflect a balanced view of the business performance during the performance period.

Awards will be required to be held for an additional period of two years after the end of the performance period. This is called the holding period and will be phased in during 2014 and 2015.

Dividends are earned on deferred shares during the holding period.

During the holding period awards may be reduced or cancelled in certain circumstances. Further detail is provided on page 88.

Our current operational policy is to make awards of 225% of salary each year.

Under the new LTIP rules, the maximum annual award that may be granted in any financial year is 350% of salary.

The Committee would consult with shareholders if it was considering increasing awards above the current operational policy.

 

Performance is measured against corporate targets closely linked to the Company's financial and strategic priorities.

Performance metrics are:

·     Adjusted EPS

·     Non-NAR and its components

·     Viewing performance

For details on 2014 targets see page 99.

LTIP awards will vest based on financial performance.

A gateway condition must be achieved before any portion of the award vests.

Each performance metric will operate independently.

The performance range will be determined for each metric. The proportion of each element of the award that will vest for threshold performance against a metric will be 20%.

 

SAYE

Provides all employees, including Executive Directors the opportunity to voluntarily invest in Company shares.

Executive Directors are entitled to participate in the plan on the same basis as other employees.

 

Participation limits are as per the rules of the plan and in accordance with HMRC limits.

 

None

 

Should the Company choose to implement a tax efficient all-employee share participation plan (for example a SIP) the Executive Directors would be eligible to participate in accordance with any shareholder approved plan rules and HMRC limits.

Legacy plans

The Committee may make any remuneration payments and payments for loss of office (including exercising any discretions available to it in connection with such payments) notwithstanding that they are not in line with the policy set out above. This would apply where the terms of the payment were agreed before the policy came into effect or at a time when the relevant individual was not a director of the Company and the payment was not in consideration for the individual becoming a director of the Company.

Subject to the approval by shareholders of the new LTIP, there is no current intention for further awards to be made to Executive Directors under the PSP, details of which are set out below:

Purpose and link to strategy

Operation

Maximum potential payment

Performance Metrics

Incentivises executives to deliver performance that is aligned to the business strategy over the longer term and the creation of shareholder value.

Acts as a retention tool to retain the executives required to deliver the business strategy.

Awards are made under the PSP rules which shareholders have previously approved.

The Committee has the discretion to amend the final vesting level should any formulaic assessment of performance not reflect overall business performance.

Under the plan rules, the maximum annual award that may be granted in any financial year is 150% of salary.

Performance is measured against corporate targets closely linked to the Company's financial and strategic priorities.

 

A gateway condition must be achieved before any portion of the award vests.

 

Malus and clawback

Malus is the possible reduction of deferred awards and clawback is the possible recovery of awards that have already been made to executives. Deferred awards under the DSA and awards under the new LTIP or PSP, including awards held during any additional holding period, may be reduced or cancelled at the Committee's discretion in such cases as material misstatement of results, gross misconduct or fraud.

Performance measures and target setting

The annual bonus is assessed against both financial and individual targets determined by the Committee. This enables the Committee to reward both annual financial performance delivered for shareholders, and performance against specific financial, operational or strategic objectives set for each director, which are closely linked to the strategic priorities of the business.

The Committee sets targets for the long-term incentive plans taking into account external forecasts, internal budgets and business priorities. Targets are set to be appropriately stretching in this context with maximum performance being set at a level which is considered to be the delivery of exceptional performance.

When considering performance outcomes the Committee will look beyond formulaic results to ensure the outcomes align with the overall business performance.

Non-executive Directors

The table below summarises the main elements of remuneration for Non-executive Directors:

Component

Approach of the Company

Chairman fees

The Committee determines the fees of the Chairman and sets the fees at a level that is considered to be appropriate, taking into account the size and complexity of the business and the expected time commitment and contribution of the role.

The fee is a fixed annual fee of which 25% (40% for the current Chairman) after statutory deductions, is used to acquire shares in the Company. The shares are purchased quarterly and held by a nominee until retirement from the Board.

Non-executive fees

The Board determines the fees of the Non-executive Directors and sets the fees at a level that is considered to be appropriate, taking into account the size and complexity of the business and the expected time commitment and contribution of the role.

Fees are structured as a basic fee with additional fees payable for membership and/or chairmanship of a committee or other additional responsibilities.

The Non-executive Directors are required to use 25% of their annual fees, after statutory deductions, to acquire shares in the Company. The shares are purchased quarterly and held by a nominee on their behalf until they retire from the Board.

Benefits

Additional benefits may also be provided in certain circumstances, if required for business purposes.

 

Application of remuneration policy

The chart below provides an indication of the level of remuneration that would be received by each Executive Director under the following three assumed performance scenarios:

Below threshold performance

Fixed elements of remuneration only - base salary, benefits and pension

On-target performance

Assumes 60% pay-out under the annual bonus

Assumes 20% pay-out under the LTIP (aligned with threshold performance)

Maximum performance

Assumes 100% pay-out under the annual bonus

Assumes 100% pay-out under the LTIP

 

Notes:

1.   The scenarios do not include any share price growth assumptions or take into account any dividends that may be paid.

2.   Fixed pay is the salary as at 1 January 2014, pension is per the remuneration policy, and the value for benefits is equivalent to that included in the remuneration table on page 93.

3.   Annual bonus is based on 180% of salary for Adam Crozier and 165% of salary for Ian Griffiths.

4.   LTI amount is based on 225% of salary for both Executive Directors.

 

Recruitment remuneration

When agreeing the components of a remuneration package for a new Executive Director, the Committee will apply the principles detailed below.

The package will be competitive to attract and retain the best candidate for the job.

Where possible, the Committee will always seek to align the remuneration package with the remuneration policy outlined above. However, where appropriate, elements of the package may be outside of this policy to meet the circumstances of the individual upon recruitment.  The Committee will ensure that the arrangements are in the best interests of both ITV and its shareholders and remain subject to the overall variable pay limits set out below. 

Ongoing remuneration

In determining an appropriate remuneration structure and levels, the Committee will take into account all relevant factors to ensure they are able to recruit the best candidate for the job and that the arrangements are in the best interests of both ITV and its shareholders. The Committee will typically seek to align the ongoing remuneration package with the ongoing remuneration policy outlined in the table on pages 85 to 87.

The maximum level of variable remuneration which may be granted to a new director upon appointment (excluding any buy-out awards for forfeited remuneration) will not be greater than 550% of salary (the sum of the maximum bonus and maximum new LTIP opportunities).

Buy-out awards for forfeited remuneration

The Committee may make awards to 'buy out' a candidate's remuneration arrangements that are forfeited as a result of leaving their previous employer.

In doing so, the Committee will take account of relevant factors including any performance conditions attaching to forfeited awards, the likelihood of the awards vesting and the form and timing of the awards. The Committee will typically seek to make buy-out awards on a comparable basis to those that have been forfeited.

In exceptional circumstances, the Committee may grant a buy-out award under a structure not included in the policy but that is consistent with the principles set out above.

 

The Committee will take all relevant factors into account (including the candidate's location, the calibre of the individual, external influences, internal relativities and the overall business context) when determining the new remuneration package and seek to ensure that no more is paid than necessary.

In the Remuneration Report following the appointment, the Committee will fully explain to shareholders the remuneration package for the appointed individual and the rationale for such arrangements and will display such information on the ITV plc website and announce via a regulatory information service as soon as practicable following the appointment.

Service contracts and loss of office

Executive Directors

Executive Directors have rolling service contracts that provide for 12 months' notice on either side. There are no special provisions that apply in the event of a change of control.

A payment in lieu of notice, including base salary, contractual benefits and contractual provision for an income in retirement may be made if:

·     the Company terminates the employment of the executive with immediate effect, or without due notice; or

·     termination is agreed by mutual consent.

The Company may also make a payment in respect of outplacement costs, legal fees and the cost of any settlement agreement where appropriate.

With the exception of termination for cause or resignation, Executive Directors will be eligible for a bonus award prorated to reflect the proportion of the financial year for which they were employed and subject to performance achieved, provided they have a minimum of three months' service in the bonus year.

The treatment of shares awarded under the DSA, new LTIP and PSP on termination, are set out below.

 

 

Good leaver

Mutual agreement

Resignation/misconduct

Change of control

DSA

Injury, ill health, disability or transfer of undertakings. Awards release in full at the leaving date.

For other good leaver reasons awards release at the end of the deferral period.

Committee has the right to exercise its discretion as to the extent to which awards, if any, may release, for example where someone is asked to leave because of a change in circumstances outside of their control. 

Awards lapse.

Note 2

Awards release in full at effective date of change.

New LTIP

During performance period:

Injury, ill health or disability, redundancy, retirement or transfer of undertaking.

Awards are prorated for time served and subject to achievement of the performance conditions during the performance period.

 

Awards become exercisable at end of holding period.

Committee has the right to exercise its discretion to apply good leaver treatment, for example where someone is asked to leave because of a change in circumstances outside of their control.

Awards lapse.

Outstanding awards would normally vest and become exercisable subject to satisfaction of performance conditions and capped based on the time in the performance period since grant, subject to the discretion of the Committee.

During additional holding period:

Awards become exercisable at end of holding period.

Awards become exercisable at end of holding period.

For resignation, awards become exercisable at end of holding period.

In the case of misconduct awards will lapse.

Awards become exercisable at effective date of change.

PSP

Injury, ill health or disability, redundancy, retirement or transfer of undertaking.

Awards are prorated for time served during the performance period and become exercisable at normal vesting date subject to achievement of the performance conditions.

Committee has the right to exercise its discretion to apply good leaver treatment, for example where someone is asked to leave because of a change in circumstances outside of their control.

Awards lapse.

Outstanding awards would normally vest and become exercisable subject to satisfaction of performance conditions and capped based on the time in the performance period since grant.

 

Notes:

1.   If a participant dies all awards vest in full with no regard to performance conditions.

2.   DSA awards made to Executive Directors in March 2011, 2012, 2013 and 2014, prior to the adoption of the remuneration policy set out here release in full on resignation.

 

Non-executive Directors

Each Non-executive Director, including the Chairman, has a contract of service with the Company. Non-executive Directors will serve for an initial term of three years, subject to election and annual re-election by shareholders, unless otherwise terminated earlier by and at the discretion of either party upon one month's written notice (12 month's for the current Chairman).

The Directors' service contracts and letters of appointment are available for inspection at the Company's registered office.

External appointments

With specific approval of the Board, Executive Directors may accept external appointments as non-executive directors of other companies and retain any related fees paid to them.

Adam Crozier is currently a non-executive director of G4S plc.

Employment conditions elsewhere in the Company

When setting the policy for directors' remuneration, the Committee considers the pay and employment conditions of employees elsewhere in the Company.

The Company does not consult directly with employees in respect of determining the Directors' remuneration policy. However, the Committee does receive general feedback from employees via the HR function as part of the output from the employee engagement survey and receives a report on employment practices elsewhere in the Company.

Shareholder views

The Committee maintains regular and transparent communication with shareholders. We believe that it is important to regularly meet with our key shareholders to understand their views on our remuneration arrangements and what they would like to see going forward. We welcome feedback from shareholders at any time during the year.

Where we are proposing to make any significant changes to the remuneration framework we seek major shareholders' views and take these into account when determining any changes to the remuneration policy.

 

Annual Report on Remuneration

The sections of the Annual Report on Remuneration that have been audited by KPMG Audit Plc are page 93 to page 96 (up to and including payments to past directors or for loss of office) and page 100 (from Interests in Shares as at 31 December 2013) to page 101.

Total remuneration

Executive Directors

The table below sets out in a single figure the total remuneration for both Executive Directors for the financial year.


  Salary

Taxable benefits

  Bonus (cash

    and shares)

 PSP awards

Joining

award

 Pension

Total


2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

Adam Crozier

841

818

20

19

1,403

1,345

2,042

0

3,950

658

109

74

8,365

2,914

Ian Griffiths

461

449

14

14

713

683

2,130

771

0

0

81

69

3,399

1,986


1,302

1,267

34

33

2,116

2,028

4,172

771

3,950

658

190

143

11,764

4,900

 

The increase in total remuneration for the Chief Executive from 2012 to 2013 results from the vesting of his joining award in 2013, together with the first vesting under a PSP award since he joined ITV. The level of vesting of both awards reflects the outstanding performance to date and a significant increase in share price.

Further information in relation to each of the elements of remuneration set out in the table above are detailed below.

Salary

Executive Directors' base salaries were increased by 2.75% with effect from 1 January 2013 in line with the average increase given across the Company.

Taxable benefits

The benefits provided to the Executive Directors include the cost of private medical insurance and car related benefits.

Bonus (cash and shares)

The bonus paid in respect of the financial year includes amounts that will be compulsorily deferred into shares for a three year period as set out below.


% of maximum bonus opportunity earned

Value deferred into shares under the DSA

£000

Value paid

in cash

      £000

Total value

of 2013

Bonus

£000

Adam Crozier

92.75%

468

935

1,403

Ian Griffiths

93.79%

238

475

713

 

Annual incentives are provided to Executive Directors through the bonus with one-third of any award deferred into shares under the DSA. The performance conditions that apply to the bonus are set on an individual basis and are closely linked to the Company's corporate, financial and strategic priorities.

The Committee set 2013 performance targets and measures which continue to support both the delivery of the strategy and key operational outcomes.

The majority of the bonus (60%) was based upon the achievement of corporate and financial targets.

The remainder of the bonus (40%) was based upon the contribution the executive makes to the overall strategy through the delivery of specific targets. The personal targets include a combination of specific financial metrics and key strategic deliverables.

The Committee ensured that the maximum bonus opportunity could only be achieved for significant outperformance of all corporate, financial and individual bonus outcomes, with target performance achieving a 60% payout of the maximum bonus opportunity.

The table below provides a summary of the performance measures, the level of performance achieved against the targets and the resulting level of payout. The Board believes that the annual bonus performance targets are commercially sensitive information and will remain so until two years after the end of the financial year. The targets will be disclosed once they are no longer commercially sensitive. The targets remain commercially sensitive whilst they are used in the business planning processes for subsequent years.

Performance measure

Weighting

 Performance achieved

 Payout level

Strategic Target

Adam Crozier

Ian Griffiths

Adam Crozier

Ian Griffiths

ITV plc EBITA (before exceptional items)

40%

104.31%

104.31%

93.87%

93.87%

1,2,3,4

Profit to cash conversion

6.67%

107.78%

107.78%

100%

100%

1,2,3,4

Cost savings

6.67%

111.6%

111.6%

100%

100%

1

Rebalancing of revenues

6.67%

100%

-

100%

-

4

Balance sheet performance

6.67%

-

100%

-

100%

1

Individual targets

40%

88%

90.6%

88%

90.6%

1,2,3,4

 

Details of overall payout levels are set out in the table on page 93.

PSP and joining awards

The new regulations require us to show awards in the remuneration table above according to the year in which the performance period for each performance condition came to an end.

As  a result, where an award has more than one performance condition, it may be split across two years within the remuneration table.

2013 value: 75% of awards made in 2010 were subject to TSR over a three-year period ending in 2013. 100% of the awards made in 2011 were subject to performance conditions measured to 31 December 2013. The 2013 values for these awards are set out below. For details of the total award and share price at the award dates see the table on page 101.



Awards that vested and released in 2013

Awards that vested in 2013 and release in 2014

Total

£000


Number of shares vesting

Value at award date

£000

Value at vesting date

£000

Change in

share price

Value at

award date

£000

Value at

31/12/13

(194p)

£000

Change in share price

Adam Crozier









April 2010 Award

3,086,283

1,743,750

3,950,442

126.5%

-

-

-


March 2011 Award

1,052,416

-

-

-

961,908

2,041,687

112.25%

5,992,130

Ian Griffiths









March 2010 Award

700,366

398,438

910,476

128.5%

-

-

-


March 2011 Award

631,619

-

-

-

574,530

1,219,463

112.5%

2,129,939

 

Details of the TSR performance achieved for the 2010 awards are below.

 

Performance measure

 

Weighting

 

Targets

Performance achieved

Payout

level

TSR measured against selected FTSE 250 companies 1

37.5%

Median and below - nil vesting

Upper quartile - 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line in between

Upper quartile

100%

TSR measured against a specific international industry peer group 2

37.5%

Median and below - nil vesting

Upper quartile - 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line in between

Upper quartile

100%

Total

75%



100%

 

1.   The constituents of the FTSE 250 index (excluding companies from the basic materials, financial services, oil and gas and industrial sectors.

2.   An industry specific group of 23 companies: British Sky Broadcasting Group, Scripps Networks, Canal Plus, Telecinco, CBS, Tf1 (Tv.Fse.1), Daily Mail & General Trust, Time Warner, M6-Metropole TV, Trinity Mirror, Mediaset, Viacom Digital, Modern Times Group, Virgin Media, News Corporation, Vivendi, Pearson, WPP Group, Premier AG, Yell Group, Proseiben Sat 1 Pf., Zon Multimedia and RTL Group.

 

Details of the performance achieved for the 2011 awards are below.  A gateway condition of minimum cumulative adjusted EPS had to be met before any portion of the award could vest.

 

Performance measure

 

Weighting

 

Targets

Performance achieved

Payout

level

Cumulative adjusted EPS

50%

21p = 30% vesting

24p = 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line basis between

28.3p

100%

Family SOV

25%

Maintain 2010 level = 50% vesting

+2% on 2010 level = 100% vesting

Vesting on a proportionate basis between

+0.41%

above 2010 level

 

96.22%

 

 

Annual Non-NAR growth

25%

5% growth = 30% vesting

10% growth = 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line basis between

13.49%

100%

Total

100%



99.05%

 

2012 value:  25% of awards made in 2010 were subject to financial measures (split equally between Family SOV and cumulative adjusted EPS) measured to 31 December 2012. 75% of the award made in 2009 to Ian Griffiths was subject to TSR measured to 1 June 2012. The value of these elements on vesting is included in the remuneration table.

Pension

Pension contributions represent a cash allowance in lieu of pension. The cash payments were reviewed during 2013 to ensure they were market competitive and were increased to 25% of base salary for both Executive Directors with effect from 1 October 2013 (previously 9% for Adam Crozier and 15% for Ian Griffiths).

Non-executive Directors

The table below sets out in a single figure the total remuneration for Non-executive Directors for the financial year.



 Fees

 Taxable Benefits

 Total


Notes

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

2013

£000

2012

£000

Peter Bazalgette

1

35

0

-

-

35

-

Mike Clasper


96

94

-

-

96

94

Roger Faxon


61

10

-

-

61

10

Andy Haste


81

79

-

-

81

79

Lucy Neville-Rolfe

2

64

59

-

-

64

59

Archie Norman

3

500

300

-

-

500

300

John Ormerod


86

84

-

-

86

84



923

626

-

-

923

626

 

1.   Fees paid from appointment on 1 June 2013.

2.   Lucy Neville-Rolfe joined the Audit Committee on 1 May 2013.

3.   The Chairman was appointed in 2010 for a three-year term on a fee of £300,000 per annum and on joining received an award of 1,200,000 shares, which at the time was valued at £600,000. The 2012 figures do not include an amount in relation to these shares.  Under the new legislation the value would have been shown in 2010.

 

PSP awards made during the year

PSP awards were made in March 2013 to both Executive Directors. Awards were made in the form of nil-cost options, subject to performance over the period to 31 December 2015 as follows:


Award Date

% Salary

awarded

Number of

options1

Performance period ends

Vesting date

Adam Crozier

01.03.13

90

624,647

31.12.15

28.03.16

Ian Griffiths

01.03.13

90

342,549

31.12.15

28.03.16

 

1.   The number of options is calculated using the average share price over a three day period prior to award date which was 129.5p.

The awards are subject to performance measures and targets as set out below. In addition a minimum gateway cumulative adjusted EPS target must be reached before any portion of the award can vest.

Performance measure

Weightings

Targets

Cumulative adjusted EPS

50%

30.4p = 30% vesting

33.4p = 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line basis between

Family SOV

25%

23% = 50% vesting

+2% = 100% vesting

Vesting on a proportionate basis between

Annual Non-NAR growth

25%

5% growth = 30% vesting

10% growth = 100% vesting

Vesting on a straight line basis between

 

Payments to past Directors or for loss of office

No payments were made during the year.

Consideration of Directors' remuneration

The following Directors were members of the Committee when matters relating to the Directors' remuneration for the year were considered:

·     Andy Haste (Chairman)

·     Mike Clasper (stepped down from the Board and as a member of the Committee on 31 December 2013)

·     Archie Norman

·     John Ormerod

The Committee obtains advice from various sources in order to ensure it makes informed decisions.  The Chief Executive and Group Finance Director are invited to attend committee meetings as appropriate. No individual is involved in decisions relating to their own remuneration.

The Group HR Director is the main internal adviser and provides updates on remuneration, employee relations and human resource issues.

Deloitte LLP have been appointed by the Committee after consultation with the Board as an independent adviser on remuneration policy and the external remuneration environment. During the year they provided advice on benchmarking, shareholder consultation and new long-term incentive arrangements. Total fees for the advice provided to the Committee during the year amounted to £131,000.

Deloitte are a founding member of the Remuneration Consultants Group and are signatories to the Code of Conduct in relation to Executive Remuneration Consulting in the UK. During the year Deloitte also provided the Group with advice on tax, corporate finance and pensions matters, and acted on a consultancy basis to provide internal audit support under separate engagement terms.

The Committee has formally reviewed the work undertaken by Deloitte for the Committee and elsewhere in the Company and is satisfied that the advice they have received has been objective and independent.

Shareholder voting

At the AGM held on 15 May 2013, votes cast by proxy and at the meeting in respect of the Directors' remuneration were as follows:

Resolution

Votes For

%

Votes Against

%

Total votes cast

Votes Withheld

Approval of Remuneration Report

2,705,212,305

98.16

50,644,260

1.84

2,755,856,565

11,233,377

Approval of PSP

2,699,058,785

97.69

63,763,062

2.31

2,762,821,847

4,267,522

 

Chief Executive remuneration

The table below provides a summary of the total remuneration for the Chief Executive over the last five years including details of the annual bonus payout and PSP vesting levels in each year.



Total remuneration

£000

 Bonus

% of maximum

PSP vesting

% of maximum

2013

Adam Crozier

8,365

93

87

2012

Adam Crozier

2,915

91

12

2011

Adam Crozier

2,158

88

-

2010

Adam Crozier (for the 8 month period served)

1,350

95

-


John Cresswell (for the 4 month period served)

661

83

-

2009

Michael Grade

2,583

94

-

 

The table below provides details of the percentage change in the base salary, benefits and bonus of the Chief Executive between 31 December 2012 and 31 December 2013 compared to the average percentage change for other employees.


Notes

% change in
base salary

% change in
benefits

% change in
bonus payment

Chief Executive

1

2.75

1.5

1.55

All employees

2,3

5.94

(3)

20.18

 

1.   Benefits include the cost of medical insurance and car related benefits. The level of benefits remains the same as for 2012. The percentage decrease is due to a fall in the cost of medical insurance. The percentage increase for the Chief Executive is due to a minor increase in the cost of car related benefits.

2.   As the majority of employees are based in the UK, overseas employees have not been included.

3.   The percentage change in benefits is the average change for all employees (excluding the Chief Executive) with any of the same benefits as the Chief Executive.

Spend on pay

The table below shows pay for all employees compared to other key financial indicators.


Notes

2013

£m

2012

£m

% Change

Employee pay

1

173

166

4

Ordinary dividend


115

78

47

Special dividend


157

-

100

Employee headcount

2

3,845

3,731

3

 

1.   Employee pay is the total UK permanent and fixed-term employee base salary bill .

2.   Employee headcount is the total UK permanent and fixed-term full-time equivalent headcount.

 

Remuneration policy for 2014

The following provides details of how the remuneration policy will be implemented in 2014.

Salary

Executive Directors base salaries were increased with effect from 1 January 2014 as follows.


1 January 2014

£000

1 January 2013

£000

% Change

Adam Crozier

900

841

7.0

Ian Griffiths

550

461

19.3

 

Our remuneration policy for Executive Directors has been, and will continue to be, that salary increases will generally follow those of the wider employee population. This approach has been adopted since their appointment. During that time the shape and size of the business has changed significantly and performance has been strong. We have therefore increased base salaries to reflect increased responsibilities, performance, marketability and the challenges ahead. Following these increases it is our intention to return to normal policy in 2015.

Taxable benefits, pension and bonus

These will be paid in line with the remuneration policy.

New LTIP awards

Awards will be made in line with the remuneration policy under the new LTIP. The proposed performance measures and targets for awards to be made in 2014 are detailed below.  In order to ensure that Executive Directors are only rewarded if value is delivered to shareholders, awards will be subject to an initial cumulative adjusted EPS performance gateway equal to that required for threshold performance.  If this gateway is achieved, performance will then be assessed by reference to the conditions detailed below.

Performance measure

Weightings

Threshold

Maximum

Cumulative adjusted EPS

50%

37.1 p

42.3 p

Family SOV

20%

23.05%

23.51%

Non-NAR

10%

5% growth pa

10% growth pa

  International Production revenue

10%

5% growth pa

15% growth pa

Online, Pay & Interactive revenue

10%

5% growth pa

18% growth pa

 

Threshold vesting for all targets is 20%. Vesting between threshold and maximum (100%) is on a straight line basis.

When assessing performance against the Family SOV target the Committee will also have regard to the health of the main ITV channel.

The target range for awards to be made in future years will be reviewed and set in the context of the operating environment at that time.

Chairman and Non-executive Director Fees

Non-executive Director fees were increased with effect from 1 January 2014 as set out below.


Notes

1 January 2014

£000

1 January 2013

 £000

% change

Chairman (all inclusive fee)


500,000

500,000

-

Board Fee


62,224

60,559

2.75

Additional fees for:





Senior Independent Director


25,000

25,000

-

Audit Committee Chairman


20,000

20,000

-

Audit Committee Member


5,137

5,137

-

Remuneration Committee Chairman

1

20,000

15,000

33.33

Remuneration Committee Member


5,137

5,137

-

 

1.   Increased to reflect the time commitment required for this role.

 

Directors' share interests

Shareholding guidelines

The Committee continues to recognise the importance of Executive Directors being shareholders so as to align their interests with other shareholders. Shareholding guidelines are in place, which encourage Executive Directors to build up a holding of ITV plc shares based on a percentage of base salary. 50% of the requirement must be obtained within three years of appointment and the remainder within five years as follows.


% of salary required under

shareholding guidelines

% of salary held

at 31 December 2013

Adam Crozier

400

434

Ian Griffiths

200

554

 

The guidelines were increased in 2014 from 200% of salary for Adam Crozier and 150% of salary for Ian Griffiths. 

Other members of the Management Board are required to hold between 50-100% of their salary in line with their individual bonus opportunity.

Interests in shares

The figures set out below represent shareholdings in the ordinary share capital of ITV plc beneficially owned by Directors and their family interests at 31 December 2013.


26 February 20141

 31 December 2013

31 December 2012

Peter Bazalgette

2,370

1,249

-

Mike Clasper2

112,361

110,758

100,363

Adam Crozier

1,633,488

1,633,488

298,258

Roger Faxon

6,051

4,953

-

Ian Griffiths

1,511,922

1,511,922

881,852

Andy Haste

88,397

87,085

78,058

Lucy Neville-Rolfe

28,318

27,258

22,154

Archie Norman

1,235,969

1,221,432

1,163,167

John Ormerod

136,059

134,627

122,788

 

1.   Shares were acquired for the Non-executive Directors on 2 January 2014 under a Trading Plan using 25% (40% for the Chairman) of their fees, after statutory deductions, for the quarter to 31 December 2013 as part of the share acquisition policy set out in the remuneration policy on page 89.

2.   Mike Clasper stepped down from the Board on 31 December 2013.

 

Outstanding interests under share schemes

The following tables provide details of Directors' interests in outstanding share awards.

Award date

Notes

At 1 January 2013

Awarded in year

Vested

 in year

Exercised in year

Lapsed

 in year

At

31 December

2013

Share price used for award (pence)

Share price at date of vesting

(pence)

Date of release/

Exercise
in
year

Adam Crozier












Deferred Share Award Plan










28 March 2013

A

4

-

346,228

-

-

-

346,228

129.5

-

-

28 March 2012

A


477,112


-

-

-

477,112

88.6

-

-

28 March 2012

B


238,557


-

-

-

238,557

88.6

-

-

08 March 2011

A


276,314


-

-

-

276,314

91.4

-

-

08 March 2011

B


276,314


-

-

-

276,314

91.4

-

-

Joining Award










26 April 2010


3

4,115,044


3,600,663

3,600,663

514,381

-

56.5

128.0

29 April 2013

Performance Share Plan










01 March 2013

C


-

624,647

-

-

-

624,647

121.1

-

-

01 March 2012

C


899,347


-

-

-

899,347

81.9

-

-

28 March 2012

D


238,557


-

-

-

238,557

88.6

-

-

08 March 2011

C

3

786,196


-

-

-

786,196

91.4

-

-

08 March 2011

D

3

276,314


-

-

-

276,314

91.4

-

-

Ian Griffiths












Deferred Share Award Plan










28 March 2013

A

4

-

175,891

-

-

-

175,891

129.5

-

-

28 March 2012

A


234,406


-

-

-

234,406

88.6

-

-

28 March 2012

B


117,204


-

-

-

117,204

88.6

-

-

08 March 2011

A


203,478


-

-

-

203,478

91.4

-

-

08 March 2011

B


203,478


-

-

-

203,478

91.4

-

-

Performance Share Plan










01 March 2013

C


-

342,549

-

-

-

342,549

121.1

-

-

01 March 2012

C


493,192


-

-

-

493,192

81.9

-

-

28 March 2012

D


117,204


-

-

-

117,204

88.6

-

-

08 March 2011

C

3

431,140


-

-

-

431,140

91.4

-

-

08 March 2011

D

3

203,478


-

-

-

203,478

91.4

-

-

26 March 2010


3

933,820


817,092

817,092

116,728

-

56.9

120.4

9 April 2013

01 June 2009



1,188,812


-

1,188,812

-

-

35.8

120.4

9 April 2013

 

1.   No awards are outstanding that have vested but not been exercised.

2.   There are no performance conditions attaching to the DSA. Performance conditions that apply to the outstanding awards under the PSP are set out in the table below.

 





2011

2012

2013

Strategic target


Weightings

Threshold Vesting

Threshold

Maximum

Threshold

Maximum

Threshold

Maximum

Gateway




21p


26.15p


30.4p


Cumulative
adjusted EPS

1

50%

30%

21p

24p

26.15p

 

28.76p

30.4p

 

33.4p

Family SOV



2

25%

50%

Maintain at

2010 levels

(platform adjusted)

+2%

Maintain at

2011 levels

(platform adjusted)

+2%

23%


+2%

Annual Non-NAR growth

3, 4

25%

30%

5%

10%

5%

10%

5%

10%





Cumulative adjusted EPS years 2011 to 2013

Cumulative adjusted EPS years 2012 to 2014

Cumulative adjusted EPS years 2013 to 2015





Vesting between threshold and maximum (100%) on a
straight line basis (EPS, Non-NAR) and a proportionate basis (SOV).

 

3.   A proportion of the performance conditions were met in the financial year and the value of that proportion is included in the total remuneration table on page 93 and described on
pages 94 and 95.

4.   DSA awards made in 2013 for 2012 performance are included in the Bonus (cash and shares) column for 2012 in the remuneration table on page 93.

A - Compulsory deferral,  B - Voluntary deferral, C - Core Award,  D - Matching Award

 

Financials
Independent Auditor's Report to the Members of ITV plc Only 

Opinions and conclusions arising from our audit

 

1 Our opinion on the financial statements is unmodified

We have audited the financial statements of ITV Plc for the year ended 31 December 2013 set out on pages 109 to 173. In our opinion: 

·     the financial statements give a true and fair view of the state of the Group's and of the parent company's affairs as at 31 December 2013 and of the Goup's profit for the year then ended; 

·     the Group financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the European Union; 

·     the parent company financial statements have been properly prepared in accordance with UK Accounting Standards; and

·     the financial statements have been prepared in accordance with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and, as regards the Group financial statements, Article 4 of the IAS Regulation. 

2 Our assessment of risks of material misstatement

In arriving at our audit opinion above on the financial statements the risks of material misstatement that had the greatest effect on our audit were as follows. 

The Audit Committee's consideration of these significant risks is set out in the Audit Committee Report on page 75.

The risk

Our response

Revenue recognition and contractual arrangements  (see note 2.1)

The Group's revenue consists primarily of advertising, programme production and programme rights. 


Net Advertising Revenue ('NAR') (£1,542 million)


The majority of ITV's advertising revenue ('NAR') is subject to regulation under Ofcom's Contract Rights Renewal system ('CRR'). CRR works by ensuring that the annual share of TV advertising that will be placed with ITV by each advertising agency can change in relation to the viewing figures for commercial television that it delivers. The CRR system, the pricing of the annual contractual arrangements with advertising agencies and the details of each advertising campaign, together with the related processes and controls, are complex and involve estimation.

In particular, the pricing mechanism means it is possible for a difference to arise between the price received by ITV for an advertising campaign and the value it delivered, mainly as a result of the actual viewing figures being different from the agreed level. Where the Group has over-delivered viewers this is referred to as a 'deal credit', or a 'deal debt' where delivery has fallen short. Rather than the price paid for that campaign being adjusted, these differences are noted for each agency and then taken account of when agreeing either future campaigns or the annual contract. Only a net deal debt position with an agency is recorded in ITV's accounts, as a liability. 

NAR is therefore considered a significant risk due to:

·     the quantum and complexity of contractual agreements with advertising agencies;

·     the complexity of the systems and processes of control used to record revenue; and

·     the level of estimation involved in determining the deal debt liability at the period end.

Our audit procedures included:

·     testing of controls, assisted by our own IT specialists, including those over: input of individual campaigns' terms and pricing, comparison of those terms and pricing data against the related overarching contracts with advertising agencies; linkage to transmission/viewer data; and segregation of duties; 

·     testing management's review controls over: contract approval; periodic deal reconciliations; and the deal debt adjustment; 

·     analysis of revenue based on our industry knowledge and external market data, following up variances; and 

·     challenging the year end deal debt adjustment based on comparison with customers' correspondence and agreed terms of business.

Other revenue streams ('Non-NAR revenue')
(£847 million of external revenue)


Non-NAR revenue includes revenue from: programme production, the sale of programme rights, transmission supply arrangements and the Online, Pay & Interactive division within the Broadcast segment. 

Recognition of non-NAR revenue is primarily driven by the related contracts. It is considered to be a risk as the contracts can be complex and the terms are varied, with the result that accounting for the revenue generated in any given period can require individual consideration.

Our audit procedures included testing of controls over the timing of revenue recognition, and the accounting for new contractual arrangements. We considered the revenue policies against the relevant accounting standards. For the larger contracts entered into during the year, and for a statistical sample of all contracts, we tested whether revenue had been recognised in accordance with the contractual terms, given the requirements of the relevant accounting standard.

Acquisition accounting (see notes 3.3 and 3.4)


During the year, ITV acquired four production companies for an aggregate initial consideration of £66 million. 

Accounting for acquisitions requires the Group to determine the fair value of the consideration transferred, the non-controlling interests ('NCI') and the assets acquired as part of the acquisition. 

This requires the Group to make a number of judgements, which focus on, but are not limited to: assessment of the earnout arrangements entered into with selling shareholders (whether it is acquisition consideration or post-acquisition remuneration), assessing options granted to the Group over shares of the acquired business (whether the Group has a liability for the option price) and determining the fair value of the assets acquired.

In summary, acquisition accounting is considered to be a significant risk due to the level of judgement required to be applied over numerous assumptions in establishing the fair values of consideration transferred and acquired assets.

For each significant acquisition:

We critically assessed the treatment of earnout arrangements and options against the relevant accounting standards.

We used our own valuation specialists to assist us in critically assessing the appropriateness of the identified intangibles against the criteria of the relevant accounting standards. 

Our audit procedures also included testing the principles and integrity of the asset valuation models used, comparison of the input assumptions to externally and internally derived data as well as our own assessments in relation to key inputs such as the likelihood of shows being recommissioned; and the impact of the loss of key talent on the forecasts. 

Defined benefit pension schemes  (£445 million, see note 3.7)


The valuation of the pensions liability requires significant judgement and estimation to be applied across numerous assumptions.

Further, the application of IFRS 13 'Fair Value Measurement' in 2013 has led to a change in the valuation approach for the longevity swap, with the value of the swap increasing by £95 million in 2013. 

The key valuation assumptions are set out in note 3.7 in the 'keeping it simple' section on page 148. When deciding on these assumptions the Group takes independent actuarial advice relating to their appropriateness.   

The valuation is considered to be a significant risk as, given the quantum of the net deficit, small changes in the assumptions can have a material financial impact on the Group.

Our audit procedures included an assessment of the competency and objectivity of the actuarial specialists engaged by the Group.

We compared the valuation methodology, in particular for the longevity swap, with relevant accounting standards and market practices. 

We also challenged the key assumptions supporting the retirement benefit obligation and swap valuations, with input from our own actuarial specialists. This included a comparison of the mortality, discount and inflation rates used against externally derived data. 

We obtained third party confirmation of the pension schemes assets as at 31 December 2013.

We considered the appropriateness of the disclosures described in note 3.7.

Royalty accruals (£71 million,  see note 3.1.5)


The Group pays royalties directly to artists/producers for all content used. The contractual terms of these agreements are varied and complex.

The related IT systems can only address part of the processing, necessitating a significant manual element in calculating the year end royalty accrual recorded by the Group. Overall the process is complex, though core to the Group's operations.

The volume and variety of contracts being interpreted and accounted for combined with the manual nature of the process increases the risk of error.

Among other procedures, we tested controls over the recording of royalty costs and the approval of royalty payments. 

We also re-performed a sample of the year end calculations, agreeing key inputs to contracts and the underlying system data.

In addition, we performed analytical procedures comparing royalty costs as a percentage of the related income streams to budgets and prior periods, taking account of any expected changes.  

 

3 Our application of materiality and an overview of the scope of our audit

Our materiality for the Group financial statements as a whole has been determined with reference to: 

For 2013 our materiality for the Group financial statements as a whole was set at:

Consequently, corrected and uncorrected audit differences are explained to the Audit Committee.

Group profit before tax.

 

We consider this to be one of the principal considerations for members of the company in assessing the financial performance of the Group.

£21m

 

This represents 5% of Group profit before tax.

 

We explain audit differences with a quantitative impact of over £1 million, in addition to other audit misstatements below that threshold that we believe warranted reporting on qualitative grounds.

 

The Group's principal operations are in the United Kingdom and represent 89% of total Group revenue, 95% of Group profit before tax and 92% of Group total assets. Only the UK operations are scoped in for Group reporting purposes. The Group audit team performed the audit of the UK operations as if they were a single aggregated set of financial information using the materiality levels set out above.

Although not in-scope for Group reporting purposes, in agreement with the audit committee and coterminus with the audit of the Group and the UK operations, audits were performed in Australia and Germany to local materiality levels and specified audit procedures were also performed on four entities in the US. Together these audits and specified audit procedures covered 99% of total Group revenue, 99% of Group profit before taxation; and 99% of total Group assets.

4 Our opinion on other matters prescribed by the Companies Act 2006 is unmodified

In our opinion: 

·     the part of the Remuneration Report to be audited has been properly prepared in accordance with the Companies Act 2006; and 

·     the information given in the Strategic Report and the Directors' Report for the financial year for which the financial statements are prepared is consistent with the financial statements. 

5 We have nothing to report in respect of the matters on which we are required to report by exception 

Under ISAs (UK and Ireland) we are required to report to you if, based on the knowledge we acquired during our audit, we have identified other information in the annual report that contains a material inconsistency with either that knowledge or the financial statements, a material misstatement of fact, or that is otherwise misleading.

In particular, we are required to report to you if:

·     we have identified material inconsistencies between the knowledge we acquired during our audit and the Directors' statement that they consider that the annual report and financial statements taken as a whole is fair, balanced and understandable and provides the information necessary for shareholders to assess the Group's performance, business model and strategy; or

·     the Audit Committee Report does not appropriately address matters communicated by us to the Audit Committee.

Under the Companies Act 2006 we are required to report to you if, in our opinion:

·     adequate accounting records have not been kept by the parent company, or returns adequate for our audit have not been received from branches not visited by us; or 

·     the parent company financial statements and the part of the Remuneration Report to be audited are not in agreement with the accounting records and returns; or 

·     certain disclosures of Directors' remuneration specified by law are not made; or 

·     we have not received all the information and explanations we require for our audit. 

Under the Listing Rules we are required to review: 

·     the Directors' statement, set out on page 115, in relation to going concern; and 

·     the part of the Corporate Governance Statement on pages 67 to 74 relating to the Company's compliance with the nine provisions of the 2010 UK Corporate Governance Code specified for our review. 

We have nothing to report in respect of the above responsibilities.

Scope of report and responsibilities

As explained more fully in the Directors' Responsibilities Statement set out on page 66, the Directors are responsible for the preparation of the financial statements and for being satisfied that they give a true and fair view. A description of the scope of an audit of financial statements is provided on the Financial Reporting Council's website at www.frc.org.uk/auditscopeukprivate. This report is made solely to the Company's members as a body and is subject to important explanations and disclaimers regarding our responsibilities, published on our website at www.kpmg.com/uk/auditscopeukco2013a, which are incorporated into this report as if set out in full and should be read to provide an understanding of the purpose of this report, the work we have undertaken and the basis of our opinions. 

 

Mark Summerfield (Senior Statutory Auditor)
for and on behalf of KPMG Audit Plc, Statutory Auditor
Chartered Accountants
15 Canada Square
London
E14 5GL
26 February 2014

 

In this section . . . 

The financial statements have been presented in a style which attempts to make them less complex and more relevant to shareholders. We have grouped the note disclosures into five sections: 'Basis of Preparation', 'Results for the Year', 'Operating Assets and Liabilities', 'Capital Structure and Financing Costs' and 'Other Notes'. Each section sets out the accounting policies applied in producing the relevant notes, along with details of any key judgements and estimates used. The purpose of this format is to provide readers with a clearer understanding of what drives financial performance of the Group. The aim of the text in boxes is to provide commentary on each section, or note, in plain English.

Keeping it simple . . .

Notes to the financial statements provide information required by statute, accounting standards or Listing Rules to explain a particular feature of the financial statements. The notes which follow will also provide explanations and additional disclosure to assist readers' understanding and interpretation of the annual report and the financial statements.

Consolidated Income Statement

For the year ended 31 December

Note

 2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Revenue               

2.1

2,389

2,196

Operating costs


(1,843)

(1,750)

Operating profit


546

446





 Presented as:




 Earnings before interest, tax, amortisation (EBITA) before exceptional items

2.1

620

513

 Operating exceptional items

2.2

(8)

(7)

 Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets

3.3

(66)

(60)

 Operating profit


546

446





 Financing income

4.4

10

20

 Financing costs

4.4

(125)

(126)

Net financing costs

4.4

(115)

(106)

Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

2.1

(2)

(1)

Loss on sale and impairment of non-current assets (exceptional items)

2.2

-

(6)

Gain on sale and impairment of subsidiaries and investments (exceptional items)

2.2

6

1

Profit before tax


435

334

Taxation

2.3

(105)

(77)

Profit for the year


330

257





Profit attributable to:




Owners of the Company


326

256

Non-controlling interests


4

1

Profit for the year


330

257





Earnings per share




Basic earnings per share

2.4

8.3p

6.6p

Diluted earnings per share

2.4

8.1p

6.4p

 

Consolidated Statement of Comprehensive Income

 

For the year ended 31 December

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Profit for the year

330

257




Other comprehensive income:



Items that are or may be reclassified to profit or loss



Revaluation of available for sale financial assets

(3)

(1)

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations

(6)

(1)

Items that will never be reclassified to profit or loss



Remeasurement gains/(losses) on defined benefit pension schemes

48

(213)

Income tax (charge)/credit on items that will never be reclassified

(13)

50

Other comprehensive income/(cost) for the year, net of income tax

26

(165)

Total comprehensive income for the year

356

92




Total comprehensive income attributable to:



Owners of the Company

352

91

Non-controlling interests

4

1

Total comprehensive income for the year

356

92

 

Consolidated Statement of Financial Position

As at 31 December

Note

2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Non-current assets




Property, plant and equipment

3.2

259

156

Intangible assets

3.3

954

938

Investments in joint ventures and associated undertakings


4

6

Available for sale financial assets


--

3

Held to maturity investments

4.1

-

145

Derivative financial instruments

4.3

41

99

Distribution rights

3.1.1

10

17

Net deferred tax asset

2.3

52

93



1,320

1,457

Current assets




Programme rights and other inventory

3.1.2

322

252

 Trade and other receivables due within one year

3.1.4

388

366

 Trade and other receivables due after more than one year   

3.1.4

14

14

Trade and other receivables


402

380

Derivative financial instruments

4.3

32

-

Cash and cash equivalents

4.1

518

690



1,274

1,322

Assets held for sale

3.5

-

25



1,274

1,347

Current liabilities




Borrowings

4.2

(62)

(7)

Derivative financial instruments

4.3

(6)

(1)

 Trade and other payables due within one year

3.1.5

(702)

(622)

 Trade payables due after more than one year

3.1.6

(42)

(31)

Trade and other payables


(744)

(653)

Current tax liabilities


(36)

(29)

Provisions

3.6

(19)

(25)



(867)

(715)





Net current assets


407

632





Non-current liabilities




Borrowings

4.2

(318)

(632)

Derivative financial instruments

4.3

(27)

(48)

Defined benefit pension deficit

3.7

(445)

(551)

Other payables


(40)

(14)

Provisions

3.6

(8)

(12)



(838)

(1,257)

Net assets


889

832





Attributable to equity shareholders of the parent company




Share capital

4.7.1

403

391

Share premium

4.7.1

174

122

Merger and other reserves

4.7.2

248

283

Translation reserve


7

13

Available for sale reserve


4

7

Retained earnings


22

1

Total equity attributable to equity shareholders of the parent company


858

817

Non-controlling interests


31

15

Total equity


889

832

 

Ian Griffiths
Group Finance Director

 

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity



Attributable to equity shareholders of the parent company









Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss






Note

Share

capital

£m

Share

premium

£m

Merger

and other

reserves

£m

Translation

reserve

£m

Available

for sale

 reserve

£m

Retained

earnings

£m

 

 

Total

£m

Non-

controlling

interests

£m

 

Total

equity

£m

Balance at 1 January 2013


391

122

283

13

7

1

817

15

832

Total comprehensive income for the year











Profit


-

-

-

-

-

326

326

4

330

Other comprehensive income/(cost)











Revaluation of available for sale financial assets


-

-

-

-

(3)

-

(3)

-

(3)

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations


-

-

-

(6)

-

-

(6)

-

(6)

Remeasurement gains on defined benefit
pension schemes

3.7

-

-

-

-

-

48

48

-

48

Income tax on other comprehensive income

2.3

-

-

-

-

-

(13)

(13)

-

(13)

Total other comprehensive income


-

-

-

(6)

(3)

35

26

-

26

Total comprehensive income for the year


-

-

-

(6)

(3)

361

352

4

356

Transactions with owners, recorded directly in equity











Contributions by and distributions
to owners











Equity dividends


-

-

-

-

-

(271)

(271)

(1)

(272)

Equity portion of the convertible bond

4.1

10

52

(22)

-

-

(70)

(30)

-

(30)

Movements due to share-based compensation

4.7.7

-

-

-

-

-

14

14

-

14

Purchase of own shares via employees' benefit trust

  4.7.7

-

-

-

-

-

(13)

(13)

-

(13)

Issue of new shares

4.7.1

2

-

-

-

-

-

2

-

2

Total contributions by and distributions
to owners


12

52

(22)

-

-

(340)

(298)

(1)

(299)

Total transactions with owners


12

52

(22)

-

-

(340)

(298)

(1)

(299)

Changes in non-controlling interests(a)

3.4

-

-

(13)

-

-

-

(13)

13

-

Balance at 31 December 2013

4.7

403

174

248

7

4

22

858

31

889

 

(a) Movements reported in merger and other reserves include a put option for the acquisition of non-controlling interests.

Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity



Attributable to equity shareholders of the parent company









Items that may be reclassified to profit or loss






Note

Share

capital

£m

Share

premium

£m

Merger

and other

reserves

£m

Translation

reserve

£m

Available

for sale

 reserve

£m

Retained

earnings

(restated)

£m

Total

£m

Non-

controlling

interests

£m

Total

equity

£m

Balance at 1 January 2012


389

120

300

14

8

(25)

806

3

809

Total comprehensive income for the year











Profit


-

-

-

-

-

256

256

1

257

Other comprehensive income/(cost)











Revaluation of available for sale financial assets


-

-

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

-

(1)

Exchange differences on translation of foreign operations


-

-

-

(1)

-

-

(1)

-

(1)

Remeasurement losses on defined benefit
pension schemes               

3.7

-

-

-

-

-

(213)

(213)

-

(213)

Income tax on other comprehensive income

2.3

-

-

-

-

-

50

50

-

50

Total other comprehensive cost


-

-

-

(1)

(1)

(163)

(165)

-

(165)

Total comprehensive income for the year


-

-

-

(1)

(1)

93

91

1

92

Transactions with owners, recorded directly in equity











Contributions by and distributions to owners











Equity dividends


-

-

-

-

-

(78)

(78)

(1)

(79)

Equity portion of the convertible bond

4.1

-

-

(5)

-

-

5

-

-

-

Movements due to share-based compensation

4.7.7

-

-

-

-

-

9

9

-

9

Purchase of own shares via employees' benefit trust

4.7.7

-

-

-

-

-

(3)

(3)

-

(3)

Issue of new shares

4.7.1

2

2

-

-

-

-

4

-

4

Total contributions by and distributions to owners


2

2

(5)

-

-

(67)

(68)

(1)

(69)

Total transactions with owners


2

2

(5)

-

-

(67)

(68)

(1)

(69)

Changes in non-controlling interests(a)

3.4

-

-

(12)

-

-

-

(12)

12

-

Balance at 31 December 2012

4.7

391

122

283

13

7

1

817

15

832

(a) Movements reported in merger and other reserves include a put option for the acquisition of non-controlling interests.

 

The Consolidated Statement of Changes in Equity has been restated to reflect the impact of amendments to IAS 19R. See section 1 for details.

Consolidated Statement of Cash Flows

For the year ended 31 December

Note

£m

2013

£m

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Cash flows from operating activities






Profit before tax


435


334


Gain on sale and impairment of subsidiaries and investments (exceptional items)

2.2

(6)


(1)


Loss on sale and impairment of non-current assets (exceptional items)

2.2

-


6


Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

2.1

2


1


Net financing costs

4.4

115


106


Operating exceptional items

2.2

8


7


Depreciation of property, plant and equipment

3.2

24


27


Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets

3.3

66


60


Share-based compensation and pension service costs

3.7/4.7.7

20


16



(Increase)/decrease in programme rights and other inventory,
and distribution rights


(42)


29


 (Increase)/decrease in receivables


(15)


17


 Increase/(decrease) in payables


42


(45)


Movement in working capital

3.1.7

(15)


1


Cash generated from operations before exceptional items



649


557

Cash flow relating to operating exceptional items:







Net operating loss

2.2

(5)


(7)




Increase/(decrease) in payables and provisions


(6)


5


Cash outflow from exceptional items



(11)


(2)

Cash generated from operations



638


555

Defined benefit pension deficit funding


(80)


(72)


Interest received


38


42


Interest paid on bank and other loans


(60)


(72)


Interest paid on finance leases


(2)


(3)


Net taxation paid


(67)


(62)





(171)


(167)

Net cash inflow from operating activities



467


388

Cash flows from investing activities






Redemption of gilts

4.1

165


-


Acquisition of subsidiary undertakings

3.4

(66)


(38)


Cash balances of subsidiaries acquired in period

3.4

10


-


Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment


4


-


Acquisition of property, plant and equipment


(101)


(50)


Acquisition of intangible assets


(2)


(11)


Loans granted to associates and joint ventures


(4)


(9)


Loans repaid by associates and joint ventures


-


3


Proceeds from sale of subsidiaries and joint ventures


-


4


Proceeds from sale of available for sale investments


8


-


Net cash inflow/(outflow) from investing activities



14


(101)

Cash flows from financing activities






Bank and other loans - amounts repaid


(365)


(309)


Capital element of finance lease payments


(8)


(8)


Issue of share capital


2


4


Equity dividends paid


(271)


(78)


Dividend paid to minority interest


(1)


(1)


Purchase of own shares via employees' benefit trust


(13)


(3)


Net cash outflow from financing activities



(656)


(395)

Net decrease in cash and cash equivalents



(175)


(108)

Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January

4.1


690


801

Effects of exchange rate changes and fair value movements



3


(3)

Cash and cash equivalents at 31 December

4.1


518


690

 

Notes to the Financial Statements

Section 1: Basis of Preparation

 

In this section . . .

This section sets out the Group's accounting policies that relate to the financial statements as a whole. Where an accounting policy is specific to one note, the policy is described in the note to which it relates. This section also shows new EU endorsed accounting standards, amendments and interpretations, and whether they are effective in 2013 or later years. We explain how these changes are expected to impact the financial position and performance of the Group.

 

The financial statements consolidate those of ITV plc ('the Company') and its subsidiaries (together referred to as 'the Group') and include the Group's interests in associates and jointly controlled entities. The Company is domiciled in the United Kingdom.

As required by EU law (IAS Regulation EC 1606/2002) the Group's accounts have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as adopted by the EU ('IFRS'), and approved by the Directors.

The financial statements are principally prepared on the basis of historical cost. Where other bases are applied these are identified in the relevant accounting policy.

The 2012 consolidated income statement and consolidated statement of comprehensive income have been restated for the retrospective application of IAS 19 Revised (see note 3.7). In addition, the consolidated statement of financial position has been restated for fair value adjustments to the net assets acquired with acquisitions in 2012 (see note 3.4).

The Company has elected to prepare its parent company financial statements in accordance with UK GAAP.

Going concern

As a result of the Group's continued generation of significant free cash flows the Group maintained its positive net cash position while paying a special dividend. The Group has also sought to gain further efficiencies in the balance sheet by repurchasing further debt where it is economically beneficial to do so (see section 4 for details on capital structure and financing).

The Group continues to review forecasts of the television advertising market to determine the impact on ITV's liquidity position. The Group's forecasts and projections, taking account of reasonably possible changes in trading performance, show that the Group will be able to operate within the level of its current funding.

The Group also continues to focus on development of the non-advertising business, and evaluates the impact of further investment in acquisitions against the strategy and cash headroom of the business.

After making enquiries, the Directors have a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence for the foreseeable future. Accordingly, the Group continues to adopt the going concern basis in preparing its consolidated financial statements.

Subsidiaries, joint ventures, associates and special purpose entities

Subsidiaries are entities that are directly or indirectly controlled by the Group. Control exists where the Group has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the entity in order to obtain benefits from its activities. In assessing control, potential voting rights that are currently exercisable or convertible are taken into account.

A joint venture is an entity in which the Group holds an interest under a contractual arrangement where the Group and one or more other parties undertake an economic activity that is subject to joint control. The Group accounts for its interests in joint ventures using the equity method. Under the equity method the investment in the entity is stated as one line item at cost plus the investor's share of retained post-acquisition profits and other changes in
net assets.

An associate is an entity, other than a subsidiary or joint venture, over which the Group has significant influence. Significant influence is the power to participate in, but not control or jointly control, the financial and operating decisions of an entity. These investments are also accounted for using the equity method.

A special purpose entity (SPE) is a legal entity which the Group may establish to fulfil a specific trading and investment purpose. Judgement is required when determining if an SPE should be consolidated and involves the evaluation of the substance of its relationships with the Group and the SPE's risks and rewards. Those SPEs controlled by the Group are established under terms that impose strict limitations on the decision-making powers of their management and that result in the Group receiving the majority of the benefits related to their operations and net assets, being exposed to the majority of risks incidental to their activities and receiving the majority of the residual or ownership risks related to the SPEs or their assets.

SPEs are used in limited circumstances by the Group. The only significant SPE is the pension funding partnership that was established in 2010 between the Group and the Trustee of the ITV Pension Scheme as a way of establishing payment streams to the pension scheme. The partnership, which is a Scottish Limited Partnership, is controlled and consolidated by the Group.

Current/non-current distinction

Current assets include assets held primarily for trading purposes, cash and cash equivalents, and assets expected to be realised in, or intended for sale or use in, the course of the Group's operating cycle. All other assets are classified as non-current assets.

Current liabilities include liabilities held primarily for trading purposes, liabilities expected to be settled in the course of the Group's operating cycle and those liabilities due within one year from the reporting date. All other liabilities are classified as non-current liabilities.

Classification of financial instruments

The financial assets and liabilities of the Group are classified into the following financial statement captions in the statement of financial position in accordance with IAS 39 Financial Instruments:

·     'Loans and receivables' - separately disclosed as cash and cash equivalents (excluding gilts over which unfunded pension commitments have a charge) and trade and other receivables;

·     'Available for sale financial assets' - measured at fair value through other comprehensive income. Includes gilts over which unfunded pension commitments have a charge and equity securities that do not meet the definition of subsidiaries, joint ventures or associates;

·     'Held to maturity investments';

·     'Financial assets/liabilities at fair value through profit or loss' - separately disclosed as derivative financial instruments in assets/liabilities and included in non-current other payables (contingent consideration); and

·     'Financial liabilities measured at amortised cost' - separately disclosed as borrowings and trade and other payables.

Judgement is required when determining the appropriate classification of the Group's financial instruments. Details on the accounting policies for measurement of the above instruments are set out in the relevant note.

Recognition and derecognition of financial assets and liabilities

The Group recognises a financial asset or liability when it becomes a party to the contract. Financial instruments are no longer recognised in the statement of financial position when the contractual cash flows expire or when the Group no longer retains control of substantially all the risks and rewards under the instrument.

Cash and cash equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents comprise cash balances, call deposits with a maturity of less than or equal to three months from the date of acquisition, cash held to meet certain finance lease commitments and gilts over which unfunded pension commitments have a charge. The carrying value of cash and cash equivalents is considered to approximate fair value.

Foreign currencies

The primary economic environment in which the Group operates is the UK. The consolidated financial statements are therefore presented in pounds sterling ('£').

Where Group companies based in the UK transact in foreign currencies, these transactions are translated into pounds sterling at the exchange rate on that day. Foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities are translated into pounds sterling at the year end exchange rate. Where there is a movement in the exchange rate between the date of the transaction and the year end, a foreign exchange gain or loss may arise. Any such differences are recognised in the income statement. Non-monetary assets and liabilities measured at historical cost are translated into pounds sterling at the exchange rate on the date of the transaction.

The assets and liabilities of Group companies outside of the UK are translated into pounds sterling at the year end exchange rate. The revenues and expenses of these companies are translated into pounds sterling at the average monthly exchange rate during the year. Where differences arise between these rates, they are recognised in the translation reserve within equity and other comprehensive income.

Exchange differences arising on the translation of the Group's interests in joint ventures and associates are recognised in the translation reserve within equity and other comprehensive income.

On disposal of an interest in a joint venture or an associate, the related translation reserve is released to the income statement as part of the gain or loss on disposal.

Accounting judgements and estimates

The preparation of financial statements requires management to exercise judgement in applying the Group's accounting policies. It also requires the use of estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, income and expenses. Actual results may differ from these estimates.

Estimates and underlying assumptions are reviewed on an ongoing basis, with revisions recognised in the period in which the estimates are revised and in any future periods affected.

The areas involving a higher degree of judgement or complexity are set out below and in more detail in the related notes:

·     Revenue recognition (note 2.1)

·     Classification of financial instruments (included in
this note)

·     Business combinations (note 3.3 and note 3.4)

The areas involving the most sensitive estimates and assumptions that are significant to the financial statements are set out below and in more detail in the related notes:

·     Defined benefit pension schemes, including the related longevity swap (note 3.7)

·     Taxation (note 2.3)

·     Provisions (note 3.6)

·     Business combinations (note 3.4)

·     Impairment of assets (note 3.2 and note 3.3)

·     Financial instruments (note 4.1)

 

New or amended EU endorsed accounting standards

The table below represents new or amended EU endorsed accounting standards relevant to the Group's results that are effective in 2013:

Accounting Standard

Requirement

Impact on financial statements

IAS 19 Revised - Employee Benefits

The IASB issued numerous amendments to IAS 19, ranging from the concept of expected return on plan assets to simple clarifications and rewording of disclosures.

The most significant amendment is the requirement to calculate net interest income or expense using the discount rate used to measure the defined benefit obligation, whereas the previous standard required a separate expected return on assets to be used.

The amendment also clarifies that administrative costs should be recognised within operating costs, which differs from previous practice of including it as a deduction of assets. 

The revised standard has been implemented in the current year by the Group, with retrospective application.

The impact on the income statement has been reflected in the current year and has resulted in finance costs of £20 million (which is adjusted for in calculating adjusted profit), and operating costs of £13 million, which is included within EBITA. The 2012 comparative performance has been restated to reflect an increase in finance costs of £7 million to £16 million, and an additional £7 million in operating costs to £15 million. The impact on 2012 statutory EPS is a decrease from 6.9p to 6.6p.

The above amendments have not had any impact on the 2013 and 2012 net asset position of the Group.

 

 

IAS 1 Financial Statement Presentation

The amendments to IAS 1 change the grouping of items presented in other comprehensive income. Items that could be reclassified to the income statement at a future point in time would be presented separately from items that will never be reclassified.

The statement of other comprehensive income has been amended to reflect the update in presentation but there is no impact on the Group's financial position or performance.

IFRS 13 Fair Value Measurements

IFRS 13 establishes a single source of guidance under IFRS for all fair value measurements. IFRS 13 does not change when an entity is required to use fair value, but rather provides guidance on how to measure fair value under IFRS when fair value is required or permitted. The standard is effective for periods beginning on or after
1 January 2013.

Longevity swap

IFRS 13 has resulted in a change in the method of valuing a longevity swap (previously accounted for under IAS 19R). Under the new method the Group will be applying market-based assumptions to the measurement process (previously the best estimate was taken).

Longevity swap

The value of the longevity swap has increased from a negative asset of £118 million in 2012 under the old method to a negative asset of £23 million in 2013 under the new method. Had the old valuation method applied at 31 December 2013, the value of the longevity swap would have been negative £140 million. The impact of the new valuation method is an increase in the net assets position of £117 million, with the remaining £22 million offsetting movement being changes in market conditions over 2013. The movement has been reflected within the net remeasurement gain presented in the statement of other comprehensive income. 

The change in value of the swap has had no impact on the consolidated income statement of the Group. Further details are in note 3.7.

There have been no other material impacts noted for the Group.

 

The Directors also considered the impact on the Group of other new and revised accounting standards, interpretations or amendments on the Group that are currently endorsed but not yet effective. Except where noted below, none are considered relevant to the Group's results and are effective for periods beginning on or after 1 January 2014.

Accounting Standard

Requirement

Impact on financial statements

IAS 32 Financial Instruments

The amendments clarify the offsetting criteria, such as when an entity has a legal right to offset and when gross settlement is equivalent to net settlement.

Based on the preliminary analyses performed, the amendments are not expected to have any impact on the Group.

IFRS 10

IFRS 10 replaces a portion of IAS 27 Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements that addresses the accounting for consolidated financial statements. It also includes the issues raised in SIC-12 Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities.

IFRS 10 establishes a single control model that applies to all entities including special purpose entities. The changes introduced by IFRS 10 will require management to exercise significant judgement to determine which entities are controlled and therefore are required to be consolidated by a parent, compared with the requirements that were in IAS 27.

Based on the preliminary analyses performed, IFRS 10 is not expected to have any material impact on the currently held investments of the Group.

IFRS 11

IFRS 11 replaces IAS 31 Interests in Joint Ventures and SIC-13 Jointly controlled entities - Non-monetary contributions by Venturers.

IFRS 11 removes the option to account for jointly controlled entities (JCEs) using proportionate consolidation. Instead, JCEs that meet the definition of a joint venture must be accounted for using the equity method.

Based on the preliminary analyses performed, IFRS 11 is not expected to have any material impact on the currently held investments of the Group.

IFRS 12

IFRS 12 includes all of the disclosures that were previously in IAS 27 related to consolidated financial statements, as well as all of the disclosures that were previously included in IAS 31 and IAS 28. These disclosures relate to an entity's interests in subsidiaries, joint arrangements, associates and structured entities.

Although a number of new disclosures will be required, there is no material impact expected on the Group's financial position or performance.

 

Section 2: Results for the Year

In this section . . .

This section focuses on the results and performance of the Group. On the following pages you will find disclosures explaining the Group's results for the year, segmental information, exceptional items, taxation and earnings per share.

Keeping it simple . . .

This section analyses the Group's profit before tax by reference to the activities performed by the Group and an analysis of key operating costs.

Earnings before interest, tax, amortisation (EBITA) and before exceptional items remains the Group's key profit indicator. This reflects the way the business is managed and how the Directors assess the performance of the Group. This section therefore also shows each division's contribution to total revenue and EBITA.

Following revisions to IAS 19, we have restated our prior period results and the details of those restatements are included in note 3.7.

 

2.1 Profit before tax

Accounting policies

Revenue recognition

Revenue is stated exclusive of VAT and comprises the sale of products and services to third parties. Selecting the appropriate timing and amount of revenue recognised requires some judgement. Revenue from the sale of products is recognised when the Group has transferred both the significant risks and rewards of ownership and control of the products sold and the amount of revenue can be measured reliably. Revenue recognition criteria for the Group's key classes of revenue are recognised on the following bases:

Applicable segment

Class of revenue

Recognition criteria

Broadcast & Online

Advertising

on transmission or display

Broadcast & Online

Sponsorship

 

on transmission of the sponsored programme or series

Studios

Programme production

 

on delivery of episode and acceptance by the customer

Studios

Programme rights

when contracted and available for exploitation

Broadcast & Online

Participation revenues (interactive & 'red
button' services)

as the service is provided

Studios

Digital revenue: Archive and Video on Demand - one-off and top-up content

 

on delivery of content (one-off) or over the contract period in a manner that reflects the flow of content delivered (top-up)

Broadcast & Online

Digital revenue: Catch up

an estimate is accrued in the month and trued up on receipt of third party reports showing revenue share calculation (showing subscribers and hours downloaded)

 

Segmental information

Operating segments, which have not been aggregated, are reported in a manner that is consistent with the internal reporting provided to the Board of Directors, regarded as the chief operating decision maker.

The Board of Directors considers the business primarily from a product or activity perspective. The reportable segments for the years ended 31 December 2013 and 31 December 2012 are therefore 'Broadcast & Online' and 'ITV Studios', the results of which are outlined in the following tables:


Broadcast

& Online

2013

£m

ITV Studios

2013

£m

Consolidated

2013

£m

Total segment revenue

1,896

857

2,753

Intersegment revenue

-

(364)

(364)

Revenue from external customers

1,896

493

2,389

EBITA before exceptional items

487

133

620

Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

(2)

-

(2)

 


Broadcast

& Online

2012

(restated)

£m

ITV Studios

2012

£m

Consolidated

2012

(restated)

£m

Total segment revenue

1,834

712

2,546

Intersegment revenue

-

(350)

 (350)

Revenue from external customers

1,834

362

2,196

EBITA before exceptional items

406

107

513

Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

(1)

-

(1)

 

Intersegment revenue, which is carried out on arm's length terms, is generated from the supply of ITV Studios programmes to Broadcast & Online for transmission primarily on ITV. This revenue stream is a measure which forms part of the Group's strategic priority of building a strong international content business.

In preparing the segment information, centrally managed costs have been allocated between reportable segments on a methodology driven principally by revenue and headcount of each segment. This is consistent with the basis of reporting to the Board of Directors.

Broadcast & Online

This segment is responsible for commissioning and scheduling programmes on the ITV channels, marketing and programme publicity and online rights exploitation. Upon transmission of these programmes, Broadcast & Online generates revenue from the sale of audiences for advertising airtime and sponsorship. Other sources of revenue are from:  participation revenue, digital revenue (including pay), online advertising, digital terrestrial multiplex SDN, brand extensions and licensing channels and content to pay operators.

ITV Studios

ITV Studios is an international productions business. It comprises ITV Studios UK, international production centres in the USA, Germany, France, Australia, Sweden, Norway and Finland and ITV Studios Global Entertainment, the distribution and exploitation business.

A significant portion of ITV Studios' UK revenue is generated when it creates ideas that are then produced and sold as programming to the 'Broadcast & Online' segment, primarily for ITV. This is shown in the intersegment revenue in the segmental analysis.

ITV Studios Global Entertainment sells programming, exploits merchandising and licensing worldwide, and is a distributor of DVD entertainment primarily in the United Kingdom, both for ITV Studios and third parties.

EBITA before exceptional items

The Directors assess the performance of the reportable segments based on a measure of EBITA before exceptional items. The Directors use this measurement basis as it excludes the effect of non-recurring income and expenditure. Amortisation, investment income and share of profit/(losses) of joint ventures and associates are also excluded to reflect more accurately how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis. Net financing costs are not allocated to segments as this type of activity is managed by the central treasury function, which manages the cash position and funding of the Group.

A reconciliation from EBITA before exceptional items to profit before tax is provided as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

 £m

EBITA before exceptional items

620

513

Operating exceptional items

(8)

(7)

Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets

(66)

(60)

Net financing costs

(115)

(106)

Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

(2)

(1)

Loss on sale and impairment of non-current assets (exceptional items)

-

(6)

Gain on sale and impairment of subsidiaries and investments (exceptional items)

6

1

Profit before tax

435

334

 

Whilst becoming more international, the Group's principal operations are in the United Kingdom. Its revenue from external customers in the United Kingdom is £1,982 million (2012: £1,895 million), and total revenue from external customers in other countries is £407 million (2012: £301 million).

There are three media buying agencies (2012: three) acting on behalf of a number of customers that represent the Group's major customers. These agencies are the only customers which individually represent over 10% of the Group's revenues. Revenues of approximately £527 million (2012: £486 million), £235 million (2012: £239 million) and £210 million (2012: £233 million) were derived from these customers. These revenues are attributable to the 'Broadcast & Online' segment.

Operating costs

Staff costs

Staff costs before exceptional items can be analysed as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Wages and salaries

255

236

Social security and other costs

42

35

Share-based compensation

(see note 4.7.7)

14

9

Pension costs

19

20


330

300

 

The number of full-time equivalent employees (excluding short-term contractors and freelancers), calculated on a weighted average basis, during the year was:


2013

2012

Broadcast & Online

2,049

2,102

ITV Studios

2,208

1,957


4,257

4,059

 

The increase in full-time equivalent employees in ITV Studios is primarily driven by the four acquisitions completed in 2013 as well as an increase in production from the core UK business. Broadcast & Online headcount reduction is driven by the regional news operations due to changes in Ofcom regulations combined with efficiency savings.

Details of Directors' emoluments, share options, pension entitlements and long-term incentive scheme interests are set out in the Remuneration Report.

Depreciation

Depreciation in the year was £24 million (2012: £27 million), of which £12 million (2012: £15 million) relates to 'Broadcast & Online' and £12 million (2012: £12 million) to 'ITV Studios'.

Operating leases

The total undiscounted future minimum lease payments under non-cancellable operating leases fall due for payment as follows:

2013

Transponders

Property

Total

Within 1 year

36

12

48

Later than 1 year and not later than 5 years

138

23

161

Later than 5 years

194

11

205


368

46

414

 

2012

Transponders

Property

Total

Within 1 year

29

12

41

Later than 1 year and not later than 5 years

137

29

166

Later than 5 years

220

91

311


386

132

518

 

The Group's operating leases relate to transponder assets and office and studio properties. The Group holds transmission supply agreements that require the use of specific transponder assets for a period of up to 11 years with payments increasing over time, limited by specific RPI caps. These supply agreements are classified as operating leases, in accordance with the Group's policy on leases detailed in note 3.2.

Included in 2012 property commitments were future minimum lease payments of £82 million contracted on the London Television Centre, a property which the Group acquired in January 2013 (see note 3.2).

Property leases typically run for a period of up to ten years and may have an option to renew after that date (options to renew are not included in the commitments table). Lease payments are generally subject to market review every five years to reflect market rentals, but because of the uncertainty over the amount of any future changes, such changes have not been reflected in the table above. None of the leases include contingent rentals.

The total future minimum sublease payments expected to be received under non-cancellable subleases at the year end are £2 million (2012: £4 million).

The total operating lease expenditure recognised during the year was £45 million (2012: £40 million) and total sublease payments received were £2 million (2012: £2 million).

Audit fees

The Group engages KPMG Audit Plc ('KPMG') on assignments additional to their statutory audit duties where their expertise and experience with the Group are important.

Fees paid to KPMG and its associates during the year are set out below:


2013

£m

2012

£m


For the audit of the Group's annual accounts

0.7

0.8


For the audit of subsidiaries of the
Group

0.2

0.1

 Audit-related assurance services

0.1

0.1

Total Audit and Audit-Related assurance services

1.0

1.0

 Taxation compliance services

0.1

0.1

 Taxation advisory services

0.2

0.3

 Other assurance services

0.2

-

Total Non-Audit Services

0.5

0.4

Total fees paid to KPMG

1.5

1.4

 

There were no fees payable in 2013 or 2012 to KPMG and associates for the auditing of accounts of any associate of the Group, internal audit services, services relating to corporate finance transactions entered into or proposed to be entered into, by or on behalf of the Group or any of its associates.

Fees paid to KPMG for audit and other services to the Company are not disclosed in its individual accounts as the Group accounts are required to disclose such fees on a consolidated basis.

2.2 Exceptional Items

Keeping it simple . . .

Exceptional items are material and non-recurring and are excluded from management's assessment of profit because by their nature they could distort the Group's underlying quality of earnings. They are typically gains or losses arising from events that are not considered part of the core operations of the business (e.g. costs relating to capital transactions, such as professional fees on acquisitions). These items are excluded to reflect performance in a consistent manner and are in line with how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis.

Accounting policies

Exceptional items as described above are disclosed on the face of the income statement.

Subsequent revisions of estimates for items initially recognised as exceptional provisions are recorded as exceptional items in the year that the revision is made. Gains or losses on disposal of non-core assets are also considered exceptional due to their nature and impact on the Group's underlying quality of earnings.

Exceptional items

Operating and non-operating exceptional items are analysed as follows:

 

 

Ref.

2013

£m

2012

£m

Operating exceptional items:




Reorganisation and restructuring costs

A

-

(5)

Acquisition related expenses

B

(8)

(2)

Total net operating exceptional items


(8)

(7)

Non-operating exceptional items:




Loss on sale and impairment
of non-current assets

C

-

 (6)

Gain on sale and
impairment of subsidiaries
and investments

D

6

1

Total non-operating exceptional items


6

(5)

Total exceptional items
before tax


(2)

(12)

 

A - Reorganisation and restructuring costs

In 2012 £5 million of costs were incurred relating to restructuring initiatives to drive cost efficiency in line with the strategy.

B - Acquisition related expenses

Acquisition related expenses of £8 million include professional fees (mainly financial and legal due diligence) incurred on the acquisitions completed during the year of £5 million (2012: £2 million; see also note 3.4), and expenses in the period with respect to performance based, employment linked contingent costs accrued to former owners of £3 million (2012: nil).

C - Loss on sale and impairment of non-current assets

In 2012 a £6 million loss on sale and impairment of non-current assets was incurred primarily as a result of an impairment on previous premises of £5 million.

D - Gain on sale and impairment of subsidiaries and investments

In 2013 the credit principally relates to the gain of £6 million recognised on disposal of STV shares. In 2012, the £1 million credit related to a £3 million gain on the sale of Screenvision US (Technicolor Cinema Advertisers LLC), offset by £2 million of impairment charges on investments in Freesat (UK) Limited and NoHo Film and Television Limited.

2.3 Taxation

Keeping it simple . . .

This section lays out the tax accounting policies, the current and deferred tax charges or credits in the year (which together make up the total tax charge or credit in the income statement), a reconciliation of profit before tax to the tax charge and the movements in deferred tax assets and liabilities.

Following revisions to IAS 19, we have restated our prior period results and the details of those restatements are included in note 3.7.

Accounting policies

The tax charge for the period is recognised in the income statement and the statement of comprehensive income, according to the accounting treatment of the related transaction. The tax charge comprises both current and deferred tax. The calculation of the Group's total tax charge involves a degree of estimation and judgement in respect of certain items whose tax treatment cannot be finally determined until a resolution has been reached by the relevant tax authority.

Current tax is the expected tax payable or receivable on the taxable income or loss for the year and any adjustment in respect of previous years. The current tax charge is based on tax rates that are enacted or substantively enacted at the year end.

The Group recognises liabilities for anticipated tax issues based on estimates of the additional taxes that are likely to become due, which require judgement. Amounts are accrued based on management's interpretation of specific tax law and the likelihood of settlement. Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made.

Deferred tax arises due to certain temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and those for taxation purposes. The following temporary differences are not provided for:

·     the initial recognition of goodwill;

·     the initial recognition of assets or liabilities that affect neither accounting nor taxable profit other than in a business combination; and

·     differences relating to investments in subsidiaries to the extent that they will probably not reverse in the foreseeable future.

The amount of deferred tax provided is based on the expected manner of realisation or settlement of the carrying amount of assets and liabilities. A deferred tax asset is recognised only to the extent that it is probable that sufficient taxable profit will be available to utilise the temporary difference.

Recognition of deferred tax assets, therefore, involves judgement regarding the timing and level of future taxable income. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are disclosed net to the extent that they relate to taxes levied by the same authority and the Group has the right of set-off.

Taxation - Income statement

The total taxation charge in the income statement is analysed as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Current tax:



 Current tax charge before exceptional items

(78)

(63)

Current tax charge on exceptional items

(2)

(2)


(80)

(65)

 Adjustments for prior periods

3

10


(77)

(55)

Deferred tax:



Origination and reversal of temporary differences

(25)

(27)

 Adjustments for prior periods

(3)

5


(28)

(22)

Total taxation charge in the income statement

(105)

(77)

 

In order to understand how, in the income statement, a tax charge of £105 million (2012: £77 million restated) arises on a profit before tax of £435 million (2012: £334 million restated), the taxation charge that would arise at the standard rate of UK corporation tax is reconciled to the actual tax charge as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Profit before tax

435

334

Taxation charge at UK corporation tax rate of 23.25% (2012: 24.5%)

(101)

(82)

Non-taxable income/non-deductible expenses

1

(4)

Recognition of previously unrecognised temporary differences

-

8

Adjustments for prior periods

-

7

Impact of changes in tax rate

(4)

(3)

Other

(1)

(3)

Total taxation charge in the income statement

(105)

(77)

 

Non-deductible expenses are expenses that are not expected to be allowable for tax purposes. Similarly non-taxable income is income that will not be taxed.

A deferred tax asset of £10 million is recognised on overseas temporary differences in the USA. The deferred tax asset of £9 million in 2012 was on overseas temporary differences in the USA and Germany.

Adjustments for prior periods primarily arise where an outcome is obtained on certain tax matters which differs from expectations held when the related provision was made. Where the outcome is more favourable than the provision made, the difference is released, lowering the current year tax charge. Where the outcome is less favourable than our provision, an additional charge to current year tax will occur.

The effective tax rate is the tax charge on the face of the income statement expressed as a percentage of the profit before tax. In the year ended 31 December 2013, the effective tax rate is comparable to the standard rate of UK corporation tax. In the year ended 31 December 2012, the effective tax rate was lower than the standard rate of UK corporation tax primarily due to the reversal of over provisions for prior periods and recognition of overseas deferred tax assets. As explained in the Financial and Performance Review, the Group uses an adjusted tax rate to show the cash tax impact on its adjusted earnings.

Taxation - Other comprehensive income

Within other comprehensive income a tax charge totalling £13 million (2012: credit of £50 million) has been recognised representing deferred tax. An analysis of this is included in the deferred tax movement table.

 

Taxation - Statement of financial position

The table below outlines the deferred tax assets/(liabilities) that are recognised in the statement of financial position, together with their movements in the year:


At

1 January

2013

£m

Recognised in

the income

statement

£m

Recognised

in equity

£m

At

31 December

2013

£m

Property, plant and equipment

(6)

-

-

(6)

Intangible assets

(34)

15

-

(19)

Programme rights

1

-

-

1

Pension scheme deficits

96

(27)

(13)

56

UK tax losses

17

(16)

-

1

Interest-bearing loans and borrowings, and derivatives

-

-

-

-

Share-based compensation

9

(1)

5

13

Overseas

9

1

-

10

Other

1

-

(5)

(4)


93

(28)

(13)

52

 


At

1 January

2012

£m

Recognised in

the income

statement

(restated)

£m

Recognised

in equity

(restated)

£m

At

31 December

2012

 £m

Property, plant and equipment

1

(7)

-

(6)

Intangible assets

(49)

15

-

(34)

Programme rights

1

-

-

1

Pension scheme deficits

71

(24)

49

96

UK tax losses

32

(15)

-

17

Interest-bearing loans and borrowings, and derivatives

(1)

1

-

-

Share-based compensation

8

-

1

9

Overseas

-

9

-

9

Other

2

(1)

-

1


65

(22)

50

93

 

At 31 December 2013, total deferred tax assets are £81 million (2012: £133 million) and total deferred tax liabilities are £29 million (2012: £40 million).

The deferred tax balance relates to:

·     property, plant and equipment temporary differences arising on assets qualifying for capital allowances;

·     temporary differences on intangible assets arising on business combinations;

·     programme rights temporary differences on intercompany profits on stock;

·     pension scheme deficit temporary differences on the IAS 19 pension deficit, additional contributions resulting from funding through the SDN pension partnership (not recognised as contributions under IAS 19) and the spreading of tax relief on one-off large pension funding payments;

·     UK tax loss temporary differences in receiving the benefit of the Group's tax losses;

·     interest-bearing loans and borrowings and derivatives  temporary differences on hedging instruments;

·     share-based compensation temporary differences on share schemes;

·     overseas temporary differences on intangible assets and net operating losses arising in the US and Germany; and

·     other temporary differences on miscellaneous items.

Due to the change in the statutory tax rate, deferred tax is provided at 20% (2012: 23%), which is the rate that has been substantively enacted to apply on 2 July 2013. The impact of the change in the tax rate is £6 million (2012: £7 million), of which £4 million was recognised in the deferred tax charge and the remainder recognised in equity to reflect the movements in the pension deficit taken to equity.

The deferred tax balance associated with the pension deficit has been adjusted to reflect the current tax benefit obtained in the current year following the employer contributions of £91 million to the Group's defined benefit pension scheme. The adjustment in equity to the deferred tax balance primarily relates to the actuarial gains recognised in the period.

A deferred tax asset of £446 million (2012: £513 million) in respect of capital losses of £2,230 million (2012: £2,230 million) has not been recognised due to uncertainties as to the amount and whether a capital gain will arise in the appropriate form and relevant territory against which such losses could be utilised. For the same reasons, deferred tax assets in respect of overseas losses of £14 million (2012: £13 million) that time expire between 2017 and 2026 have not been recognised.

2.4 Earnings per share

Keeping it simple . . .

Earnings per share ('EPS') is the amount of post-tax profit attributable to each share.

Basic EPS is calculated on the Group profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of £326 million (2012: £256 million) divided by 3,929 million (2012: 3,888 million) being the weighted average number of shares in issue during the year.

Diluted EPS reflects any commitments the Group has to issue shares in the future. In 2013, this comprised share options and the 2016 convertible bond. To calculate the impact it is assumed that all share options are exercised and that the 2016 convertible bond is converted into shares in its entirety.

When calculating the impact of the convertible bond, only ten months of dilution were suffered since the bond was settled in October (see note 4.1 for details). 

Basic EPS is adjusted in order to more accurately show the business performance of the Group in a consistent manner and reflect how the business is managed and measured on a day-to-day basis. Adjusted EPS is adjusted for exceptional items which include acquisition related costs (professional fees, primarily due diligence, and performance based, employment linked contingent payments), impairment of intangible assets, amortisation of intangible assets acquired through business combinations, net financing cost adjustments and prior period and other tax adjustments.

Following revisions to IAS 19, we have restated our prior period results and the details of those restatements are included in note 3.7.

 

The calculation of basic, diluted and adjusted EPS is set out below:

Earnings per share 2013


Ref.

Basic

£m

Diluted

£m

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of ITV plc


326

331

Weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,929

3,929

Dilution due to share options


-

46

Dilution due to convertible bond

A

-

136

Total weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,929

4,111

Earnings per ordinary share


8.3p

8.1p

 

Adjusted earnings per share 2013


Ref.

Adjusted

£m

Diluted

£m

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of ITV plc

A

326

331

Exceptional items

B

1

1

Profit for the year before exceptional items


327

332

Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets

C

42

42

Adjustments to net financing costs

D

69

69

Other tax adjustments

E

3

3

Adjusted profit

F

441

446

Total weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,929

4,111

Adjusted earnings per ordinary share


11.2p

10.8p

 

Earnings per share 2012 (restated)


Ref.

Basic

£m

Diluted

£m

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of ITV plc


256

264

Weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,888

3,888

Dilution due to share options


-

43

Dilution due to convertible bond

A

-

192

Total weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,888

4,123

Earnings per ordinary share


6.6p

6.4p

 

Adjusted earnings per share 2012 (restated)


Ref.

Adjusted

£m

Diluted

£m

Profit for the year attributable to equity shareholders of ITV plc


256

264

Exceptional items

B

10

10

Profit for the year before exceptional items


266

274

Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets

C

37

37

Adjustments to net financing costs

D

47

47

Other tax adjustments

E

2

2

Adjusted profit

F

352

360

Total weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue - million


3,888

4,123

Adjusted earnings per ordinary share


9.1p

8.7p

 

Details of the adjustments to earnings are as follows:

A. The Group dilutes EPS for the impact of any convertible instrument outstanding during the year. As detailed in note 4.1, in 2013 the Group partially settled the 2016 convertible Eurobond for equity. Consequently, diluted profit for the period attributable to equity shareholders of ITV plc includes an adjustment for interest and accretion recognised in the year on the convertible Eurobond which would not have been incurred if the bond had been converted to equity at the beginning of the period. There will equally be a dilutive impact on the weighted average number of shares for the period to settlement resulting in an additional 136 million shares (2012: 192 million shares for the full year).

B. Both operating and non-operating exceptional items (detailed in note 2.2) are adjusted to reflect profit for the year before exceptional items. A net tax credit of £1 million (2012: £2 million credit) is recognised on the total exceptional items charge of £2 million (2012: £12 million charge).

C. Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets of £42 million (2012: £37 million) is calculated as total amortisation and impairment of £66 million (2012: £60 million), less amortisation of software licences and development of £12 million (2012: £11 million). A related tax credit of £12 million (2012: £12 million) is then recognised on the net amount.

D. Gross adjustments to net financing costs of £90 million (2012: £62 million restated) relate to mark-to-market movements on swaps and foreign exchange, losses on buybacks and imputed pension interest charges. This is reduced by a tax credit of £21 million (2012: £15 million restated) to give a net adjustment of £69 million (2012: £47 million restated).

E. Other tax adjustments primarily reflect the impact on the deferred tax charge resulting from a decrease in the statutory tax rate from 23% to 20% and to reflect the reversal of credit in respect of losses (2012: the rate at which we recognised deferred tax decreased from 25% to 23%).

F. Adjusted profit is defined as profit for the year before exceptional items which include acquisition related costs (professional fees, primarily due diligence, and performance based, employment linked contingent payments), impairment of intangible assets, amortisation of intangible assets acquired through business combinations, net financing costs adjustments and other tax adjustments.

Section 3: Operating Assets and Liabilities

In this section . . .

This section shows the assets used to generate the Group's trading performance and the liabilities incurred as a result. Liabilities relating to the Group's financing activities are addressed in Section 4. Deferred tax assets and liabilities are shown in note 2.3.

On the following pages there are notes covering working capital, non-current assets and liabilities, acquisitions and disposals, provisions and pensions.

3.1 Working capital

Keeping it simple . . .

Working capital represents the assets and liabilities
the Group generates through its trading activity. The Group therefore defines working capital as distribution rights, programme rights and other inventory, trade and other receivables and trade and other payables.

Careful management of working capital ensures
that the Group can meet its trading and financing obligations within its ordinary operating cycle.

Working capital is a driver of the 'profit to cash' conversion, a key performance indicator for the Group. The Group's target 'profit to cash' ratio on a rolling three year basis is at least 90%.

In the following section you will find further information regarding working capital management and analysis of the elements of working capital.

3.1.1 Distribution rights

Accounting policies

'Distribution rights' are programme rights the Group buys from producers to derive future revenues principally through licensing to broadcasters. These are classified as non-current assets as these rights are used to derive long-term economic benefit for the Group.

Distribution rights are recognised initially at cost and charged through operating costs in the income statement over a maximum five year period that is dependent on either cumulative sales and programme genre, or based on forecast future sales. Certain film rights are expensed over a period of up to ten years reflecting the estimated period over which these types of rights can be exploited. These estimates are based on historical experience with similar rights as well as anticipation of future events. Advances paid for the acquisition of distribution rights are disclosed as distribution rights as soon as they are contracted. These advances are not expensed until the programme is available for distribution. Up to that point they are assessed annually for impairment through the reassessment of the future sales expected to be earned from that title.

Movements in distribution rights during the year are shown in the table below:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Cost:



At 1 January

140

125

Additions

16

15

At 31 December

156

140




Charged to income statement:



At 1 January

123

114

Charge for the year

23

9

At 31 December

146

123




Net book value

10

17

 

3.1.2 Programme rights and other inventory

Accounting policies

Where programming, sports rights and film rights are acquired for the primary purpose of broadcasting, these are recognised within current assets.

Assets are recognised when the Group controls the respective assets and the risks and rewards associated
with them.

For acquired programme rights, assets are recognised as payments are made and are recognised in full when the programme is available for transmission. Programmes produced internally, either for the purpose of broadcasting or to be sold in the normal course of the Group's operating cycle, are recognised within current assets at production cost.

Programme costs and rights, including those acquired under sale and leaseback arrangements, are generally expensed to operating costs in full on first transmission. Film rights, sports rights and certain acquired programmes are expensed over a number of transmissions reflecting the pattern in which the right is consumed.

Programme costs and rights not yet written off are included in the statement of financial position at the lower of cost and net realisable value. In assessing net realisable value for programmes in production, judgement is required when considering the contracted sales price and estimated costs to complete. For programme stock, sports rights and film rights, the net realisable value assessment is based on estimated airtime value, with consideration given to whether the number of transmissions purchased can be efficiently played out over the licence period.

Historically, ITV has entered into sale and leaseback agreements in relation to certain programme titles. Related outstanding sale and leaseback obligations, which comprise the principal and accrued interest, are included within borrowings. The finance related element of the agreement is charged to the income statement over the term of the lease on an effective interest basis. Sale and leaseback obligations are secured against an equivalent cash balance held within cash and cash equivalents.

The programme rights and other inventory at the year end are shown in the table below:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Acquired programming

110

102

Production

109

97

Commissions

46

24

Sports rights

57

28

Other

-

1


322

252

 

Production inventory comprises the costs incurred by ITV Studios in producing a programme, where the programme is part way through the production process and not yet available for delivery to a broadcaster. Commissions primarily comprise programmes purchased based on editorial specification, over which the Group has some control.

Programme rights and other inventory written down in the year were £1 million (2012: £3 million).

3.1.3 Programme commitments

These are operating commitments in respect of programming entered into in the ordinary course of business with programme suppliers, sports organisations and film distributors in respect of rights to broadcast on the ITV network. Commitments in respect of these purchases, which are not reflected in the statement of financial position, are due for payment as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Within one year

444

439

Later than one year and not more than five years

431

474

More than five years

3

47


878

960

 

3.1.4 Trade and other receivables

Accounting policies

Trade receivables are recognised initially at the value of the invoice sent to the customer and subsequently at the amounts considered recoverable (amortised cost). Where payments are not due for more than one year, they are shown in the financial statements at their net present value to reflect the economic cost of delayed payment. The Group provides goods and services to substantially all its customers on credit terms.

Estimates are used in determining the level of receivables that will not, in the opinion of the Directors, be collected. These estimates include such factors as historical experience, the current state of the UK and overseas economies and industry specific factors. A provision for impairment of trade receivables is established when there is sufficient evidence that the Group will not be able to collect all amounts due.

The carrying value of trade receivables is considered to approximate fair value.

Trade and other receivables can be analysed as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Due within one year:



 Trade receivables

295

264

 Other receivables

40

44

 Prepayments and accrued income

53

58


388

366

Due after more than one year:



 Trade receivables

11

14

 Other receivables

3

-

Total trade and other receivables

402

380

 

£306 million (2012: £278 million) of total trade receivables that are not impaired are aged as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Current

296

274

Up to 30 days overdue

8

2

Between 30 and 90 days overdue

2

2


306

278

 

The balance above is stated net of a provision of £7 million (2012: £7 million) for impairment of trade receivables. Of the provision total, £3 million relates to balances overdue by more than 90 days (2012: £4 million) and £4 million relates to current balances (2012: £3 million).

Movements in the Group's provision for impairment of trade receivables can be shown as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

At 1 January

7

11

Charged during the year

1

3

Receivables written off during the year as uncollectable (utilisation of provision)

(1)

(4)

Unused amounts reversed

-

(3)

At 31 December

7

7

 

3.1.5 Trade and other payables due within one year

Accounting policies

Trade payables are recognised at the value of the invoice received from a supplier.

The carrying value of trade payables is considered to approximate fair value.

Trade and other payables due within one year can be analysed as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Trade payables

43

34

Social security

7

7

Other payables

216

193

Accruals and deferred income

436

388


702

622

 

3.1.6 Trade payables due after more than one year

Trade payables due after more than one year can be analysed as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Trade payables

42

31

 

This primarily relates to film creditors for which payment is due after more than one year.

3.1.7 Working capital management

Cash and working capital management continues to be a key focus. During the year the cash outflow from working capital was £15 million (2012: inflow of £1 million) derived as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

(Increase)/decrease in programme rights and other inventory and distribution rights

(42)

29

(Increase)/decrease in receivables

(15)

17

Increase/(decrease) in payables

42

(45)

Working capital (outflow)/ inflow

(15)

1

 

The working capital outflow for the year excludes the impact of balances acquired on the purchase of new subsidiaries (see note 3.4).

The increase in programme rights and other inventory is largely driven by an increase in commissions and sports rights. The broadcast sports rights mainly represent payment for the FIFA World Cup and Rugby World Cup.

The increase in receivables has been driven by higher revenues, compared to December 2012, resulting in an increase in trade receivables.

The increase in payables primarily relates to trade payables, and an increase in the Group VAT liability.

3.2 Property, plant and equipment

Keeping it simple . . .

The following section shows the physical assets used
by the Group to operate the business, generating revenues and profits. These assets include office buildings and studios, as well as equipment used in broadcast transmission, programme production and support activities.

The cost of these assets is the amount initially paid for them. A depreciation expense is charged to the income statement to reflect annual wear and tear and the reduced value of the asset over time. Depreciation is calculated by estimating the number of years the Group expects the asset to be used (useful economic life). If there has been a technological change or decline in business performance the Directors review the value of the assets to ensure they have not fallen below their depreciated value. If an asset's value falls below its depreciated value an additional one-off impairment charge is made against profit.

This section also explains the accounting policies followed by ITV and the specific estimates made in arriving at the net book value of these assets.

Accounting policies

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and impairment losses. Certain items of property, plant and equipment that were revalued to fair value prior to 1 January 2004, the date of transition to IFRS, are measured on the basis of deemed cost, being the revalued amount less depreciation up to the date of transition.

Leases

Finance leases are those which transfer substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership to the lessee. Certain service contracts involve the use of specific assets (e.g. transmission or studio equipment) and therefore contain an embedded lease.

Determining whether a lease is a finance lease requires judgement as to whether substantially all of the risks and benefits of ownership have been transferred to the Group. Estimates used by management in making this assessment include the useful economic life of assets, the fair value of the asset and the discount rate applied to the total payments required under the lease. Assets held under such leases are included within property, plant and equipment and depreciated on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives.

Outstanding finance lease obligations, which comprise the principal plus accrued interest, are included within borrowings. The finance element of the agreements is charged to the income statement over the term of the lease on an effective interest basis.

All other leases are operating leases, the rentals on which are charged to the income statement on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

Depreciation

Depreciation is provided to write off the cost of property, plant and equipment less estimated residual value, on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives. The annual depreciation charge is sensitive to the estimated useful life of each asset and the expected residual value at the end of its life. The major categories of property, plant and equipment are depreciated as follows:

Asset class

Depreciation policy

Freehold land

Freehold buildings

Leasehold improvements

 

Vehicles, equipment and fittings1

 

1.   Equipment includes studio production and technology assets.

Impairment of assets

Property, plant and equipment that is subject to depreciation is reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. Indicators of impairment may include changes in technology and business performance.

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment can be analysed as follows:


Freehold land

and buildings

Improvements to leasehold

land and buildings

Vehicles, equipment

and fittings

Total


 

£m

Long

£m

Short

£m

Owned

£m

Finance leases

£m

 

£m

Cost







At 1 January 2012

51

59

18

205

14

347

Additions

-

18

-

33

2

53

Reclassification to intangible assets

-

-

-

(6)

-

(6)

Reclassification to assets held for sale

(37)

(1)

-

(8)

-

(46)

Disposals and retirements

-

-

(2)

(21)

-

(23)

At 31 December 2012

14

76

16

203

16

325

Additions

58

24

1

23

-

106

Reclassification of acquired property

32

(32)

-

-

-

-

Reclassification from assets held for sale (note 3.5)

33

1

-

8

-

42

Disposals and retirements

-

-

-

(13)

-

(13)

At 31 December 2013

137

69

17

221

16

460








Depreciation







At 1 January 2012

9

15

15

130

11

180

Charge for the year

1

2

1

20

3

27

Impairment charge for the year (see note 2.2)

5

-

-

-

-

5

Reclassification to assets held for sale

(12)

(1)

-

(8)

-

(21)

Disposals and retirements

-

-

(1)

(21)

-

(22)

At 31 December 2012

3

16

15

121

14

169

Charge for the year

1

1

-

22

-

24

Reclassification of acquired property

7

(7)

-

-

-

-

Reclassification from assets held for sale (note 3.5)

12

1

-

8

-

21

Disposals and retirements

-

-

-

(13)

-

(13)

At 31 December 2013

23

11

15

138

14

201

Net book value







At 31 December 2013

114

58

2

83

2

259

At 31 December 2012

11

60

1

82

2

156

 

There are no additions in 2013 relating to acquisitions made in the year (2012: £2 million).

Included within property, plant and equipment are assets in the course of construction of £66 million (2012: £38 million). Included within this are construction costs in relation to the new Coronation Street set, which was completed in early 2014.

During the year, the Group acquired the freehold and leasehold at its headquarters, the London Television Centre, for £56 million and stamp duty of £2 million.

 

Capital commitments

There are £3 million of capital commitments at
31 December 2013 (2012: £10 million) which primarily relate to the development at MediaCity, including the new location for Coronation Street, in Manchester.

3.3 Intangible assets

Keeping it simple . . .

The following section shows the non-physical assets used by the Group to generate revenues and profits.

These assets include brands, customer contracts and relationships, contractual arrangements, licences, software development, film libraries and goodwill. The cost of these assets is the amount that the Group has paid or, where there has been a business combination, the fair value of the specific intangible assets that could be sold separately or which arise from legal rights. In the case of goodwill, its cost is the amount the Group has paid in acquiring a business over and above the fair value of the individual assets and liabilities acquired. The value of goodwill is 'intangible' value that comes from, for example, a uniquely strong market position and the outstanding productivity of its employees.

The value of intangible assets, with the exception of
goodwill, reduces over the number of years the Group expects to use the asset, the useful economic life, via an annual amortisation charge to the income statement. Where there has been a technological change or decline in business performance the Directors review the value of assets to ensure they have not fallen below their amortised value. Should an asset's value fall below its amortised value an additional one-off impairment charge is made against profit.

This section explains the accounting policies applied and the specific judgements and estimates made by the Directors in arriving at the net book value of these assets.

Accounting policies

Goodwill

Goodwill represents the future economic benefits that arise from assets that are not capable of being individually identified and separately recognised. The goodwill recognised by the Group has all arisen as a result of business combinations.

Due to changes in accounting standards goodwill has been calculated using three different methods depending on the date the relevant business was purchased.

Method 1: All business combinations that have occurred since 1 January 2009 were accounted for using the acquisition method. Under this method, goodwill is measured as the fair value of the consideration transferred (including the recognition of any non-controlling interests of the business being bought), less the fair value of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed, all measured at the acquisition date. Any contingent consideration to be transferred will be recognised at fair value at the acquisition date and recognised within Other payables. Contingent consideration classified as an asset or liability that is a financial instrument is measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognised in the income statement. The determination of fair value is based on discounted cash flows. The key assumptions take into consideration the probability of meeting each performance target and the discount rate.

Where less than 100% of a subsidiary is acquired, and call and put options are granted over the remaining interest, a non-controlling interest is recognised in equity. A call option is recognised as a derivative financial instrument, carried at fair value. The put option is recognised as a liability within Other payables, carried at the present value of the put option exercise price, and a corresponding charge is included in Merger and Other Reserves. Any subsequent remeasurement of the call option and the put option liability is recognised within finance income or cost.

Subsequent adjustments to the fair value of net assets acquired can only be made within 12 months of the acquisition date, and only if fair values were determined provisionally at an earlier reporting date. These adjustments are accounted for from the date of acquisition.

Acquisitions of non-controlling interests are accounted for as transactions with owners and therefore no goodwill is recognised as a result of such transactions. Transaction costs incurred in connection with those business combinations, such as legal fees, due diligence fees and other professional fees, are expensed as incurred.

Method 2: All business combinations that occurred between 1 January 2004 and 31 December 2008 were accounted for using the purchase method in accordance with IFRS 3 'Business Combinations (2004)'. Goodwill on those combinations represents the difference between the cost of the acquisition and the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired and did not include the value of the non-controlling interest. Transaction costs incurred in connection with those business combinations, such as legal fees, due diligence fees and other professional fees, were included in the cost of acquisition.

Method 3: For business combinations prior to 1 January 2004, goodwill is included at its deemed cost, which represents the amount recorded under UK GAAP at that time less accumulated amortisation up to 31 December 2003. The classification and accounting treatment of business combinations occurring prior to 1 January 2004, the date of transition to IFRS, has not been reconsidered as permitted under IFRS 1. Goodwill is stated at its recoverable amount being cost less any accumulated impairment losses and is allocated to cash-generating units.

Other intangible assets

Other intangible assets are those which are identifiable and can be sold separately or which arise from legal rights.

Within ITV there are two types of intangible assets: those acquired and those that have been internally generated (such as software licences and development).

Other intangible assets acquired directly by the Group are stated at cost less accumulated amortisation. Those separately identified intangible assets acquired as part of a business combination are shown at fair value at the date of acquisition less accumulated amortisation.

The main intangible assets the Group has valued are brands, licences, contractual arrangements, and customer contracts and relationships.

Each class of intangible asset's valuation method on initial recognition, amortisation method and estimated useful life is set out in the table below:

Class of intangible asset

Valuation method

Amortisation method

Estimated useful life

Brands

 

Applying a royalty rate to the expected future revenues
over the life of the brand.

Straight-line

 

up to 11 years

 

Customer contracts and relationships

 

Expected future cash flows from those contracts and relationships existing at the date of acquisition are
estimated. If applicable, a contributory charge is deducted
for the use of other assets needed to exploit the cash flow.

The net cash flow is then discounted back to present

value.

Straight-line

 

up to 6 years for customer contracts

 

5 to 10 years for customer relationships

Contractual arrangements

Expected future cash flows from those contracts existing at the date of acquisition are estimated. If applicable, a contributory charge is deducted for the use of other assets needed to exploit the cash flow. The net cash flow is then discounted back to present value.

Straight-line

 

up to 10 years depending on the contract terms

Licences

 

Start-up basis of expected future cash flows existing at
the date of acquisition. If applicable, a contributory charge is deducted for the use of other assets needed to exploit the cash flow. The net cash flow is then discounted back to present
value.

Straight-line

11 to 17 years depending on term of licence

 

Software licences and development

Initially at cost and subsequently at cost less accumulated amortisation.

Straight-line

 

1 to 5 years

 

Film libraries

 

Initially at cost and subsequently at cost less accumulated amortisation.

Sum of digits

 

20 years

 

 

Determining the fair value of intangible assets arising on acquisition requires judgement. The Directors make estimates regarding the timing and amount of future cash flows derived from exploiting the assets being acquired. The Directors then estimate an appropriate discount rate to apply to the forecast cash flows. Such estimates are based on current budgets and forecasts, extrapolated for an appropriate period taking into account growth rates, expected changes to selling prices, operating costs and the expected useful lives of assets. Judgements are also made regarding whether, and for how long, licences will be renewed; this drives our amortisation policy for those assets.

The Directors estimate the appropriate discount rate using pre-tax rates that reflect current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the assets or businesses being acquired.

Amortisation

Amortisation is charged to the income statement over the estimated useful lives of intangible assets unless such lives are judged to be indefinite. Indefinite life assets, such as goodwill, are not amortised but are tested for impairment at each year end.

Impairment

Goodwill is not subject to amortisation and is tested annually for impairment and when circumstances indicate that the carrying value may be impaired.

Other intangible assets are subject to amortisation and are reviewed for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the amount carried in the statement of financial position is less than its recoverable amount.

Determining whether the carrying amount of intangible assets has any indication of impairment requires judgement. Any impairment is recognised in the income statement.

 

An impairment test is performed by assessing the recoverable amount of each asset, or for goodwill, the cash-generating unit (or group of cash-generating units) related to the goodwill. Assets are grouped at the lowest levels for which there are separately identifiable cash flows ('cash-generating unit' or 'CGU').

The recoverable amount is the higher of an asset's fair value less costs to sell and 'value in use'. The value in use is based on the present value of the future cash flows expected to arise from the asset.

Growth assumptions derived from the strategy are not included in the estimated future cash flows used as the Group applies cautious assumptions for impairment testing.

Estimates are used in deriving these cash flows and the discount rate. Such estimates reflect current market assessments of the risks specific to the asset and the time value of money. The estimation process is complex due to the inherent risks and uncertainties. If different estimates of the projected future cash flows or a different selection of an appropriate discount rate or long-term growth rate were made, these changes could materially alter the projected value of the cash flows of the asset, and as a consequence materially different amounts would be reported in the financial statements.

Impairment losses in respect of goodwill are not reversed. In respect of assets other than goodwill, an impairment loss is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amount. An impairment loss is reversed only to the extent that the asset's carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined, net of depreciation or amortisation, if no impairment loss had been recognised.

 

Intangible assets

Intangible assets can be analysed as follows:


Goodwill

£m

Brands

£m

Customer

contracts

and relationships

£m

Contractual

arrangements

£m

Licences

£m

Software

licences and

development

£m

Film libraries

and other

£m

Total

£m

Cost









At 1 January 2012

3,379

173

328

-

121

62

79

4,142

Additions (restated)

32

2

4

10

-

10

-

58

Reclassification from tangible assets

-

-

-

-

-

6

-

6

At 31 December 2012 (restated)

3,411

175

332

10

121

78

79

4,206

Additions

58

4

20

-

-

-

2

84

Foreign exchange

(2)

-

-

-

-

-

-

(2)

At 31 December 2013

3,467

179

352

10

121

78

81

4,288

Amortisation and impairment









At 1 January 2012

2,654

127

287

-

65

37

38

3,208

Charge for the year

-

16

19

-

9

11

2

57

Impairments

-

-

-

-

-

-

3

3

At 31 December 2012

2,654

143

306

-

74

48

43

3,268

Charge for the year

-

16

20

2

9

12

7

66

At 31 December 2013

2,654

159

326

2

83

60

50

3,334

Net book value









At 31 December 2013

813

20

26

8

38

18

31

954

At 31 December 2012 (restated)

757

32

26

10

47

30

36

938

 

All additions in the year are due to the acquisition of four production companies, as detailed in note 3.4 (2012: £48 million due to acquisitions).

2012 goodwill additions have been restated to reflect fair value adjustments of £6 million recognised upon finalisation of the purchase price allocation exercise.

Following an annual review of the amortisation periods and residual values of the intangible assets, the Group has adjusted its estimated residual value for the film libraries, resulting in an increased annual amortisation charge in the period.

 

Goodwill impairment tests

The following CGUs represent the carrying amounts of goodwill.


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Broadcast & Online

342

342

SDN

76

76

ITV Studios

395

339


813

757

 

There has been no impairment charge for the year (2012: nil).

When assessing impairment, the recoverable amount of each CGU is based on value in use calculations. These calculations require the use of estimates, specifically: pre-tax cash flow projections; long-term growth rates; and a pre-tax market discount rate.

Cash flow projections are based on the Group's current five year plan. Beyond the five year plan these projections are extrapolated using an estimated long-term growth rate of 2% (2012: 1%-2.5%). The growth rate used is consistent with the long-term average growth rates for the industry and is appropriate because these are long-term businesses.

The discount rate has been revised for each CGU to reflect the latest market assumptions for the Risk-Free rate, the Equity Risk Premium and the net cost of debt. There is currently no reasonably possible change in discount rate that would reduce the headroom in any CGU to zero.

Broadcast & Online

The goodwill in this CGU arose as a result of the acquisition of broadcasting businesses since 1999, the largest of which were the acquisition by Granada of United News and Media's broadcast businesses in 2000 and the merger of Carlton and Granada in 2004 to form ITV plc.

No impairment charge arose in the Broadcast & Online CGU during the course of 2013 (2012: nil).

The main assumptions on which the forecast cash flow projections for this CGU are based include: the share of the television advertising market; share of commercial impacts; programme and other costs; and the pre-tax market discount rate.

The key assumption in assessing the recoverable amount of Broadcast & Online goodwill is the size of the television advertising market. In forming its assumptions about the television advertising market, the Group has used a combination of long-term trends, industry forecasts and in-house estimates, which place greater emphasis on recent experience. Current industry consensus for the advertising market is 3.5% for 2014. The impairment test also assumed that ITV renews its broadcasting licences, which occured in February 2014. No impairment was identified. Also as part of the review, a sensitivity of -5% was applied to 2014 for the purposes of the impairment test, again with no impairment identified.

A pre-tax market discount rate of 11.3% (2012: 12.3%) has been used in discounting the projected cash flows.

The Directors believe that currently no reasonably possible change in these assumptions would reduce the headroom in this CGU to zero.

SDN

Goodwill was recognised when the Group acquired SDN (the licence operator for DTT Multiplex A) in 2005. It represented the wider strategic benefits of the acquisition specific to the Group, principally the enhanced ability to promote Freeview as a platform, business relationships with the channels which are on Multiplex A and additional capacity available from 2010.

No impairment charge arose on the SDN goodwill during the course of 2013 (2012: nil).

The main assumptions on which the forecast cash flows are based are income to be earned from medium-term contracts, the market price of available multiplex video streams in the period up to and beyond digital switchover and the pre-tax market discount rate. These assumptions have been determined by using a combination of current contract terms, recent market transactions and in-house estimates of video stream availability and pricing.

A pre-tax market discount rate of 13.1% (2012: 14.4%) has been used in discounting the projected cash flows.

The Directors believe that currently no reasonably possible change in the income and availability assumptions would reduce the headroom in this CGU to zero.

ITV Studios

The goodwill for ITV Studios arose as a result of the acquisition of production businesses since 1999, the largest of which were the acquisition by Granada of United News and Media's production businesses in 2000 and the merger of Carlton and Granada in 2004 to form ITV plc. ITV Studios goodwill also includes all of the goodwill arising from recent acquisitions in 2013 and 2012.

No impairment charge arose in the ITV Studios CGU during the course of 2013 (2012: nil).

The key assumptions on which the forecast cash flows were based include revenue (including international revenue and the ITV Studios share of ITV output, growth in commissions and hours produced), margin growth and the pre-tax market discount rate. These assumptions have been determined by using a combination of extrapolation of historical trends within the business, industry estimates and in-house estimates of growth rates in all markets.

A pre-tax market discount rate of 12.2% (2012: 12.9%) has been used in discounting the projected cash flows.

The Directors believe that currently no reasonably possible change in the income and availability assumptions would reduce the headroom in this CGU to zero.

 

3.4 Acquisitions

Keeping it simple . . .

The following section outlines what the Group has acquired in the year.

All of the deals are structured so that a large part of the payment made to the sellers is determined based on future performance ('consideration'). Accounting standards require some of this consideration to be included in the purchase price used in determining goodwill ('contingent consideration'), while the rest is required to be recognised as a liability or expense outside of acquisition accounting (put option liabilities and performance based, employment-linked contingent payments known as 'earnout' payments).

Therefore, for each acquisition below, the distinction between the types of consideration has been explained in detail.

Acquisitions

During 2013 the Group completed four acquisitions, all of which have been included in the results of the Studios operating segment. Each of these businesses fits with the Group's strategy to create world class content for multiple platforms, free and pay, both in the UK and internationally. The following sections provide a summary of each acquisition.

Acquisitions in the United Kingdom

The Garden Productions

On 22 April 2013, the Group acquired 100% of The Garden Productions Limited ('The Garden'), a company that specialises in factual entertainment productions. Initial consideration of £18 million was paid in cash. Contingent consideration included a performance based payment due in 2014 of a maximum of £8 million which is no longer expected to be paid.

The Group also agreed to an earnout payment that will be based on the business meeting certain performance targets. The maximum payment is £28 million (undiscounted) and the expected payment is being accrued over the earnout period (five years), and will largely be reported within exceptional items relating to acquisitions in the income statement.

Intangibles, being the value placed on key contractual arrangements, of £8 million were identified. Goodwill, which represents the value placed on the opportunity to diversify and grow the content and formats produced by the Group, has been provisionally valued at £12 million. The goodwill arising on the acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes.

Big Talk Productions

On 26 July 2013, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of Big Talk Productions Limited and associated companies ('Big Talk'), a business that specialises in scripted programmes. Initial consideration of £13 million was paid in cash. Contingent consideration includes a performance based payment due in 2015 of £1 million (maximum of £2 million undiscounted) and in 2018 of £2 million (maximum of £4 million undiscounted).

The Group also agreed to an earnout payment that will be based on the business meeting certain performance targets. The maximum payment is £11 million (undiscounted) and the expected payment is being accrued over the earnout period (five years), and will largely be reported within exceptional items relating to acquisitions in the income statement.

Intangibles, being the value placed on key contractual arrangements, of £3 million were identified. Goodwill, which represents the value placed on the opportunity to diversify and grow the content and formats produced by the Group, has been provisionally valued at £12 million. The goodwill arising on the acquisition is not expected to be deductible for tax purposes.

Acquisitions in the United States

On 10 May and 18 June 2013, the Group acquired 60% and 65% of the membership interests in High Noon Entertainment ('High Noon') and Thinkfactory Media ('Thinkfactory') respectively. The Group consolidates all of the earnings of both businesses and the vendors' remaining interest will be recognised as a non-controlling interest in equity.

High Noon specialises in reality and entertainment programmes, while Thinkfactory has a mixture of reality, entertainment and some scripted programming. It is the Group's view that the acquisitions will strengthen and complement ITV's existing position as a producer for major US television networks.

Goodwill represents the value placed on the opportunity to expand the Group's programme offering in the United States and exploiting that offering internationally. It also reflects the value of the assembled workforce of creative talent who will develop that content. It is expected to be deductible for US tax purposes.

Further details of each US acquisition is summarised below.

High Noon Entertainment

Initial consideration of £16 million ($26 million) for 60% was satisfied in cash and contingent consideration includes a performance based payment due in 2015 of £2 million ($3 million undiscounted, maximum of $10 million).

A call and put option has been granted over the 40% non-controlling interest. The call option is exercisable in the first half of 2016 and then following the expiry of the vendors' put option, which is exercisable in 2019.

The maximum additional consideration that the Group could pay for the remaining 40% equity interest is £45 million ($74 million; undiscounted). Final payment will be entirely dependent on future performance of the business, and the maximum payout will only be achieved if the business continues to deliver substantial growth over the next five years.

Intangibles, being the value placed on brands, customer contracts and contractual arrangements, of £7 million were identified and goodwill was valued at £16 million.

Based on the Group's projections at acquisition, the value of the put option was valued at £8 million ($13 million, discounted). The total was allocated, for accounting purposes, between a put option liability and an earnout accrual. Consequently, a put option liability of £6 million ($10 million) has been included in the Statement of Financial Position. Any changes in the fair value of the put option liability arising from a reassessment of projections will be reported within financing costs on the income statement, and excluded from adjusted profit. The remaining £2 million ($3 million) will be accrued over the put option vesting period as an earnout payment and will be reported within exceptional items relating to acquisitions in the income statement.

At the year end, the value of the put option was estimated to be £16 million ($28 million; undiscounted).

Thinkfactory Media

Initial consideration of £19 million ($30 million) for 65% was satisfied in cash.

A call and put option has been granted over the 35% non-controlling interest. The call option is exercisable in the first half of 2017 and then following the expiry of the vendors' put option, which is exercisable in 2019.

The maximum additional consideration which the Group could pay for the remaining 35% equity interest is £42 million ($70 million; undiscounted). Final payment will be entirely dependent on future performance of the business, and the maximum payout will only be achieved if the business continues to deliver substantial growth over the next five years.

Intangibles, being the value placed on brands, customer contracts and contractual arrangements, of £8 million were identified and goodwill was valued at £18 million.

At acquisition the put option was valued at £9 million ($13 million, discounted). The total has been allocated between a put option liability and an earnout accrual, resulting in a £7 million ($10 million) put option liability included in the Statement of Financial Position. Any subsequent changes in the fair value of the put option liability arising from a reassessment of projections will be reported within financing costs on the income statement, and excluded from adjusted profit. The remaining £2 million ($3 million) will be accrued over the put option vesting period as an earnout payment and will be reported within exceptional items relating to acquisitions in the income statement.

At the year end, the value of the put option was estimated to be £12 million ($20 million; undiscounted).

Effect of acquisition

The acquisitions noted above had the following impact on the Group assets and liabilities:

 

 

Recognised values on acquisition


£m

The

 Garden

High

Noon

Think

Factory

Big Talk

2013

Total

2012

Total

(Note D)

Consideration transferred:







Initial consideration (net of cash acquired) (Note A)

14

13

18

11

56

35

Contingent consideration

1

2

-

3

6

1

Total consideration

15

15

18

14

62

36








Fair value of net assets acquired (Note B):







Property, plant and equipment

-

-

-

-

-

2

Intangible assets

8

7

8

3

26

16

Trade and other receivables

2

11

8

11

32

7

Trade and other payables

(7)

(13)

(9)

(12)

(41)

(9)

Fair value of net assets

3

5

7

2

17

16

Non-controlling interest measured at fair value (Note C)

-

6

7

-

13

12

Goodwill

12

16

18

12

58

32








Other information:







Present value at acquisition of the liability on options

-

6

7

-

13

12

Present value at acquisition of the earnout payment

5

2

2

6

15

9








Contributions to the Group's performance:







Revenue - acquisition to date

10

22

20

9

61

6

Profit after tax - acquisition to date

1

1

1

-

3

-

Revenue - January to December

15

38

24

19

96

47

Profit after tax - January to December

2

2

1

1

6

6

 

Note A: Cash of £4 million was acquired with The Garden, £3 million was acquired with High Noon, £1 million with Thinkfactory and £2 million with Big Talk.
Note B: Provisional details of fair value of net assets acquired in 2013 are set out in the table above. The analysis is provisional and amendments may be made to these figures in the 12 months following the date of the acquisition.

Note C: Non-controlling interest arises where the Group acquires less than 100% of the equity interest in a business, but obtains control.

Note D: During 2013 a payment of £4 million was made to settle pre-acquisition cash of £6 million. Additional fair value adjustments of £6 million were recognised upon finalisation of the purchase price allocation exercise and recognised in goodwill. The December 2012 balance sheet has been restated to reflect the fair value adjustments to goodwill.

Fair value of the consideration transferred comprises the initial cash paid to the sellers and an estimate for any future payments the Group may be liable to pay, based on future performance of the business. This latter amount is classified as contingent consideration.

The total expected remuneration payment reflects the present value of the future amount the Group estimates it will have to pay the sellers based on employment conditions set out in the purchase agreement (separate to any employment contract). This payment does not form part of the calculation of goodwill. 

Acquisitions in 2012

During 2012 the Group completed four acquisitions which have all been included in the ITV Studios operating segment.

The Group acquired a 61.5% controlling interest in Gurney in December 2012. Total payments of £29 million ($46 million) were made, consisting of initial consideration of £25 million ($40 million) and £4 million ($6 million) paid for cash acquired. A call and put option was granted over the non-controlling interest. The discounted put option liability ('options') at the acquisition date was £12 million and the maximum consideration which the Group could pay for the remaining 38.5% equity interest is £42 million ($71 million; undiscounted). Final payment will be entirely dependent on future performance of the business.

Intangibles, being the value placed on brands, customer contracts and contractual arrangements, of £8 million were identified and goodwill of £26 million has been recognised.

The Group acquired 100% of the share capital of the remaining three businesses for total consideration of £13 million. The maximum additional amount payable is £11 million (undiscounted), and is primarily being accounted for as an earnout payment. Total goodwill of £6 million was recognised on acquisition and represents the value placed on the opportunity to diversify and grow the content and formats produced by the Group.

Acquisition costs largely comprise legal and financial diligence fees. Details of that, along with earnout costs expensed in the period, are disclosed in exceptional items note 2.2.

3.5 Assets held for sale and disposals

Keeping it simple . . .

The following section outlines what the Group is either holding for sale or has disposed of in the year.

IFRS provides strict criteria that must be met for an asset to be classified as held for sale. Where the Group no longer considers an asset to meet any of the criteria, it is reclassified.

Accounting policies

Non-current assets or disposal groups are classified as held for sale if their carrying amount will be recovered principally through sale, rather than continuing use; they are available for immediate sale; and the sale is highly probable. A disposal group consists of assets that are to be disposed of, by sale or otherwise, in a single transaction together with the directly associated liabilities. The Group includes goodwill acquired in a business combination if the disposal group is a cash-generating unit to which goodwill has been allocated.

On initial classification as held for sale, non-current assets or components of a disposal group are remeasured in accordance with the Group's accounting policies. Thereafter, generally the assets or disposal groups are measured at the lower of their carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell. Any impairment on a disposal group is first allocated to goodwill and then to remaining assets and liabilities on a pro rata basis, except to programming rights and other inventory, financial assets and deferred tax assets, which continue to be measured in accordance with the Group's accounting policies. Impairment on initial classification as held for sale and subsequent gains or losses on remeasurement are recognised in the income statement. Gains are not recognised in excess of any cumulative impairment.

No amortisation or depreciation is charged on non-current assets (including those in disposal groups) classified as held for sale. Assets classified as held for sale are disclosed separately on the face of the statement of financial position and classified as current assets or liabilities, with disposal groups being separated between assets held for sale and liabilities held for sale.

Assets held for sale

The movement in assets held for sale since 1 January 2013 is summarised in the table below:


2013

£m

At 1 January 2013

25

Disposal of properties held for sale

(4)

Property reclassified to tangible fixed assets

(21)

At 31 December 2013

-

 

At the beginning of the year the Group was actively marketing certain freehold properties in Manchester following the Group's decision to relocate to a new site at MediaCity. The sale of one Manchester property was completed in 2013 for consideration of £4 million, with an immaterial gain on sale. The remaining properties are under a conditional offer, with the sale not expected to complete until 2015. As a result, they have been reclassified to tangible fixed assets.

3.6 Provisions

Keeping it simple . . .

A provision is recognised by the Group where an obligation exists, relating to events in the past and it is probable that cash will be paid to settle it.

A provision is made where the Group is not certain how much cash will be required to settle a liability, so an estimate is required. The main estimates relate to the cost of holding properties that are no longer in use by the Group, the likelihood of settling legal claims and contracts the Group has entered into that are now unprofitable.

Accounting policies

A provision is recognised in the statement of financial position when the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation arising from past events, it is probable cash will be paid to settle it and the amount can be estimated reliably. Provisions are determined by discounting the expected future cash flows by a rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the liability. The unwinding of the discount is recognised as a financing cost in the income statement. The value of the provision is determined based on assumptions and estimates in relation to the amount and timing of actual cash flows which are dependent on future events.

Provisions

The movements in provisions during the year are as follows:


Contract

provisions

£m

Restruc-turing

provisions

£m

Property

provisions

£m

Other

provisions

£m

Total

£m

At 1 January 2013

10

4

8

15

37

Additions

-

1

-

-

1

Utilised

(3)

(4)

(4)

-

(11)

At 31 December 2013

7

1

4

15

27

 

Provisions of £19 million are classified as current liabilities (2012: £25 million). Unwind of the discount is nil in 2013 and 2012.

Contract provisions comprise onerous sports rights commitments that are expected to be utilised over the remaining contract period. Other contract provisions relate to onerous commitments on transmission infrastructure.

Property provisions principally relate to onerous lease contracts due to empty space created by the ongoing review and rationalisation of the Group's property portfolio. Utilisation of the provision will be over the anticipated life of the leases or earlier if exited.

Other provisions of £15 million primarily relate to potential liabilities that may arise as a result of Boxclever having been placed into administrative receivership, most of which relate to pension arrangements. In 2011 the Determinations Panel of The Pensions Regulator determined that Financial Support Directions ('FSDs') should be issued against certain companies within the Group in relation to the Boxclever pension scheme. The Group immediately referred this decision to the Upper Tribunal (thereby effectively appealing it). An FSD would require the Company to put in place financial support for the Boxclever scheme; however, it cannot be issued during the period of the reference. The reference process is ongoing and aside from procedural issues there were no substantive case developments in the period. The Directors have obtained leading counsel's opinion and extensive legal advice in connection with the proceedings and continue to believe that the provision held is appropriate.

3.7 Pensions

Keeping it simple . . .

Historically, the Group has offered its employees the opportunity to participate in a number of defined benefit schemes; these are now closed to new members. The ITV Pension Scheme (the Scheme) consists of three sections, A, B and C. Section A of the Scheme is considerably larger than the other sections. The Group is required to disclose the net of its defined benefit pension assets and liabilities in the statement of financial position. In the event of a net liability the Directors are obliged to determine how this deficit will be addressed.

The Group continues to offer employees defined contribution pension schemes and, where taken up, makes payments into this scheme on their behalf.

In this section we explain the accounting policies governing the Group's pension schemes, followed by analysis of the deficit on the defined benefit pension scheme and how this has been calculated. In addition, we have placed text boxes to explain some of the technical terms used in the disclosure.

Accounting policies

Defined contribution schemes

Obligations under the Group's defined contribution schemes are recognised as an operating cost in the income statement as incurred.

Defined benefit schemes

The Group's obligation in respect of defined benefit pension schemes are calculated separately for each scheme by estimating the amount of future benefit that employees have earned in return for their service in the current and prior periods. That benefit is discounted to determine its present value and the fair value of scheme assets is then deducted. The discount rate used is the yield at the valuation date on high quality corporate bonds, that exactly match the timing of the expected benefit payments over future years.

The Group takes advice from independent actuaries relating to the appropriateness of the assumptions which include life expectancy of members, expected salary and pension increases, and inflation. It is important to note that comparatively small changes in the assumptions used may have a significant effect on the income statement and statement of financial position.

The liabilities of the defined benefit schemes are measured by discounting the best estimate of future cash flows to be paid using the projected unit method. This method is an accrued benefits valuation method that makes allowance for projected earnings. These calculations are performed by a qualified actuary.

Actuarial gains and losses are recognised in full in the period in which they arise through the statement of comprehensive income.

An unfunded scheme in relation to previous Directors is accounted for under IAS 19. This is securitised by assets held outside of the ITV Pension scheme in the form of gilts and included within cash and cash equivalents.

The Group's pension schemes

Keeping it simple . . .

Under defined contribution schemes, the Group pays fixed contributions into a separate fund on behalf of the employee and has no further obligations to employees. The risks and rewards associated with this type of scheme are assumed by the members rather than the Group. It is the member's responsibility to make investment decisions relating to their retirement benefits.

In a defined benefit scheme, members receive cash payments at and in retirement, the value of which is dependent on factors such as salary and length of service. The Group underwrites investment, mortality and inflation risks necessary to meet these obligations. In the event of poor returns the Group needs to address this through a combination of increased levels of contribution or by making adjustments to the schemes. Schemes can be funded, where regular cash contributions are made by the employer into a fund which is invested, or unfunded, where no regular money or assets are required to be put aside to cover future payments.

The Group makes contributions to the ITV Pension Scheme, a separate trustee-administered fund that is not consolidated in these financial statements, but is reflected on the defined benefit pension deficit line on the statement of financial position. It is the responsibility of the Trustee to manage and invest the assets of the schemes and to monitor the schemes' funding position. The Trustee is required to act in the best interest of the members. The appointment of trustees is determined by the scheme's documentation.

In the unfunded scheme the Group is responsible for meeting pension obligations as they fall due.

The following section outlines the key elements of the Group's defined contribution and defined benefit schemes during the year and as at 31 December 2013.

Defined contribution schemes

Total contributions recognised as an expense in relation to defined contribution schemes during 2013 were £8 million (2012: £9 million). This is the default scheme for all new employees.

Defined benefit schemes

The Group's main scheme was formed from a merger of a number of schemes on 31 January 2006. The level of retirement benefit is principally based on pensionable salary at retirement. The Group's main scheme consists of three sections, A, B and C. The latest triennial valuations of sections A, B and C were undertaken as at 1 January 2011 by an independent actuary appointed by the Trustee of the ITV Pension Scheme and agreed in 2012. The next triennial valuation of sections A, B and C will be as at 1 January 2014, and is expected to be agreed in 2015. The Group will monitor funding levels annually.

The defined benefit pension deficit

The defined benefit pension deficit at 31 December 2013 was £445 million (2012: £551 million).

The assets and liabilities of the schemes are recognised in the consolidated statement of financial position and shown within non-current liabilities. The totals recognised in the current and previous years are:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Total defined benefit scheme obligations

(3,315)

(3,244)

Total defined benefit scheme assets

2,870

2,693

Net amount recognised within the consolidated statement of financial position

(445)

(551)

 

Addressing the deficit

The statutory funding objective is that a funded scheme has sufficient and appropriate assets to pay its benefits as they fall due. This is a long-term target. Future contributions will always be set at least at the level required to satisfy the statutory funding objective. The general principles adopted by the Trustee are that the assumptions used, taken as a whole, will be sufficiently prudent for pensions and benefits already in payment to continue to be paid, and to reflect the commitments which will arise from members' accrued pension rights.

The levels of ongoing contributions to the defined benefit schemes are based on the current service costs (as assessed by the scheme Trustee) and the expected future cash flows of the schemes. Normal employer contributions in 2014 for current service are expected to be in the region of £10 million (2013: £11 million) assuming current contribution rates continue as agreed with the Trustee. Based on the agreements currently in force, the following deficit funding payments are expected for forthcoming years.

In 2014 the Group expects to make deficit funding contributions of £89 million (£80 million was paid in 2013) comprised as follows:

·     deficit funding contribution to Section A of £40 million;

·     total annual deficit funding contributions to Sections B and C of £5.5 million;

·     £32 million, being 10% of the Group's EBITA before exceptional items that exceeds the £300 million threshold;

·     £11 million of annual deficit contributions as a result of the SDN pension partnership. Under the partnership arrangements, the Group has committed to making a payment to the main section of the Scheme of up to £200 million in 2022, if and to the extent that it remains in deficit at that time.

The remaining sections provide further detail of the value of scheme assets and liabilities, how these are accounted for and the impact on the income statement.

 

Total defined benefit scheme obligations

Keeping it simple . . .

The defined benefit obligation (the pension scheme liabilities) may change due to the following:

·     Current service cost - the cost to the Group of benefits arising in the future which are attibutable to the members' service in the current period. This is charged to operating costs in the income statement.

·     Past service cost - refers to the cost or credit as a result of changes in the benefits offered to members or a reduction in the number of employees covered by the scheme. This is recognised through operating costs in the income statement.

·     Settlement gains/(losses) - these occur when the Group enters into a transaction to eliminate all further legal or constructive obligations for some or all of the benefits provided by the schemes. Settlement gains or losses can arise from the transfer of member benefits into alternative pension arrangements, fully insuring benefits or on business disposals.

·     Increase due to interest cost - future pension obligations are stated in present value, in that a discount factor is used to state the current worth of a future cost. This interest cost is the unwinding of the discount on the present value of the obligation. Broadly, it is determined by multiplying the discount rate at the beginning of the period by the present value of the obligation during the period. This is recognised through net financing costs in the income statement.

·     Actuarial losses/(gains) - in order to value the Group's defined benefit obligation at the end of a period, it is necessary to apply certain assumptions in relation to demographic and financial trends. Where there is a difference between previous estimates and actual experience, or a change to assumptions, this will give rise to actuarial gains or losses, which are recognised through other comprehensive income

·     Benefits paid - any benefits paid out by the schemes will lower the obligations of those schemes.

 

The movement in the present value of the Group's defined benefit obligation is analysed below:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Defined benefit obligation at
1 January

3,244

3,036

Current service cost

8

7

Interest cost

133

140

Net actuarial loss

70

200

Benefits paid

(140)

(139)

Defined benefit obligation at
31 December

3,315

3,244

 

The present value of the defined benefit obligation is analysed between wholly unfunded and funded defined benefit schemes in the table below:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Defined benefit obligation in respect of funded schemes

3,271

3,203

Defined benefit obligation in respect of wholly unfunded schemes

44

41

Total defined benefit obligation

3,315

3,244

 

Keeping it simple . . .

Assumptions used to calculate the best estimate of future cash flows to be paid out by the schemes include: future salary levels, future pensionable salary levels, the estimate of increases in pension payments, the life expectancy of members, the effect of inflation on all these factors and ultimately the discount rate used to estimate the present day fair value of these obligations.

When deciding on these assumptions the Group takes independent actuarial advice relating to the appropriateness of the assumptions.

The principal assumptions used in the schemes' valuations at the year end were:

 

 

2013

2012

Discount rate for:



 Past service liabilities

4.45%

4.2%

 Future service liabilities

4.60%

4.2%

Inflation assumption for:



 Past service liabilities

3.35%

2.9%

 Future service liabilities

3.40%

2.9%

Rate of pensionable salary increases

0.9%

0.9%

Rate of increase in pension payment (LPI 5% pension increases)

3.25%

2.8%

Rate of increase to deferred
pensions (CPI)

2.35%

2.2%

 

IAS 19 requires that the discount rate is determined by reference to high quality fixed income investments in the UK that match the estimated term of the pension obligations. The basis of estimating the discount rate is by using the yields available on AA rated corporate bonds of a term similar to the liabilities, using the yield curve as the basis of estimation and differentiating between past service (the defined benefit obligation) and future service (the current service cost). Differentiating in this way represents a refinement in the basis of estimation applied in prior periods, where previously the discount rate was based on the term of the past service liabilities and there was no differentiation between past and future service. There is no impact of the refinement on the defined benefit obligation as at 31 December 2013, as this continues to be valued by reference to a single rate for past service liabilities. The use of a different discount rate and inflation rate for future service liabilities has no material impact on the 2014 income statement charge.

The inflation assumption has been set by looking at the difference between the yields on fixed and index-linked Government bonds, also differentiating between past and future service. The inflation assumption is used as a basis for the remaining financial assumptions, except where inflation caps have been implemented.Both the discount rate and the inflation assumption have been selected by considering yields taken from yield curves at terms, and weighted by cash flows, consistent with the pension obligations. The yield curves are constructed by our actuarial advisers from the yields available on relevant AA rated corporate bonds (for the discount rate) and fixed and index-linked Government bonds (for the inflation assumption).

 

In estimating the life expectancy of pension scheme members, the Group has used the SAPS Normal year of birth tables with CMI 2013 improvements, with a 1.25% p.a. long-term trend and a minus one year age rating (i.e. tables are adjusted so that a member is assumed to be one year younger than actual age). At the 2012 year end, PA92 year of birth tables with medium cohort improvements were used, with a 1% per annum underpin and a one year age rating. Using these tables the assumed life expectations on retirement are:


2013

2013

2012

2012

Retiring today at age

60

65

60

65

Males

27.8

23

26.8

21.9

Females

30.4

25.5

30.1

25.1

Retiring in 20 years at age

60

65

60

65

Males

29.8

24.8

28.8

23.7

Females

32.4

27.4

32.2

27.0

 

The tables above reflect published mortality investigation data in conjunction with the results of investigations into the mortality experience of scheme members. The Group estimates the average duration of its UK scheme's liabilities to be 15 years (2012: 15 years).

The sensitivities regarding the principal assumptions used to measure the defined benefit obligation are set out below:

Assumption

Change in assumption

Impact on scheme deficit

Discount rate

Increase by 0.5%

Decrease by £240 million


Decrease by 0.5%

Increase by £270 million

Rate of inflation (Retail Price Index)

Increase by 0.5%

Increase by £80 million


Decrease by 0.5%

Decrease by £60 million

Rate of inflation (Consumer Price Index)

Increase by 0.5%

Increase by £40 million


Decrease by 0.5%

Decrease by £30 million

Life expectations

Increase by 1 year

Increase by £80 million

 

The above sensitivity for life expectations excludes the longevity swap. It is estimated that a £50 million benefit would arise from a one year increase in the market based assumption of mortality.

The sensitivities above consider the impact of the single change shown, with the other assumptions assumed to be unchanged. The inflation sensitivities allow for the consequential impact on the relevant pension increase assumptions.The sensitivity analyses have been determined based on a method that extrapolates the impact on the defined benefit obligation as a result of reasonable changes in key assumptions occurring at the end of the reporting period.

In practice, changes in one assumption may be accompanied by offsetting changes in another assumption (although this is not always the case).

The Group's net pension deficit is the difference between the schemes' liabilities and the schemes' assets. Changes
in the assumptions may occur at the same time as changes in the market value of scheme assets.

These may or may not offset the change in assumptions. For example, a fall in interest rates will increase the schemes' liabilities, but may also trigger an offsetting increase in the market value of certain assets so there is no net effect on the Group's liability.

Total defined benefit scheme assets

Keeping it simple . . .

The Pension scheme holds assets across a number of different classes, these being equities, bonds and other investments. These assets are managed by the Trustee, although the Trustee is required to consult with the Group on changes to their investment policy. Financial instruments are in place which provide protection against changes in market factors (interest rates and inflation) which could act to increase the pension deficit.

In 2011 the scheme obtained protection against the effect of increases in the life expectation of the majority of pensioner members by transacting a longevity swap. Under the swap, the Trustees of the Scheme agreed to make
predetermined payments in return for payments to meet the specified pension obligations as they fall due, irrespective of how long the members and their dependants live.

The difference in the present values of these two streams of payments is reflected in scheme assets. In prior periods, the present value as at the year end was calculated using the same assumptions applied to the defined benefit obligation. However, the introduction of IFRS 13 in the year means that the Group must now value the swap under market-based assumptions, which represents a change from previous best estimates. This results in a nil valuation of the swap at inception, subsequently adjusted for changes in the market life expectancy and market discount rates.

Pension scheme assets are measured at their fair value and can change due to the following:

·     The investment income on scheme assets is determined based on the discount rate at the beginning of the year and calculated as the expected percentage return multiplied by the fair value of the scheme assets. This is recognised through net financing costs in the income statement.

·     Remeasurement gains and losses arise from differences between the actual and expected final asset values and are recognised through other comprehensive income.

·     A deduction from scheme assets is made for scheme administration expenses, which are recognised through operating costs in the income statement.

·     Employer's contributions and cash contributions by scheme participants are paid into the schemes to be managed
and invested.

·     Any benefits paid out by the schemes will reduce the value of the schemes' assets.

·     Movements in the value of the longevity swap. The value of the longevity swap is sensitive to changes in the discount rate or market life expectancy and movements are recognised as a remeasurement gain or loss in other comprehensive income.

 

The movement in the fair value of the defined benefit scheme's assets is analysed below:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Fair value of scheme assets at
1 January

2,693

2,646

Investment income on scheme assets

113

124

Return on assets

118

(13)

Employer contributions

91

82

Benefits paid

(140)

(139)

Administrative expenses paid

(5)

(7)

Fair value of scheme assets at
31 December

2,870

2,693

 

At 31 December 2013 the scheme's assets were invested in a diversified portfolio that consisted primarily of equity and debt securities. The fair value of the scheme's assets are shown below by major category:


Market value

2013

£m

Market value

2012

£m

Equity-type assets



UK                   Quoted

172

144

                         Unquoted

-

-

Overseas       Quoted

575

488

                         Unquoted

1

-

Government bonds



UK                   Fixed

410

437

                         Index-linked

980

934

Overseas       Quoted

20

25

                         Unquoted

1

-

Corporate bonds



UK                   Quoted

115

121

                         Unquoted

-

-

Overseas       Quoted

268

284

                         Unquoted

7

5

Other assets



Property

49

49

Infrastructure

65

48

Hedge funds/alternatives

165

150

Insurance policies

38

37

Cash and cash equivalents

27

89

Longevity swap fair value

(23)

(118)

Total scheme assets

2,870

2,693

 

The Trustee holds a longevity swap to remove the risk of increases in pension liabilities that would arise if a significant portion of the scheme's defined benefit pensioner population were to enjoy a longer life than currently expected. The recognition of the swap results in a reduction to the scheme's assets. The introduction of IFRS 13 as discussed below has resulted in a change in the approach and assumptions used to value the swap. As a result, the negative value of the swap has reduced by £95 million, with the associated gain being recognised as a remeasurement gain on assets in other comprehensive income within equity.

The scheme is invested in a range of asset classes and uses derivative financial contracts to improve the efficiency of the portfolio and to help manage risks.

The Trustee has a substantial holding of equity-type investments, mainly shares in listed and unlisted companies. The investment return related to these is variable, and they are generally considered 'riskier' investments. However, it is generally accepted that the yield on these investments will contain a premium to compensate investors for this additional risk. There is significant uncertainty about the likely size of this risk premium. In respect of overseas equity investments there is also a risk of unfavourable currency movements which the Trustee manages by hedging broadly 60% of the overseas investments against currency movements.

The Trustee also holds corporate bonds and other fixed interest securities. The risk of default on these is assessed by various rating agencies. Some of these bond investments are issued by the UK Government. The risk of default on these is lower compared to the risk of default on corporate bond investments, although some risk may remain. The expected yield on bond investments with fixed interest rates can be derived exactly from their market value.

The expected return for each asset class is weighted based on the target asset allocation for 2014 to develop the expected long-term rate of return on assets assumption for the portfolio. The benchmark for the main section of the scheme in 2014 is to hold broadly 47% liability-matching and 53% return-seeking assets. The majority of the equities held by the schemes are in international blue chip entities. The aim is to hold a globally diversified portfolio of equities, with a target of broadly 22% of equities being held in the UK and 78% of equities held overseas. Within the bond portfolio the aim is to hold 58% of the portfolio in government bonds (gilts) and 42% of the portfolio in corporate bonds and other fixed interest securities.

The actual return on the scheme's assets for the year ended 31 December 2013 was an increase of £231 million (2012: increase of £111 million).

The Trustee is responsible for deciding the investment strategy for the scheme's assets, although changes in investment policies require consultation with the Group. Varying returns from the different types of assets held by the scheme have resulted in Trustee investment decisions that have moved the asset allocation in the scheme's portfolio away from the target ratio of bonds and equities. A rebalancing of the portfolio only occurs if equity type assets exceed the target allocation by 3%, but is not necessary if equity asset types fall below the target allocation.

Amounts recognised through the income statement

Amounts recognised through the income statement in the various captions are as follows:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Amount charged to operating costs:



 Current service cost

(8)

(7)

 Scheme administration expenses

(5)

(7)


(13)

(14)

Amount charged to net financing costs:



Net interest on defined benefit scheme obligations

(20)

(16)




Total charged in the consolidated income statement

(33)

(30)

 

Amounts recognised through the consolidated statement of comprehensive income

The amounts recognised through the consolidated statement of comprehensive income/(cost) are:


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Remeasurement gains and (losses):



Return on scheme assets excluding interest income

118

(13)

Actuarial losses on liabilities arising from change in:



 - demographic assumptions

(66)

-

 - financial assumptions

(4)

(200)


(70)

(200)

Total recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income

48

(213)

 

The £70 million actuarial loss on the scheme's liabilities was principally due to the change to mortality assumptions.The £118 million remeasurement gain on scheme assets primarily results from the change in valuation method applied to the longevity swap, as discussed below.

Changes to accounting standards

A revised version of IAS 19 'Employee benefits' has been in force from 1 January 2013 and changes a number of disclosure requirements for post employment arrangements and restricts the options previously available on how to account for defined benefit pension plans. The Group adopted the revised standard from this date and has applied it restrospectively to the Group's 2012 results.

The most notable change resulting from IAS 19 (Revised) which impacts the Group is the requirement for the expected returns on pension plan assets, previously calculated based on management's estimate of expected returns, to be replaced by a credit on pension plan assets calculated at the liability discount rate. The retrospective application has resulted in an additional charge of £14 million in the consolidated income statement for 2012, of which £7 million has been charged to operating costs and £7 million is a reduction in interest income on assets, within net financing costs. The impact on basic and diluted EPS for 2012 was a reduction of 0.3p. This change has not impacted the Group's net assets.

IFRS 13 'Fair Value Measurements' was introduced and came into effect from 1 January 2013. The most significant impact on the Group is the requirement to value the longevity swap using IFRS 13 market-based assumptions, instead of the previous requirement to apply assumptions consistent with those used for the defined benefit obligation. Applying IFRS 13 to the swap valuation results in a swap value of nil at inception in August 2011, and a negative swap asset of £23 million as at 31 December 2013. The £95 million remeasurement gain arising in the period, primarily as a result of this change in valuation method, has been recognised as a return on scheme assets within other comprehensive income, and reduced the Group's defined benefit pension obligation by the same amount.

Section 4: Capital Structure and Financing Costs

In this section . . .

This section outlines how the Group manages its capital structure and related financing costs, including its balance sheet liquidity and access to capital markets.

The Directors determine the appropriate capital structure of ITV, specifically, how much is raised from shareholders (equity) and how much is borrowed from financial institutions (debt) in order to finance the Group's activities both now and in the future.

The Directors consider the Group's capital structure and dividend policy at least twice a year ahead of announcing results and do so in the context of its ability to continue as a going concern, to execute the strategy and to deliver its business plan. During the year the Group's credit rating improved, and the Board continued to focus on improving the efficiency of the balance sheet through the partial repurchase of the bilateral loan and the repurchase and redemption of the 2016 convertible bond.

In 2014 the Board will further review its policies on capital structure to support the strategy. Any potential courses of action will take into account the Group's liquidity needs, flexibility to invest in the business, pension deficit initiatives and impact on credit ratings.

 

4.1 Net cash

Keeping it simple . . .

Net cash is the Group's key measure used to evaluate total cash resources net of the current outstanding debt. In defining total outstanding debt the Directors consider it appropriate to include:

·     the currency impact of swaps held against those debt instruments;

·     equity components of debt instruments (principally the convertible bond which was settled in the year); and

·     the amortised cost adjustment which reflects the increase in coupon rates for specific bonds caused by the change in ITV's credit status to and from investment grade in between August 2008 and August 2013.

The table below analyses movements in the components of net cash during the year:


1 January

2013

£m

Net cash flow

and acquisitions

 £m

Currency and non-cash movements £m

31 December 2013

£m

 Cash

602

(164)

-

438

 Cash equivalents

88

(8)

-

80

Total cash and cash equivalents

690

(172)

-

518

Held to maturity investments

145

(145)

-

-

 Loans and loan notes due within one year

-

-

(41)

(41)

 Finance leases due within one year

(7)

7

(21)

(21)

 Loans and loan notes due after one year

(594)

200

93

(301)

 Finance leases due after one year

(38)

-

21

(17)

Total debt

(639)

207

52

(380)

 Currency component of swaps held against euro denominated bonds

25

-

1

26

 Convertible bond equity component

(22)

11

11

-

 Amortised cost adjustment

7

-

(7)

-

Net cash

206

(99)

57

164

 


1 January

2012

£m

Net cash flow

and acquisitions

£m

Currency and

non-cash

 movements

£m

31 December

 2012

£m

 Cash

705

(103)

-

602

 Cash equivalents

96

(8)

-

88

Total cash and cash equivalents

801

(111)

-

690

Held to maturity investments

147

-

(2)

145

 Loans and loan notes due within one year

-

-

-

-

 Finance leases due within one year

(9)

8

(6)

(7)

 Loans and loan notes due after one year

(868)

275

(1)

(594)

 Finance leases due after one year

(44)

-

6

(38)

Total debt

(921)

283

(1)

(639)

 Currency component of swaps held against euro denominated bonds

31

-

(6)

25

 Convertible bond equity component

(27)

-

5

(22)

 Amortised cost adjustment

14

-

(7)

7

Net cash

45

172

(11)

206

 

Cash and cash equivalents

Included within cash equivalents is £36 million (2012: £43 million), the use of which is restricted to meeting finance lease commitments under programme sale and leaseback commitments, and gilts of £36 million (2012: £37 million) over which the unfunded pension commitments have a charge (see note 3.7 for details).

Held to maturity investments

In March 2013 gilts with a nominal value of £138 million secured against the £200 million bilateral loan were utilised in part repayment of the loan (2012: the gilts had a carrying value of £145 million).

Loans and loan notes due within one year

During the year the 2014 Eurobond was reclassified to current borrowings. 

Loans and loan notes due after one year

In March 2013 £138 million of the £200 million covenant free loan with a maturity of March 2019 was repaid from cash and with the held to maturity gilts secured against the loan. All other terms, including the interest cost of 13.55%, remain unchanged. The repayment resulted in an upfront loss of £38 million, shown in net financing costs, and future interest savings of £48 million (2012: £75 million of the October 2015 bonds and £89 million of the January 2017 bonds were repurchased).

Currency components of swaps held against euro denominated bonds

As at 31 December 2013 the currency element of the cross currency interest rate swaps is a £26 million asset (2012: £25 million asset) effectively reducing the net amount repayable on the bond at maturity.

Convertible bond

In November 2009 ITV issued a £135 million convertible Eurobond with a maturity date of November 2016 and a coupon of 4%. As the bond contained an option for the issuer to convert a portion of the debt into ITV's equity (from November 2013), the components were treated as separate instruments. The accounting policy for this compound instrument is detailed in note 4.2 (i.e. partly debt and partly equity).

During 2013 the Group settled the entire convertible bond through a combination of repurchase and redemption, resulting in future interest cost savings of £16 million and share dilution of 95 million shares:

·     the Group repurchased £73 million nominal for a cash cost of £169 million, resulting in a loss of £13 million recognised in net financing costs and a loss attributable to the equity component of £83 million, which has been reflected in retained earnings;

·     the remaining nominal of £62 million was redeemed in exchange for 95 million new shares being issued. The Group recognised a loss of £10 million in net financing costs with respect to the redemption, and the residual equity element of £9 million was released to retained earnings.

The impact of the redemption on the Group's equity is detailed in note 4.7.

Amortised cost adjustment

The purpose of the amortised cost adjustment is to exclude the impact of the coupon step-up on net debt. When ITV's Standard & Poor's credit rating was lowered to BB+ in August 2008 a coupon step-up (an increased interest cost) in the 2014 and 2017 bonds was triggered. Consequently the debt carrying values had to be revalued under IFRS, resulting in a non-cash increase in net debt and associated loss in net financing costs of £30 million as at 31 December 2008. Since then the accounting treatment has been unwinding this through an annual interest expense, which is excluded from adjusted net financing costs.

In August 2013, the Group's investment grade status was fully restored, resulting in a reversing of the previous coupon step up for the 2017 bond. This 'step down' triggered another revaluation of the amortised cost of the debt under IFRS, leading to a gain of £5 million which has been recognised within interest expense on financial liabilities in net financing costs, on a basis consistent with the unwind described above.

At year end, the amortised cost adjustment remaining is nil (2012: £7 million).

4.2 Borrowings and held to maturity investments

Keeping it simple . . .

The Group borrows money from financial institutions and debt investors in the form of bonds and other financial instruments. The Group's bonds generally have fixed interest rates and are for a fixed term.

The interest payable and receivable on these instruments is shown in the net financing costs note
in note 4.4.

Accounting policies

Borrowings

Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value less directly attributable transaction costs, with subsequent measurement at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. Under the amortised cost method the difference between the amount initially recognised and the redemption value is recorded in the income statement over the period of the borrowing on an effective interest basis. Borrowings are referred to in this section using their redemption value when describing the terms and conditions.

The mechanism used to determine variable interest rates on a loan is analysed when the loan is initially taken out to determine if it is closely related to the loan. If the variable rate mechanism is closely related to the loan it is not valued separately but cash flow estimates are included in the effective interest rate on the loan. This assessment is not revisited unless the terms of the loan are changed significantly.

Compound financial instruments

Compound financial instruments are instruments that are classified as partly debt and partly equity due to the terms of the instrument.

The Group had one compound financial instrument, the 2016 convertible bond, that was redeemed in the year as described in note 4.1.

The liability component of a compound financial instrument is recognised initially at the fair value of a normal bond that does not have an equity conversion option. The equity component is recognised initially at the difference between the fair value of the compound financial instrument as a whole and the fair value of the liability component. Any directly attributable transaction costs are allocated to the liability and equity components in proportion to their initial carrying amounts.

Subsequent to initial recognition, the liability component of a compound financial instrument is measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. The equity component of a compound financial instrument is not remeasured subsequent to initial recognition but is transferred to retained earnings over the term of the instrument on an effective interest rate basis.

Held to maturity assets

Where the Group has the positive intent and ability to hold financial assets to maturity, they are classified as held to maturity. Held to maturity financial assets are recognised initially at fair value including any directly attributable transaction costs. Subsequent to initial recognition, held to maturity financial assets are measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method, less any impairment.

Borrowings and held to maturity investments

The table below analyses the Group's borrowings by when they fall due for payment and excludes the favourable impact of the cross-currency interest rate swaps:


Loans and loan notes

£m

Finance leases

£m

2013

£m

Current




In 1 year or less, or on demand

41

21

62

Non-current




In more than 1 year but not more than 2 years

78

7

85

In more than 2 years but not more than 5 years

161

10

171

In more than 5 years

62

-

62


301

17

318

Total

342

38

380

 


Loans and

 loan notes

£m

Finance leases

£m

2012

£m

Current




In 1 year or less, or on demand

-

7

7

Non-current




In more than 1 year but not more than 2 years

39

23

62

In more than 2 years but not more than 5 years

355

15

370

In more than 5 years

200

-

200


594

38

632

Total

594

45

639

 

Loans and loan notes repayable within one year

The Group has one loan repayable in 2014. The unsecured £41 million (€50 million) Eurobond has a coupon of 10.0% and matures in June. The Group expects to pay £15 million at maturity, net of cross-currency interest rate swaps.

Loans and loan notes repayable between one and two years

The unsecured £78 million Eurobond has a coupon of 5.375% and matures in October 2015.

Loans and loan notes repayable between two and five years

The Group has one loan that is repayable between two and five years as at 31 December 2013. The unsecured £161 million Eurobond matures in January 2017 and has a coupon of 7.375%, which decreases to 6.125% from January 2014 following the coupon step down discussed in note 4.1.

Loans and loan notes repayable after five years

The £62 million (previously £200 million) covenant free loan raised in February 2009 and partially repaid in 2013 (see note 4.1) matures in March 2019 and charges interest of 13.55%. In January 2014 the remaining nominal was repurchased. See note 5.3 for details.

Fair value versus book value

The tables below provide fair value information for the Group's borrowings and held to maturity investments:

Assets

Maturity

Book value

Fair value

2013

£m

2012

£m

2013

£m

2012

£m

Held to maturity investments

Mar 2019

-

145

-

166

 

The fair value of held to maturity investments is based on quoted market bid prices at the year end.

Liabilities

Maturity

Book value

Fair value

2013

£m

2012

£m

2013

£m

2012

£m

€50 million Eurobond 

June 2014

41

39

43

48

£78 million Eurobond

Oct 2015

78

78

83

84

£135 million Convertible bond

Nov 2016

-

110

-

223

£161 million Eurobond 

Jan 2017

161

167

179

178

£62 million loan (previously £200 million loan)

Mar 2019

62

200

95

309



342

594

400

842

 

Fair value, which is determined for disclosure purposes, is calculated based on the present value of future principal and interest cash flows, discounted at the market rate of interest at the reporting date. This calculation of fair value is consistent with assets and liabilities valued under level 2 of the fair value hierarchy detailed in note 4.6.

Movements in book values of the 2016 and 2019 bonds are the result of redemption and buybacks in the period.

Finance leases

The following table analyses when finance lease liabilities are due for payment:


Minimum lease

payments

£m

Interest

£m

2013

 

Principal

£m

Minimum lease

payments

£m

Interest

£m

2012

 

Principal

£m

In 1 year or less

22

1

21

9

2

7

In more than 1 year but not more than 5 years

18

1

17

39

1

38

In more than 5 years

-

-

-

-

-

-


40

2

38

48

3

45

 

Finance leases principally comprise programmes under sale and leaseback arrangements. The net book value of tangible assets held under finance leases at 31 December 2013 was £1 million (2012: £2 million).

 

4.3 Derivative financial instruments

Keeping it simple . . .

A derivative is a type of financial instrument typically used to manage risk. A derivative's value changes over time in response to underlying variables such as exchange rates or interest rates and is entered into for a fixed period. A hedge is where a derivative is used to manage an underlying exposure.

The Group is exposed to changes in interest rates on its net borrowings and to changes in foreign exchange rates on its foreign currency transactions and net assets. In accordance with Board approved policies, which are included in note 4.5, the Group uses derivatives to hedge these underlying exposures.

Derivative financial instruments are initially included in the balance sheet at their fair value, either as assets or liabilities, and are subsequently remeasured at fair value or 'marked to market' at each reporting date. Movements in instruments measured at fair value are recorded in the income statement in net financing costs.

An interest rate swap is an instrument to exchange a fixed rate of interest for a floating rate, or vice versa, or one type of floating rate for another. A cross-currency interest rate swap exchanges a fixed or floating interest rate in one currency for a floating or fixed interest rate in another currency.

Analysis of the derivatives used by the Group to hedge its exposure and the various methods used to calculate their respective fair values are detailed in this section.

Accounting policies

The Group uses a limited number of derivative financial instruments to hedge its exposure to fluctuations in interest and foreign exchange rates. The Group does not hold or issue derivative instruments for speculative purposes. Hedge accounting as defined under IFRS has not been adopted by the Group for the derivatives held.

Derivative financial instruments are initially recognised at fair value and are subsequently remeasured at fair value with the movement recorded in the income statement within net financing costs. Derivatives with positive fair values are recorded as assets and negative fair values as liabilities.

The fair value of forward foreign exchange contracts is determined by using the difference between the contract exchange rate and the quoted forward exchange rate at the reporting date. The fair value of interest rate swaps is the estimated amount that the Group would receive or pay to terminate the swap at the reporting date, taking into account current interest rates and the current creditworthiness of swap counterparties.

Third party valuations are used to fair value the Group's derivatives. The valuation techniques use inputs such as interest rate yield curves and currency prices/yields, volatilities of underlying instruments and correlations between inputs.

For financial assets and liabilities classified at fair value through profit or loss, the movements in the year relating to changes in fair value and interest are not separated.

Derivative financial instruments

The following table shows the fair value of derivative financial instruments analysed by type of contract. Interest rate swap fair values exclude accrued interest.


Assets

£m

2013

Liabilities

£m

Current



Interest rate swaps - fair value through profit or loss

32

(6)

Non-current



Interest rate swaps - fair value through profit or loss

41

(27)


73

(33)

 


Assets

£m

2012

Liabilities

£m

Current



Interest rate swaps - fair value through profit or loss

-

(1)

Non-current



Interest rate swaps - fair value through profit or loss

99

(48)


99

(49)

 

When the Group's 2014, 2015 and 2017 Eurobonds were issued, the Group used a portfolio of interest rate swaps and cross-currency interest rate swaps to convert a portion of the fixed rate coupons into floating rates. The Group subsequently layered on additional swaps to take these floating rates back into fixed rates. Consequently, the Group is now 100% fixed on its gross borrowings. The return to fixed rate locked in an interest benefit for the Group, since the fixed rate receivable on the original swap portfolio is higher than the fixed rate payable on the swaps subsequently layered on, resulting in a net mark-to-market gain on the portfolio. On the 2014 €50m Eurobond, this also locked in a foreign exchange benefit for the Group, whereby the net effect of the related swap portfolio at maturity is to receive €50 million (to settle the bond maturity) and to pay £15 million.

Given the bond repurchases in recent periods, the remaining principal outstanding on the 2015 and 2017 Eurobonds is now less than the notional amounts on the related swaps. However, the notional amounts on all of the swaps in the portfolio match, so that there is no remaining floating interest rate exposure and the Group remains 100% fixed rate on its debt portfolio.

4.4 Net financing costs

Keeping it simple . . .

This section details the interest income generated on the Group's cash and other financial assets and the interest expense incurred on borrowings and other financial assets and liabilities. The presentation of these net financing costs in this note reflects income and expenses according to the classification of the financial instruments.

In reporting 'adjusted profit', the Group adjusts net financing costs to exclude mark-to-market movements on interest rate and foreign exchange derivatives, gains/losses on bond buybacks, imputed pension interest, interest and fair value movements in acquisition-related liabilities and other financing costs.

Mark-to-market movements reflect the change in value of our derivative instruments between the later of inception or 1 January 2013, and 31 December 2013. The value at year end is not necessarily the same as the value at which they will be settled at maturity.

Accounting policies

Net financing costs comprise interest income on funds invested, gains/losses on the disposal of financial instruments, changes in the fair value of financial instruments, interest expense on borrowings and finance leases, unwinding of the discount on provisions and liabilities to non-controlling interest, foreign exchange gains/losses, and imputed interest on pension assets and liabilities. Interest income and expense is recognised as it accrues in profit or loss, using the effective interest method.

Net financing costs

Net financing costs can be analysed as follows:

 

 

2013

 

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

Financing income:



 Interest income

7

16

Change in fair value of instruments classified at fair value through profit or loss

3

-

 Foreign exchange gain

-

4


10

20

Financing costs:



Change in fair value of instruments classified at fair value through profit or loss

-

(5)

Interest expense on financial liabilities measured at amortised cost

(29)

(60)

Net interest on defined benefit pension scheme obligations

(20)

(16)

 Losses on early settlement

(61)

(36)

 Foreign exchange loss

(1)

-

 Other interest expense

(14)

(9)


(125)

(126)

Net financing costs

(115)

(106)

 

Gains relating to changes in fair value of instruments of £3 million (2012: losses of £5 million) relate principally to the unwinding of the interest rate swaps as they near maturity.

As detailed in note 4.1, losses on early settlement of £61 million (2012: £36 million) were incurred as a result of the debt settlements during the year. The partial repurchase of the £62 million 2019 bilateral loan resulted in a loss of £38 million, while the repurchase and redemption of the convertible bond resulted in a loss of £23 million.

Other interest expense includes the interest element of
the acquisition related contingent liabilities as detailed in note 3.4.

The Group has restated 2012 net interest on defined benefit pension scheme obligations by £7 million in accordance with revisions to IAS 19. Details of the impact on 2012 are discussed in note 3.7.

4.5 Financial risk factors

Keeping it simple . . .

The Group's activities expose it to a variety of financial risks: market risks (including currency risk, interest rate risk and price risk), credit risk and liquidity risk. The Group's overall risk management programme focuses on the unpredictability of financial markets and seeks to minimise potential adverse effects on the Group's financial performance. The Group uses derivative financial instruments within its policies described below as hedges to manage certain risk exposures.

Treasury policies have been approved by the Board for managing each of these risks including levels of authority on the type and use of financial instruments. Transactions are only undertaken if they relate to underlying exposures, i.e. the Group does not use derivatives to speculate. The treasury function reports regularly to the Audit Committee and treasury operations are subject to periodic reviews.

Market risk

Currency risk

The Group operates internationally and is therefore exposed to currency risk arising from movements in foreign exchange rates, primarily with respect to the US dollar and the euro. Foreign exchange risk arises from: differences in the dates foreign currency commercial transactions are entered into and the date they are settled; recognised monetary assets and liabilities held in a non-functional currency; and net investments in foreign operations.

The Group's foreign exchange policy is to hedge material foreign currency denominated costs at the time of commitment and to hedge a proportion of foreign currency denominated revenues on a rolling 12-month basis using either a natural hedge where one exists, or through forward foreign exchange contracts taken out for up to two years. The Group also utilises foreign exchange swaps to manage foreign currency cash flow timing differences.

The Group ensures that its net exposure to foreign currency denominated cash balances is kept to an acceptable level by buying or selling foreign currencies at spot rates when necessary to address short-term imbalances.

The euro denominated interest and principal payments under the €50 million bond have been fully hedged by cross currency interest rate swaps.

The Group's investments in overseas subsidiaries are not hedged as those currency positions are considered to be long-term in nature.

At 31 December 2013, if sterling had weakened/strengthened by 10% against the US dollar with all other variables held constant, post-tax profit for the year would have been £8 million (2012: £6 million) higher/lower. Equity would have been £17 million (2012: £13 million) higher/lower.

At 31 December 2013, if sterling had weakened/strengthened by 10% against the euro with all other variables held constant, post-tax profit for the year would have been £7 million (2012: £8million) higher/lower. Equity would have been £15 million (2012: £2 million) higher/lower.

Interest rate risk

Interest rate risk is the risk that the Group is impacted by significant changes in interest rates. Borrowings issued at or swapped to floating rates expose the Group to interest rate risk.

The Group's interest rate policy was changed in 2011 to having 100% of its borrowings at fixed rates in order to lock in low interest rates. This policy has been maintained throughout 2012 and 2013. The Group utilises fixed and floating rate interest swaps and options in order to achieve the desired policy mix, as illustrated in note 4.3.

All of the Group's interest rate swaps are classified as fair value through profit or loss so any movement in the fair value goes through the income statement rather than equity.

At 31 December 2013, if interest rates had increased/decreased by 0.1%, post-tax profit for the year would have been unchanged (2012: unchanged).

Price risk

Price risk is the risk that the Group's financial instruments change in value due to movements in market prices. This excludes movements in interest rate or foreign exchange. The Group is not exposed to any material price risk.

Credit risk

Credit risk is the risk of financial loss to the Group if a customer or counterparty to a financial instrument fails to meet its contractual obligations. It arises principally from the Group's receivables from customers, cash, held to maturity investments and on in-the-money derivatives. There is also credit risk relating to the Group's own credit rating as this impacts the availability and cost of future finance.

Trade and other receivables

The Group's exposure to credit risk is influenced mainly by the individual characteristics of each customer. The majority of trade receivables relate to airtime sales contracts with advertising agencies and advertisers. Credit insurance has been taken out against these companies to minimise the impact on the Group in the event of a possible default.

Cash and held to maturity investments

The Group operates investment guidelines with respect to surplus cash that emphasises preservation of capital. The guidelines set out procedures and limits on counterparty risk and maturity profile of cash placed. Counterparty limits for cash deposits are largely based upon long-term ratings published by the major credit rating agencies and perceived state support. Deposits longer than 12 months require the approval of the Audit Committee.

Borrowings

ITV's credit ratings improved in 2013 with all three ratings agencies upgrading their long-term credit ratings. In March and April respectively, Standard & Poor's and Fitch upgraded the Group's long-term credit rating to investment grade BBB- (2012: BB+). In August Moody's Investor Service upgraded their long-term credit rating to Baa3 (2012: Ba1). ITV's credit ratings, the cost of credit default swap hedging and the absolute level of interest rates are key determinants in the cost of new borrowings for ITV. The cost of existing borrowing remains subject to the terms of the instrument.

Liquidity risk

Liquidity risk is the risk that the Group will not be able to meet its financial obligations as they fall due. The Group's financing policy is to fund itself for the long term by using debt instruments with a range of maturities and to ensure access to short-term appropriate facilities. It is substantially funded from the UK and European capital markets, supplemented with bank facilities (see below). Management monitors rolling forecasts of the Group's liquidity reserve (comprising undrawn bank facilities and cash and cash equivalents) on the basis of expected cash flows. This monitoring includes financial ratios to assess possible future credit ratings and headroom and takes into account the accessibility of cash and cash equivalents.

At 31 December 2013 the Group has available two undrawn committed facilities worth a total of £375 million (2012: £375 million). The first is a £125 million invoice discounting facility, maturing in September 2015, which is secured on advertising receivables and which has no financial covenants. The second is a £250 million Revolving Credit Facility ('RCF') which is provided by a small group of relationship banks and which matures in July 2016, following an election made in July 2013 to extend the maturity by one year. The RCF, which is unsecured, can be extended by a further year subject to agreement by the banks. The facility has leverage and interest cover financial covenants normal for such a facility.

Keeping it simple . . .

The table below analyses the Group's financial liabilities including derivatives into relevant maturity groupings based on the period remaining until the contractual maturity date. The amounts disclosed in the table are the contractual undiscounted cash flows (including interest), so will not always reconcile with the amounts disclosed on the statement of financial position:

 

At 31 December 2013

Total

contractual

cash flows

£m

Less than

1 year

£m

Between

1 and 2 years

£m

Between

2 and 5 years

£m

Over

5 years

£m

Non-derivative financial liabilities






Borrowings

(483)

(92)

(108)

(216)

(67)

Trade and other payables

(744)

(702)

(31)

(10)

(1)

Other payables - non-current

(97)

-

(4)

(75)

(18)

Derivative financial instruments






Interest rate swaps

55

37

9

9

-


(1,269)

(757)

(134)

(292)

(86)

 

 

At 31 December 2012

Total

contractual

cash flows

£m

Less than

1 year

£m

Between

1 and 2 years

£m

Between

2 and 5 years

£m

Over

5 years

£m

Non-derivative financial liabilities






Borrowings

(909)

(57)

(112)

(507)

(233)

Held to maturity investments

178

6

6

19

147

Trade and other payables

(623)

(593)

(20)

(9)

(1)

Other payables - non-current

(22)

-

-

(8)

(14)

Derivative financial instruments






Interest rate swaps

62

7

37

18

-


(1,314)

(637)

(89)

(487)

(101)

 

In 2012 held to maturity investments were included within the table above as the £138 million March 2019 gilts were used as security against the £62 million 2019 loan (previously £200 million loan).

4.6 Fair value hierarchy

Keeping it simple . . .

The financial instruments included on the ITV statement of financial position are measured at either fair value or amortised cost. The measurement of this fair value can in some cases be subjective, and can depend on the inputs used in the calculations. ITV generally uses external valuations using market inputs or market values (e.g. external share prices) and does not calculate its own fair values. The different valuation methods are called 'hierarchies' and are described below.

The tables below set out the financial instruments included on the ITV statement of financial position at 'fair value'.


Fair value

31 December

2013

£m

Level 1

31 December

2013

£m

Level 2

31 December

2013

£m

Level 3

31 December

2013

£m

Assets measured at fair value





Available for sale financial instruments





 Available for sale gilts

36

36

-

-

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss





 Interest rate swaps

73

-

73

-


109

36

73

-

 


Fair Value

31 December

2013

£m

Level 1

31 December

2013

£m

Level 2

31 December

2013

£m

Level 3

31 December

2013

£m

Liabilities measured at fair value





Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss





 Interest rate swaps

(33)

-

(33)

-

Contingent consideration

(7)

-

-

(7)


(40)

-

(33)

(7)

 


Fair value

31 December

2012

£m

Level 1

31 December

2012

£m

Level 2

31 December

2012

£m

Level 3

31 December

2012

£m

Assets measured at fair value





Available for sale financial instruments





 STV shares (disposal detailed in note 2.2)

3

3

-

-

 Available for sale gilts

37

37

-

-

Financial assets at fair value through profit or loss





 Interest rate swaps

99

-

99

-


139

40

99

-

 


Fair value

31 December

2012

£m

Level 1

31 December

2012

£m

Level 2

31 December

2012

£m

Level 3

31 December

2012

£m

Liabilities measured at fair value





Financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss





 Interest rate swaps

(49)

-

(49)

-

Contingent consideration

(1)

-

-

(1)


(50)

-

(49)

(1)

 

Level 1

Fair values measured using quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

Level 2

Fair values measured using inputs, other than quoted prices included within Level 1, that are observable for the asset or liability either directly or indirectly.

Interest rate swaps and options are accounted for at their fair value based upon termination prices. Forward foreign exchange contracts are accounted for at the difference between the contract exchange rate and the quoted forward exchange rate at the reporting date.

Level 3

Fair values measured using inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data.

Contingent consideration is the Group's only financial instrument classified as level 3 in the fair value hierarchy. As noted in the accounting policy section of note 3.3, the key assumptions taken into consideration when measuring this acquisition related liability are the performance expectations of the acquisition and a discount rate that reflects the size and nature of the new business. There is no reasonable change in discount rate or performance targets that would give rise to a material change in the liability at year end.

The acquisitions in the period gave rise to an additional £6 million of contingent consideration (see note 3.4 for details). The unwind of interest and fair value movement in the liability was immaterial in the period (2012: nil), which is recognised in other interest expense in net financing costs.

4.7 Equity

Keeping it simple . . .

This section explains material movements recorded in shareholders' equity that are not explained elsewhere in the financial statements. The movements in equity and the balance at 31 December 2013 are presented in the consolidated statement of changes in equity.

The Group utilises share award schemes as part of its employee remuneration packages. The various ITV share-based compensation schemes are explained in this section as they are accounted for through retained earnings.

Accounting policies

Available for sale reserve

Available for sale assets are stated at fair value, with any gain or loss recognised directly in the available for sale reserve in equity, unless the loss is a permanent impairment, when it is then recorded in the income statement.

Dividends

Dividends are recognised through equity on the earlier of their approval by the Company's shareholders or their payment.

Share-based compensation

The Group operates a number of share-based compensation schemes. The fair value of the equity instrument granted is measured at grant date and spread over the vesting period via a charge to the income statement with a corresponding increase in equity.

The fair value of the share options and awards is measured using either market price at grant date or a Black-Scholes model, as appropriate, taking into account the terms and conditions of the individual scheme. For performance-based schemes, the relevant Group performance measures are projected to the end of the performance period in order to determine the number of options expected to vest. Based on this number, and the option fair values, their present value is determined.

The valuation of these share-based payments also requires estimates to be made in respect of the number of options that are expected to be exercised.

Vesting conditions are limited to service conditions and performance conditions. Conditions other than service or performance conditions are considered non-vesting conditions. Non-market vesting conditions are included in assumptions about the number of options that are expected to vest. At each reporting date, the Group revises its estimates of the number of options that are expected to vest. It recognises the impact of the revision to original estimates, if any, in the income statement, with a corresponding adjustment to equity.

4.7.1 Share capital and share premium

The Group's share capital at 31 December 2013 of £403 million (2012: £391 million) and share premium of £174 million (2012: £122 million) is the same as that of ITV plc. Details of this are given in the ITV plc Company financial statements section of this annual report.

4.7.2 Merger and other reserves

Merger and other reserves at 31 December 2013 include the following reserves:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Merger reserves arising on historic mergers

119

119

Capital reserves

112

112

Capital redemption reserves

36

36

Revaluation reserves

6

6

Equity element of the 2016 convertible bond

-

22

Put option liabilities arising on acquisition of new subsidiaries

(25)

(12)

Total

248

283

 

The equity element of the 2016 convertible bond was reduced to nil in the year following redemption of the bond, as detailed in note 4.1.

The £13 million increase in liabilities on the options for the acquisition of new subsidiaries relates to the non-controlling interests of High Noon Entertainment and Thinkfactory Media, as detailed in note 3.4.

4.7.3 Translation reserve

The translation reserve comprises all foreign exchange differences arising on the translation of the accounts of, and investments in, foreign operations.

4.7.4 Available for sale reserve

The available for sale reserve comprises all movements arising on the revaluation and disposal of assets accounted for as available for sale.

4.7.5 Retained earnings

The retained earnings reserve comprises profit for the year attributable to owners of the Company of £326 million (2012: £256 million) and other items recognised directly through equity as presented on the consolidated statement of changes in equity.

The Directors of ITV plc propose a final dividend of 2.4p per share and a special dividend of 4.0p per share.

4.7.6 Non-controlling interests

In 2013 £4 million (2012: £1 million) of profit was attributable to non-controlling interests.

4.7.7 Share-based compensation

A transaction will be classed as share-based compensation where the Group receives services from employees and pays for these in shares or similar equity instruments. If the Group incurs a liability whose amount is based on the price or value of the Group's shares then this will also fall under a share-based transaction.

The Group operates a number of share-based compensation schemes. A description of each type of share-based payment arrangement that existed at any time during the period, including the general terms and conditions of each arrangement, such as vesting requirements, the maximum term of options granted, and the method of settlement
(e.g. whether in cash or equity) are set out in the Remuneration Report.

Exercises of share options granted to employees can be satisfied by market purchase or issue of new shares. No new shares may be issued to satisfy exercises under the terms of the Deferred Share Award Plan. During the year all exercises were satisfied either by using shares purchased in the market and held in the ITV Employees' Benefit Trust or by issuing new shares.

Share-based compensation charges totalled £14 million in 2013 (2012: £9 million).

The table below summarises the movements in the number of share options outstanding for the Group and their weighted average exercise price:


Number

of options

('000)

2013
Weighted

average

exercise price

(pence)

Number

of options

('000)

2012
Weighted

average

exercise price

(pence)

Outstanding at 1 January

68,387

11.06

81,479

12.74

Granted during the year - nil priced

12,726

-

19,184

-

Granted during the year - other

13,371

126.97

6,218

66.79

Forfeited during the year

(4,900)

7.69

(16,948)

3.80

Exercised during the year

(21,385)

5.97

(18,052)

14.52

Expired during the year

(523)

51.51

(3,494)

106.17

Outstanding at 31 December

67,676

14.52

68,387

11.06

Exercisable at 31 December

846

-

6,407

2.30

 

For those options exercised in the year, the average share price during 2013 was 150.44 pence (2012: 84.03 pence).

Of the options still outstanding, the range of exercise prices and weighted average remaining contractual life of these options can be analysed as follows:

Range of exercise prices (pence)

Weighted

average

exercise price

(pence)

Number

of options

('000)

2013

Weighted

average

remaining

contractual

life

(years)

Weighted

average

exercise price

(pence)

Number

of options

('000)

2012

Weighted

average

remaining

contractual

life

(years)

Nil

-

44,439

1.88

-

54,618

1.97

20.00 - 49.99

31.09

2,960

1.29

35.00

5,324

1.68

50.00 - 69.99

67.38

5,399

2.11

65.76

6,598

2.87

70.00 - 99.99

73.58

1,639

1.31

73.69

1,847

2.27

100.00 - 109.99

102.59

1,899

3.16

-

-

-

110.00 - 119.99

-

-

-

-

-

-

120.00 - 149.99

131.44

11,339

3.20

-

-

-

 

Share schemes

Further details of the ITV share plans and awards can be found in the Remuneration Report.

The Black-Scholes model is used to value the SAYE Schemes as these do not have any market performance conditions. The ITV SAYE scheme is an Inland Revenue Approved SAYE scheme.

Assumptions made relating to grants of share options during 2013 and 2012 are as follows:

Scheme name

Date of grant

Share price

at grant

(pence)

Exercise price

(pence)

Expected

volatility

%

Expected life

(years)

Gross dividend

yield

%

Risk-free rate

%

Fair value

(pence)

Save As You Earn









ITV - three year

04 Apr 2012

85.25

68.81

43.00%

3.25

2.82%

0.65%

17.97

ITV - five year

04 Apr 2012

85.25

68.81

50.00%

5.25

2.82%

1.18%

22.36

ITV - three year

13 Sept 2012

86.70

66.60

38.00%

3.25

2.82%

0.38%

17.46

ITV - five year

13 Sept 2012

86.70

66.60

50.00%

5.25

2.82%

0.81%

23.32

ITV - three year

05 Apr 2013

121.00

102.59

36.00%

3.25

2.73%

1.04%

32.83

ITV - five year

05 Apr 2013

121.00

102.59

49.00%

5.25

2.73%

1.80%

48.43

ITV - three year

13 Sept 2013

183.40

131.44

34.00%

3.25

2.73%

0.31%

63.33

ITV - five year

13 Sept 2013

183.40

131.44

47.00%

5.25

2.73%

0.72%

85.08

Performance Share Plan









ITV - three year

01 Mar 2012

88.00

-

*

3.00

*

*

88.00

ITV - three year

10 Sept 2012

88.70

-

*

3.00

*

*

88.70

ITV - three year

01 Mar 2013

123.40

-

*

3.00

*

*

123.40

ITV - three year

28 Mar 2013

129.40

-

*

3.00

*

*

129.40

 

* Awards do not include market based performance conditions; therefore, Black-Scholes model not required to calculate fair value.

The expected volatility for awards made under the SAYE scheme reflects the historic volatility of ITV plc's share price and equity markets as a whole over the preceding three or five years, and, depending on the expected life of the award, prior to the grant date of the share options awarded.

Employees' Benefit Trust

The Group has investments in its own shares as a result of shares purchased by the ITV Employees' Benefit Trust ('EBT'). Transactions with the Group-sponsored EBT are included in these financial statements. In particular, the EBT's purchases of shares in ITV plc are debited directly to equity.

The table below shows the number of ITV plc shares held in the trust at 31 December 2013 and the purchases/(releases) from the EBT made in the year to satisfy awards under the Group's share schemes.

Scheme:

Shares held at:

Number of shares

(released)/

purchased

Nominal value

£


1 January 2013

14,849,415

1,484,942

ITV Deferred Share Award Plan


(529,004)


ITV Performance Share Plan


(18,322,427)


ITV SAYE Scheme


(2,555,209)


Subscription for new issue shares


19,500,000


Shares purchased


8,834,678



31 December 2013

21,777,453

2,177,745

 

The total number of shares held by the EBT at 31 December 2013 represents 0.54% (2012: 0.38%) of ITV's issued share capital. The market value of own shares held at 31 December 2013 is £42 million (2012: £16 million).

The shares will be held in the EBT until such time as they may be transferred to participants of the various Group share schemes. Rights to dividends have been waived by the EBT in respect of shares held which do not relate to restricted shares under the Deferred Share Award Plan. In accordance with the Trust Deed, the Trustees of the EBT have the power to exercise all voting rights in relation to any investment (including shares) held within that trust.

Section 5: Other Notes

5.1 Related party transactions

Keeping it simple . . .

The related parties identified by the Directors include joint ventures, associated undertakings, investments
and key management personnel.

To enable users of our financial statements to form a view about the effects of related party relationships on the Group, we disclose the related party relationship when control exists, irrespective of whether there have been transactions between the related parties.

Related party transactions

Transactions with joint ventures and associated undertakings

Transactions with joint ventures and associated undertakings during the year were:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Sales to joint ventures

10

11

Sales to associated undertakings

11

9

Purchases from joint ventures

27

24

Purchases from associated undertakings

57

52

 

The transactions with joint ventures primarily relate to sales and purchases of digital multiplex services with Digital 3&4 Limited.

Purchases from associated undertakings primarily relate to the purchase of news services from ITN.

All transactions with associated undertakings and joint ventures arise in the normal course of business on an arm's length basis. None of the balances are secured.

The amounts owed by and to these related parties at the year end were:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Amounts owed by joint ventures

-

1

Amounts owed by associated undertakings

4

6

Amounts owed by pension scheme

2

2

Amounts owed to associated undertakings

-

2

 

Amounts paid to the Group's retirement benefit plans are set out in note 3.7.

Transactions with key management personnel

Key management consists of ITV plc Executive and Non-executive Directors and the ITV Management Board. Key management personnel compensation is as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Short-term employee benefits

8

8

Share-based compensation

5

6


13

14

 

Principal joint ventures, associated undertakings and investments

The Company indirectly held at 31 December 2013 the following holdings in significant joint ventures, associated undertakings and investments:

Name

Note

Interest in

ordinary

share capital

2013

%

Interest in

ordinary

share

capital

2012

%

                Principal activity

Freesat (UK) Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Provision of a standard and high definition

enabled digital satellite proposition

Digital 3&4 Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Operates the Channel 3 and 4 digital terrestrial multiplex

YouView TV Limited

a

14.3

14.3

Internet connected television platform

Noho Film and Television Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Television drama and film production company

Independent Television News (ITN) Limited 

b

40.0

40.0

Supply of news services to broadcasters

in the UK and elsewhere

Mammoth Screen Limited

b

25.0

25.0

Production of television programmes

 

ISAN UK Limited 

b

25.0

25.0

Operates voluntary numbering system for the

identification of audiovisual works

 

a.   Joint venture.

b.   Associated undertaking.

 

5.2 Contingent liabilities

Keeping it simple . . .

A contingent liability is a liability that is not sufficiently certain to qualify for recognition as a provision where uncertainty may exist regarding the outcome of
future events.

There are contingent liabilities in respect of certain litigation and guarantees, broadcasting issues, and in respect of warranties given in connection with certain disposals of businesses. None of these items are expected to have a material effect on the Group's results or financial position.

5.3 Subsequent events

Keeping it simple . . .

Where the Group receives information in the period between 31 December 2013 and the date of this report about conditions related to certain events that existed at the year end, we update our disclosures that relate to those conditions in light of the new information. Such events can be categorised as adjusting or non-adjusting depending on whether the condition existed in 2013. If non-adjusting events after the year end are material, non-disclosure could influence the economic decisions that users make on the basis of the financial statements.

Accordingly, for each material category of non-adjusting event after the reporting period we disclose in this section the nature of the event and an estimate of its financial effect, or a statement that such an estimate cannot be made.

On 16 January 2014, the Group repurchased the remaining 2019 Bilateral loan, with a nominal value of £62 million, for £95 million. Although this resulted in a loss of £30 million recognised within net financing costs, the Group will receive future cash interest savings of £44 million.

5.4 Subsidiaries exempt from audit

Keeping it simple . . .

Certain subsidiaries of the Group can take an exemption from having an audit. Strict criteria must be met for this exemption to be taken, and it must be agreed to by the Directors of that subsidiary entity.

Listed below are subsidiaries controlled and consolidated by the Group, where the Directors have taken the exemption from having an audit of its financial statements for the year ended 31 December 2013. This exemption is taken in accordance with Companies Act s479A.

Company name

12 Yard (North) Productions Limited

Broad Street Films Limited

Campania Limited

Carbon Media Limited

Carlton Content Holdings Limited

Carlton Finance Limited

Carlton Food Network Limited

Carlton Programmes Development Limited

Carlton Screen Advertising (Holdings) Limited

Carltonco 103

Carltonco Forty Investments

Carltonco Ninety-Six

Cosgrove Hall Films Limited

David Young 12 Yard Productions Limited

DTV Limited

Granada Media Limited

Granada Screen (2005) Limited

Granada Television Overseas Limited

ITC Entertainment Holdings Limited

ITV (HC) Limited

ITV International Channels (Asia) Limited

ITV News Channel Limited

Juice Music UK Limited

Link Electronics Limited

Morning TV Limited

 

ITV plc Company Financial Statements

Company Balance Sheet

As at 31 December

Note

2013

£m

2013

£m

2012

£m

2012

£m

Fixed assets






Investments in subsidiary undertakings       

iii


1,648


1,646

Held to maturity investments



-


145

Derivative financial instruments



41


99




1,689


1,890

Current assets






Amounts owed by subsidiary undertakings


1,280


3,424


Derivative financial instruments


32


-


Other debtors


26


4


Cash at bank and in hand and short-term deposits


319


513




1,657


3,943


Creditors - amounts falling due within one year






Borrowings

v

(41)


-


Amounts owed to subsidiary undertakings


(1,342)


(4,285)


Accruals and deferred income


(22)


(8)


Derivative financial instruments


(5)


(1)




(1,410)


(4,294)


Net current assets/(liabilities)



247


(351)

Total assets less current liabilities



1,936


1,539

Creditors - amounts falling due after more than one year






Borrowings

v


(301)


(594)

Derivative financial instruments



(27)


(48)




(328)


(642)

Net assets



1,608


897

Capital and reserves






Called up share capital

vi


403


391

Share premium

vii


174


122

Other reserves

vii


36


58

Profit and loss account

vii


995


326

Shareholders' funds - equity



1,608


897

 

The accounts were approved by the Board of Directors on 26 February 2014 and were signed on its behalf by:

Ian Griffiths
Director

Notes to the ITV plc
Company Financial Statements

i Accounting policies

Basis of preparation

These accounts have been prepared in accordance with UK Generally Accepted Accounting Practice (UK GAAP).

As permitted by section 408 (3) of the Companies Act 2006, a separate profit and loss account, dealing with the results of the parent company, has not been presented.

Under FRS 29 the Company is exempt from the requirement to provide its own financial instruments disclosures, on the grounds that it is included in publicly available consolidated financial statements which include disclosures that comply with the IFRS equivalent to that standard.

The Company has taken advantage of the FRS 1 exemption from the requirement to prepare and disclose a cash flow statement.

Subsidiaries

Subsidiaries are entities that are directly or indirectly controlled by the Company. Control exists where the Company has the power to govern the financial and operating policies of the entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities. The investment in the Company's subsidiaries is recorded at cost, adjusted for the effect of UITF 41 when it was adopted in prior years. Annual FRS 20 share-based payment compensation costs are recharged to the subsidiaries through the profit and loss account.

Foreign currency transactions

Transactions in foreign currencies are translated into sterling at the rate of exchange ruling at the date of the transaction. Foreign currency monetary assets and liabilities at the balance sheet date are translated into sterling at the rate of exchange ruling at that date. Foreign exchange differences arising on translation are recognised in the profit and loss account. Non-monetary assets and liabilities measured at historical cost are translated into sterling at the rate of exchange on the date of the transaction.

Borrowings

Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value including directly attributable transaction costs, with subsequent measurement at amortised cost using the effective interest rate method. The difference between initial fair value and the redemption value is recorded in the profit and loss account over the period of the liability on an effective interest basis.

Derivatives and other financial instruments

The Company uses a limited number of derivative financial instruments to hedge its exposure to fluctuations in interest and other foreign exchange rates. The Company does not hold or issue derivative instruments for speculative purposes.

Derivative financial instruments are initially recognised at fair value and are subsequently remeasured at fair value with the movement recorded in the profit and loss account within net financing costs. Derivatives with positive fair values are recorded as assets and negative fair values as liabilities.

The fair value of foreign currency forward contracts is determined by using the difference between the contract exchange rate and the quoted forward exchange rate at the balance sheet date. The fair value of interest rate swaps is the estimated amount that the Company would receive or pay to terminate the swap at the balance sheet date, taking into account current interest rates and the current creditworthiness of swap counterparties.

Third party valuations are used to fair value the Company's derivatives. The valuation techniques use inputs such as interest rate yield curves and currency prices/yields, volatilities of underlying instruments and correlations between inputs.

For financial assets and liabilities classified at fair value through profit or loss the fair value change and interest income/expense are not separated.

Compound financial instruments are instruments that are classified as partly debt and partly equity due to the terms of the instrument. The Company had one compound financial instrument, the 2016 convertible bond, that was redeemed in the year as described in note v.

The liability component of a compound financial instrument is recognised initially at the difference between the fair value of a normal bond that does not have an equity conversion option. The equity component is recognised initially at the difference between the fair value of the compound financial instrument as a whole and the fair value of the liability component. Any directly attributable transaction costs are allocated to the liability and equity components in proportion to their initial carrying amounts.

Subsequent to initial recognition, the liability component of a compound instrument is measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. The equity component of a compound financial instrument is not remeasured subsequent to initial recognition but is transferred to the profit and loss account over the term of the instrument on an effective interest basis.

Dividends

Dividends are recognised through equity on the earlier of their approval by the Company's shareholders or their payment.

ii Employees

Two (2012: two) Directors of ITV plc were employees of the Company during the year, both of whom remain at the year end. The costs relating to these Directors are disclosed in the Remuneration Report.

iii Investments in subsidiary undertakings

The principal subsidiary undertakings are listed in note xi. The balance at 31 December 2013 was £1,648 million (2012: £1,646 million).

iv Amounts owed (to)/from subsidiary undertakings

The Company operates an inter-group banking policy with certain 100% owned UK subsidiaries. The policy involves the daily closing cash position for participating subsidiaries whether positive or negative, being cleared to £nil via daily bank transfers to ITV plc. These daily transactions create a corresponding intercompany creditor or debtor which can result in significant movements  in amounts owed to and from subsidiary undertakings in the Company balance sheet.

v Borrowings

Loans repayable in less than than one year

Loans repayable within one year as at 31 December 2013 comprise:

·     an unsecured £41 million (€50 million) Eurobond
(£15 million net of cross currency swaps) which has a coupon of 10.0% maturing in June 2014

Loans repayable after more than one year

Loans repayable after more than one year as at 31 December 2013 include:

·     an unsecured £78 million Eurobond which has a coupon of 5.375% maturing in October 2015;

·     an unsecured £161 million Eurobond which has a coupon of 7.375% maturing in January 2017; and

·     in March 2013 £138 million of the £200 million covenant free loan with a maturity of March 2019 was repaid from cash and with the held to maturity gilts secured against the loan. All other terms, including the interest cost of 13.55%, remain unchanged. The loss on repayment was £38 million, which is shown in financing costs. The repurchase resulted in future cash interest savings of £48 million. Subsequent to year end, in January 2014, the remaining £62 million nominal was repurchased. Details are included in note xii.

Convertible bond

In November 2009 the Company issued a £135 million convertible Eurobond with a maturity date of November 2016 and a coupon of 4%. As the bond contained an option for the issuer to convert a portion of the debt into ITV plc's equity (from November 2013), the components were treated as separate instruments.

During 2013 the Company settled the entire convertible bond through a combination of repurchase and redemption, resulting in future interest cost savings of £16 million and share dilution of 95 million shares:

·     the Company repurchased £73 million nominal for a cash cost of £169 million, resulting in a loss of £13 million recognised in net financing costs and a loss attributable to the equity component of £83 million, which has been reflected in the profit and loss account within shareholders' funds.

·     the remaining nominal of £62 million was redeemed in exchange for 95 million new shares being issued. The Company recognised a loss of £10 million in net financing costs with respect to the redemption, and the residual equity element of £9 million was released to the profit and loss account within shareholders' funds.

vi Called up share capital


2013

£m

Authorised

2012

£m

2013

£m

Allotted,

issued

and fully

paid

2012

£m

Ordinary shares of 10 pence each





Authorised:





8,000,000,000
(2012: 8,000,000,000)

800

800



Allotted, issued and fully paid:





4,025,409,194
(2012: 3,912,026,854)



403

391

Total

800

800

403

391

 

The Company's ordinary shares give shareholders equal rights to vote, receive dividends and to the repayment of capital. The Company issued 20 million new ordinary shares during the period, for total consideration of £2 million.  A further 95 million new ordinary shares were issued as a result of the conversion of £62 million of the £135 million convertible Eurobond into equity, creating an additional share premium of £52 million.

 

vii Reconciliation of movements in shareholders' funds


Share

capital

£m

Share

premium

£m

Other

reserves

£m

Profit

and loss

account

£m

Total

£m

At 1 January 2012

389

120

63

497

1,069

Movement for year

2

2

(5)

(171)

(172)

At 31 December 2012

391

122

58

326

897

Retained profit for year for equity shareholders

-

-

-

996

996

Share-based compensation

-

-

-

14

14

External dividend paid

-

-

-

(271)

(271)

Equity portion of the convertible bond

10

52

(22)

(70)

(30)

Issue of shares

2

-

-

-

2

At 31 December 2013

403

174

36

995

1,608

 

The profit after tax for the year dealt with in the accounts of ITV plc is £996 million (2012: loss of £107 million).

The profit and loss account reserves of £995 million at
31 December 2013 are all distributable.

The Company received £1,117 million of dividends from subsidiaries in 2013 (2012: £nil).

The Directors of the Company propose a final dividend of 2.4p per share and a special dividend of 4.0p per share.

viii Contingent liabilities

Under a group registration, the Company is jointly and severally liable for VAT at 31 December 2013 of £51 million (31 December 2012: £33 million). The Company has guaranteed certain finance and operating lease obligations of subsidiary undertakings.

There are contingent liabilities in respect of certain litigation and guarantees, broadcasting issues, and in respect of warranties given in connection with certain disposals of businesses. None of these items are expected to have a material effect on the Group's results or financial position.

Where the Company enters into financial guarantee contracts to guarantee the indebtedness of other companies within its Group, the Company considers these to be insurance arrangements, and accounts for them as such. In this respect, the Company treats the guarantee contract as a contingent liability until such time as it becomes probable that the Company will be required to make a payment under the guarantee.

ix Capital and other commitments

There are no capital commitments at 31 December 2013 (2012: none).

x Related party transactions

Transactions with key management personnel

Key management consists of ITV plc Executive Directors.

Key management personnel compensation is as follows:


2013

£m

2012

£m

Short-term employee benefits

3

3

Share-based compensation

2

4


5

7

 

xi Principal subsidiary undertakings and investments

Principal subsidiary undertakings

The principal subsidiary undertakings of the Company at 31 December 2013, all of which are wholly owned (directly or indirectly) and incorporated and registered in England and Wales except where stated, are:

Name

Principal activity

ITV Broadcasting Limited

Broadcast of television programmes

ITV Network Limited

Scheduling and commissioning television programmes

ITV2 Limited

Operation of digital television channels

ITV Digital Channels Limited

Operation of digital television channels

ITV Breakfast Limited

 

Production and broadcast of breakfast time television under

national Channel 3 licence

ITV Consumer Limited

Development of platforms, broadband, transactional and mobile services

SDN Limited

Operation of Freeview Multiplex A

ITV Studios Limited

Production of television programmes

ITV Studios, Inc.1

Production of television programmes

ITV Studios Germany GmbH2

Production of television programmes

ITV Studios Australia Pty Limited (formerly Granada Media Australia Pty Limited)3

Production of television programmes

12 Yard Productions (Investments) Limited

Production of television programmes

Imago TV Film und Fernsehproduktion GmbH2, 4

Production of television programmes

3sixtymedia Limited4

Supplier of facilities for television productions

ITV Global Entertainment Limited

Rights ownership and distribution of television programmes and films

ITV Ventures Limited (formerly Granada Ventures Limited)

Production and distribution of video and DVD products

ITV Global Entertainment, Inc1

Distribution of television programmes

ITV Services Limited

Provision of services for other companies within the Group

Carlton Communications Limited

Holding company

Granada Limited

Holding company

ITV Scottish Limited Partnership5

Holding company

ITV Breakfast Broadcasting Limited

Broadcast of television programmes

Gurney Productions LLC 1,6

Production of television programmes

Big Talk Productions Limited

Production of television programmes

High Noon Group LLC 1,7

Production of television programmes

The Garden Productions Limited

Production of television programmes

Thinkfactory Group, LLC 1,8

Production of television programmes

 

1.   Incorporated and registered in the USA

2.   Incorporated and registered in Germany

3.   Incorporated and registered in Australia

4.   80% owned

5.   99.9% owned SPE partnership with the remaining interest held by the ITV pension scheme. Fully consolidated in the Group accounts. Incorporated and registered in Scotland holding the ownership interest in SDN. The Group has taken advantage of the exemption conferred by Regulation 7 of the Partnership (Accounts) Regulations 2008 and has, therefore, not appended the accounts of this qualifying partnership to these accounts. Separate accounts for the partnership are not required to be, and have not been, filed at Companies House.

6.   61.5% owned

7.   60% owned

8.   65% owned

A list of all subsidiary undertakings will be included in the Company's annual return to Companies House.

Principal joint ventures, associated undertakings and investments

The Company indirectly held at 31 December 2013 the following interests in significant joint ventures, associated undertakings and investments:

Name

Note

Interest in

ordinary

share capital

2013

%

Interest in

ordinary

share capital

2012

%

Principal activity

Freesat (UK) Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Provision of a standard and high definition
enabled digital satellite proposition

Digital 3&4 Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Operates the Channel 3 and 4 digital terrestrial multiplex

YouView TV Limited

a

14.3

14.3

Internet connected television platform

Noho Film and Television Limited

a

50.0

50.0

Television drama and film production company

Independent Television News Limited

b

40.0

40.0

Supply of news services to broadcasters
in the UK and elsewhere

Mammoth Screen Limited

b

25.0

25.0

Production of television programmes

ISAN UK Limited

b

25.0

25.0

Operates voluntary numbering system for the

identification of audiovisual works

 

Joint venture

Associated undertaking

xii Post balance sheet events

On 16 January 2014, the Company repurchased the remaining 2019 Bilateral loan, with a nominal value of £62 million, for £95 million. Although this resulted in a loss of £30 million recognised within the profit for the year, the Company will receive future cash interest savings of £44 million.

Financial Record


2013

£m

2012

(restated)

£m

2011

£m

2010

£m

2009

£m

Results






Revenue

2,389

2,196

2,140

2,064

1,879

Earnings before interest, tax and amortisation (EBITA) before exceptional items

620

513

462

408

202

Amortisation of intangible assets

(66)

(57)

(59)

(63)

(59)

Impairment of intangible assets

-

(3)

-

-

-

Share of losses of joint ventures and associated undertakings

(2)

(1)

(2)

(3)

(7)

Exceptional items

(2)

(12)

1

19

(20)

Profit before interest and tax

550

440

402

361

116

Net financing costs

(115)

(106)

(75)

(75)

(91)

Profit before tax

435

334

327

286

25

Taxation (charge)/credit

(105)

(77)

(79)

(16)

69

Profit after tax

330

257

248

270

94

Non-controlling interests

(4)

(1)

(1)

(1)

(3)

Profit for the financial year

326

256

247

269

91

Basic earnings per share

8.3p

6.6p

6.4p

6.9p

2.3p

Adjusted earnings per share

11.2p

9.1p

7.9p

6.4p

1.8p

Dividend per share

3.5p

2.6p

1.6p

-

-

Special dividend per share

4.0p

4.0p

-

-

-







Consolidated statement of financial position






Share capital

403

391

389

389

389

Reserves

455

426

417

272

(44)

Total equity attributable to equity shareholders of the
parent company

858

817

806

661

345

Non-controlling interests

31

15

3

2

1

Net assets

889

832

809

663

346

Represented by:






Property, plant and equipment and intangible assets

1,213

1,094

1,101

1,120

1,191

Investments

4

9

5

5

6

Distribution rights

10

17

11

12

16

Inventory

322

252

285

284

388

Trade and other receivables (including assets held for sale and derivative financial instruments)

449

479

475

511

565

Deferred tax asset

52

93

65

73

50

Total assets

2,050

1,944

1,942

2,005

2,216

Net cash/(debt)

164

206

45

(188)

(612)

Deferred tax liability

-

-

-

-

-

Other liabilities

(1,298)

(1,281)

(1,145)

(1,105)

(1,182)

Provisions

(27)

(37)

(33)

(49)

(76)


889

832

809

663

346

 

Shareholder Information

Shareholder profile

Information as at 31 December 2013


%

Shares held

Millions

%

Type of holder:





Insurance companies

7

0.01

0

0.00

Banks and nominee companies

2,460

4.12

3,839

95.36

Individuals

56,925

95.33

135

3.36

Others

321

0.54

51

1.28

Totals

59,713

100.00

4,025

100.00

 


Holders

Number

%

Shares held

%  

Size of holding:





1 - 100

9,740

16.31

346,447

0.01

101 - 200

8,148

13.65

1,222,098

0.03

201 - 500

15,423

25.83

4,978,168

0.12

501 - 1,000

9,808

16.43

7,172,614

0.18

1,001 - 2,000

7,515

12.59

10,818,644

0.27

2,001 - 5,000

5,101

8.54

15,762,847

0.39

5,001 - 10,000

1,726

2.89

12,301,121

0.31

10,001 - 50,000

1,285

2.15

26,009,203

0.65

50,001 - 100,000

188

0.31

13,614,940

0.34

100,001 - 500,000

336

0.56

86,967,481

2.16

500,001 - 1,000,000

131

0.22

93,895,771

2.33

1,000,001 - 5,000,000

196

0.33

457,459,506

11.37

5,000,001 - 10,000,000

45

0.08

319,355,231

7.93

10,000,001 - 50,000,000

56

0.09

1,152,494,459

28.63

50,000,001 and above

15

0.03

1,823,010,664

45.29

Totals

59,713

100.00

4,025,409,194

100.00

 

Registrars and transfer office

All administrative enquiries relating to shareholdings and requests to receive corporate documents should, in the first instance, be directed to Capita Asset Services, The Registry,
34 Beckenham Road, Beckenham, BR3 4TU.

They can be contacted by telephone on 0871 664 0300 (calls cost 10 pence per minute plus network charges) from the UK and +44 20 8639 3399 from outside the UK. Lines are open Monday to Friday 9.00 a.m. to 5.30 p.m.

Alternatively you could email them at:
shareholderenquiries@capita.co.uk

Shareholders who receive duplicate sets of Company mailings because they have multiple accounts should write to Capita to have the accounts amalgamated.

By logging on to www.capitashareportal.com shareholders can benefit from a number of online services as follows:

·     Cast your proxy vote online;

·     Elect to receive shareholder communication electronically;

·     View your holding balance, indicative share price and valuation;

·     View transactions on your holding and dividend payments you have received;

·     Update your address or register a bank mandate instruction to have dividends paid directly to your bank account; and

·     Access a wide range of shareholder information including downloadable forms.

You will need your investor code (IVC) which can be found on your share certificate(s) to register to use the Shareholder Portal.

Share dealing services

The Company's shares can be traded through most banks, building societies and stockbrokers. Additionally, the Company's Registrars offer online and telephone dealing for UK resident shareholders through Capita IRG Trustees Limited. To use this service shareholders should contact Capita:

08716640454

from the UK (calls cost 10 pence per minute plus network charges) or 1 890 946 375 for Ireland lo-call and +44(0) 203 367 2699 from outside the UK. Lines are open Monday to Friday 8.00 a.m. to 4.30 p.m.
www.capitadeal.com

ShareGift

ShareGift is a charity share donation scheme for shareholders who may wish to dispose of a small quantity of shares where the market value makes it uneconomic to sell on a commission basis. The scheme is administered by the Orr Mackintosh Foundation and further information can be obtained by contacting them:

020 7930 3737

www.sharegift.org

Share price information

The current price of ITV plc ordinary shares is available on the Company website

www.itvplc.com.

Unsolicited mail

The Company is legally obliged to make its register of members available to the public. As a consequence of this some shareholders might receive unsolicited mail. Shareholders wishing to limit the amount of such mail should write to the Mailing Preference Service (MPS):

FREEPOST 29 LON20771
London
W1E 0ZT

Alternatively you can register online or request an application form by telephone or by email. MPS will then notify the bodies that support its service that you do not wish to receive unsolicited mail.

0845 703 4599

www.mpsonline.org.uk

mps@dma.org.uk

Registered office

The London Television Centre
Upper Ground
London
SE1 9LT

020 7157 3000

Company registration number 4967001

Company website

Investor and shareholder related information can be found on the Company website at:

www.itvplc.com

Financial calendar

Annual General Meeting

14 May 2014

Interim Management Statement

14 May 2014

Half year results announcement

30 July 2014

 

Unauthorised brokers (Boiler Room Scams)

Shareholders are advised to be wary of any unsolicited advice, offers to buy shares at a discount or offers of free company reports. These are typically from overseas based brokers who target UK shareholders offering to sell them what often turn out to be worthless or high risk shares in US or UK investments. These operations are commonly known as boiler rooms.

If you receive any unsolicited investment advice:

·     Make sure you get the correct name of the person and organisation.

·     Check that they are properly authorised by the FCA before getting involved by visiting:

www.fsa.gov.uk/register/home.do

·     Report the matter to the FCA either by calling their Consumer Helpline 0800 111 6768 or by completing an online form at:

www.fca.org.uk/scams

·     If the calls persist, hang up.

If you deal with an unauthorised firm, you will not be eligible to receive payment under the Financial Services Compensation Scheme.

Details of any sharedealing facilities that the Company endorses will only be included in Company mailings.

Keep in mind that it is very unlikely that an authorised firm that you have no relationship with would contact you out of the blue offering to buy or sell shares or offer other investment opportunities.

More detailed information can be found on the FCA website:

www.fca.org.uk

www.fca.org.uk/consumers/protect-yourself

Identity theft

Tips for protecting your ITV plc shares:

·     Ensure all your certificates are kept in a safe place or hold your shares electronically in CREST via a nominee.

·     Keep all correspondence from Capita in a safe place, or destroy correspondence by shredding.

·     If you change address inform Capita in writing or via the Shareholder Portal. If you receive a letter from Capita regarding a change of address but have not recently moved please contact them immediately.

·     Consider having your dividend paid directly into your bank. This will reduce the risk of the cheque being intercepted or lost in the post.

·     If you change your bank account, inform Capita of the details of your new account. You can do this via post or online using the Shareholder Portal. Respond to any letters Capita sends you about this.

·     If you are buying or selling shares only deal with brokers registered in your country of residence or the UK.

Glossary

Broadcasters' Audience Research Board (BARB) - organisation owned by broadcasters and advertisers providing data on television viewing statistics in UK households

Catch up viewing - non-live viewing of recently broadcast television programmes, either via a recording device (often called a PVR or DTR) such as Sky+ or through a Video on Demand service such as ITV Player, BBC iPlayer, 4oD or Demand 5

Channel 3 licences - the 15 regional licences and one national licence awarded to transmit Channel 3 across the UK. All are owned by ITV with the exception of three of the regional licences, two of which are owned by STV and one by UTV

Contract Rights Renewal (CRR)- the remedy agreed by Carlton and Granada in 2003 as a pre-condition of the merger, which governs the way in which ITV airtime is sold
by ITV to its advertising customers

Digital switchover - termination in 2012 of the analogue terrestrial television signal in the regions in which it is still broadcast. BBC1, BBC2, ITV, Channel 4 and Channel 5 were broadcast in analogue

Free-to-Air (FTA) television- viewing of television through devices not requiring monthly subscriptions such as the Freeview or Freesat services

High Definition (HD)- channels or services broadcast in substantially higher resolution than standard, providing improved picture quality

Impact or Commercial Impact- one Commercial Impact is defined as one viewer watching one 30-second television commercial

ITV Family - the ITV Family of channels which includes ITV, ITV2, ITV3, ITV4, CITV, ITV Breakfast, CITV Breakfast and all associated +1 and HD equivalents. Viewing figures include the whole of the ITV network. Revenue figures include only ITV plc operated regions

Long form video requests- video requests are a measure of the total number of videos viewed across all platforms (such as itv.com, Virgin and mobile devices). A long form video is a programme that has been broadcast on television and is available to watch online and on demand in its entirety

Media sales - commission earned by ITV plc on sales of airtime on behalf of the non-consolidated licensees

Net Advertising Revenues (NAR)- the amount of money received by a broadcaster as payment for television spot advertising net of any commission paid to agencies

Network Programme Budget (NPB) - the budget spent on programming broadcast on the ITV channel, excluding spend on regional programming and ITV Breakfast

Non-consolidated licensees - the three regional channel 3 licences which ITV does not own. These licences are owned by STV and UTV and revenues received from these licences for ITV programming content are referred to as minority revenues

Non-NAR revenues - non-NAR revenues includes all ITV revenues, both internal and external, except net advertising revenues (NAR). This includes inter-segment revenues from the sale of ITV Studios shows to the ITV Network

Ofcom - the regulator established to govern UK broadcasting as well as other areas of the media and telephony industry

SDN - multiplex operator owned by ITV which operates one of the six digital terrestrial multiplex licences in the UK that make up Freeview

Share of Broadcast (SOB)- ITV's share of UK television advertising revenues (NAR), a measure of market share

Share of Commercial Impacts (SOCI) - the term used to define the share of total UK television commercial impacts which is delivered by one channel or group of channels. This measure excludes viewing of BBC channels as they do not generate commercial impacts. Unless stated otherwise, SOCI figures cited throughout this report are based on BARB data and are based on the universe of Adults (16+)

Share of Viewing (SOV)- the share of the total viewing audience during a defined period gained by a programme or channel. This measure includes viewing of BBC channels. Unless stated otherwise, SOV figures cited throughout this report are based on BARB data and are based on the universe of Individuals

Video on Demand (VOD)- the ability to deliver video content to a customer's television set, computer or device when the customer requests it

YouView - a joint venture (with the BBC, Channel 4, Channel 5, British Telecom, TalkTalk, and Arqiva) to operate and promote a hybrid television platform combining Freeview channels with catch up and on demand services.

 

ITV plc
The London Television Centre
Upper Ground
London
SE1 9LT
www.itv.com
Investors:
www.itvplc.com

 

 


This information is provided by RNS
The company news service from the London Stock Exchange
 
END
 
 
FR JLMRTMBBBBFI

Companies

ITV (ITV)
UK 100

Latest directors dealings